Nikon Digital Camera 1543 User Manual

DIGITAL CAMERA  
User's Manual  
Nikon Manual Viewer 2  
Use the Nikon Manual Viewer 2 app to view  
manuals anytime, anywhere on your smartphone or  
tablet.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And DownlEoadn.  
D750  
Model Name: N1404  
To get the most from your camera, please be sure to read all  
instructions thoroughly and keep them where they will be read  
by all who use the product.  
Symbols and Conventions  
To make it easier to find the information you need, the following  
symbols and conventions are used:  
This icon marks cautions; information that should be  
read before use to prevent damage to the camera.  
D
A
0
This icon marks notes; information that should be read  
before using the camera.  
This icon marks references to other pages in this  
manual.  
Menu items, options, and messages displayed in the camera monitor are  
shown in bold.  
Camera Settings  
The explanations in this manual assume that default settings are used.  
Nikon Manual Viewer 2  
Install the Nikon Manual Viewer 2 app on your smartphone or  
tablet to view Nikon digital camera manuals, anytime,  
anywhere. Nikon Manual Viewer 2 can be downloaded free of  
charge from the App Store and Google Play. Download of the  
app and any product manuals requires an Internet  
connection, for which fees may be levied by your phone or  
Internet service provider.  
AFor Your Safety  
Before using the camera for the first time, read the safety instructions  
in “For Your Safety” (0xiii–xvi).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Package Contents  
Be sure all items listed here were included with your camera.  
DK-21 rubber eyecup  
BF-1B body cap  
D750 camera (01)  
EN-EL15 rechargeable Li-ion battery with terminal cover  
(025, 26)  
MH-25a battery charger (comes with either an AC wall  
adapter or power cable of a type and shape that varies  
with the country or region of sale; 025)  
DK-5 eyepiece cap (0107)  
UC-E17 USB cable (0266, 271)  
AN-DC14 strap (024)  
Warranty  
User’s Manual (this guide)  
ViewNX 2 installer CD (0262)  
Memory cards are sold separately. Cameras purchased in Japan display  
menus and messages in English and Japanese only; other languages are  
not supported. We apologize for any inconvenience this may cause.  
i
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Table of Contents  
Package Contents.......................................................................... i  
For Your Safety........................................................................... xiii  
Notices........................................................................................ xvii  
Wireless ..................................................................................... xxiv  
Introduction  
Getting to Know the Camera...................................................... 1  
The Camera Body .................................................................................. 1  
The Mode Dial ........................................................................................ 6  
The Release-Mode Dial........................................................................ 7  
The Control Panel.................................................................................. 8  
The Viewfinder ..................................................................................... 10  
The Information Display ................................................................... 12  
The P button......................................................................................... 16  
Using the Tilting Monitor ................................................................. 17  
The Multi Selector............................................................................... 19  
Camera Menus ............................................................................ 20  
Using Camera Menus......................................................................... 21  
First Steps..................................................................................... 24  
Basic Photography and Playback  
“Point-and-Shoot” Photography (i and j Modes)............ 34  
Basic Playback............................................................................. 37  
Deleting Unwanted Photographs................................................. 38  
Matching Settings to the Subject or Situation  
(Scene Mode)  
k Portrait ...................................................................................... 42  
l Landscape................................................................................ 42  
p Child........................................................................................... 42  
m Sports......................................................................................... 42  
ii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
n Close Up................................................................................... 43  
o Night Portrait ......................................................................... 43  
r Night Landscape................................................................... 43  
s Party/Indoor ........................................................................... 43  
t Beach/Snow............................................................................ 44  
u Sunset....................................................................................... 44  
v Dusk/Dawn ............................................................................. 44  
w Pet Portrait.............................................................................. 44  
x Candlelight............................................................................... 45  
y Blossom.................................................................................... 45  
z Autumn Colors....................................................................... 45  
0 Food ........................................................................................... 45  
Special Effects  
% Night Vision ............................................................................ 47  
g Color Sketch.......................................................................... 47  
i Miniature Effect................................................................... 48  
u Selective Color....................................................................... 48  
1 Silhouette................................................................................ 48  
2 High Key................................................................................... 49  
3 Low Key.................................................................................... 49  
Options Available in Live View ...................................................... 50  
Live View Photography  
Focus ....................................................................................................... 57  
Manual Focus ....................................................................................... 60  
Using the P Button............................................................................. 61  
The Live View Display: Live View Photography ....................... 63  
The Information Display: Live View Photography .................. 64  
Movie Live View  
Indices..................................................................................................... 70  
Using the P Button............................................................................. 71  
The Live View Display: Movie Live View ..................................... 74  
iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Information Display: Movie Live View................................. 75  
Image Area............................................................................................. 76  
Taking Photos During Movie Live View ...................................... 77  
Viewing Movies........................................................................... 79  
Editing Movies ............................................................................ 81  
Trimming Movies ................................................................................ 81  
Saving Selected Frames.................................................................... 86  
P, S, A, and M Modes  
P: Programmed Auto.......................................................................... 89  
S: Shutter-Priority Auto...................................................................... 90  
A: Aperture-Priority Auto .................................................................. 91  
M: Manual ............................................................................................... 93  
Long Time-Exposures (M Mode Only)................................. 95  
User Settings: U1 and U2 Modes  
Saving User Settings .......................................................................... 99  
Recalling User Settings................................................................... 101  
Resetting User Settings.................................................................. 101  
Release Mode  
Choosing a Release Mode...................................................... 103  
Self-Timer Mode (E) ............................................................... 106  
Mirror up Mode (V).............................................................. 109  
Image Recording Options  
Image Area................................................................................ 110  
Image Quality and Size........................................................... 115  
Image Quality .................................................................................... 115  
Image Size........................................................................................... 118  
Using Two Memory Cards...................................................... 119  
iv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Focus  
Autofocus .................................................................................. 120  
Autofocus Mode................................................................................ 121  
AF-Area Mode.................................................................................... 123  
Focus Point Selection...................................................................... 127  
Focus Lock........................................................................................... 129  
Manual Focus............................................................................ 132  
ISO Sensitivity  
Auto ISO Sensitivity Control .................................................. 136  
Exposure 139  
Metering .................................................................................... 139  
Autoexposure Lock.................................................................. 141  
Exposure Compensation ........................................................ 143  
White Balance  
Fine-Tuning White Balance .................................................... 149  
Choosing a Color Temperature ............................................. 152  
Preset Manual ........................................................................... 155  
Viewfinder Photography................................................................ 155  
Live View (Spot White Balance) ................................................... 159  
Managing Presets............................................................................. 162  
Image Enhancement  
Picture Controls........................................................................ 165  
Selecting a Picture Control............................................................ 165  
Modifying Picture Controls ........................................................... 167  
Creating Custom Picture Controls.............................................. 170  
Sharing Custom Picture Controls................................................ 173  
Preserving Detail in Highlights and Shadows .................... 175  
Active D-Lighting.............................................................................. 175  
High Dynamic Range (HDR).......................................................... 177  
v
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Flash Photography  
Using the Built-in Flash .......................................................... 180  
Auto Pop-up Modes........................................................................ 180  
Manual Pop-up Modes................................................................... 182  
Flash Compensation ............................................................... 188  
FV Lock ...................................................................................... 190  
Remote Control Photography  
Using an Optional ML-L3 Remote Control.......................... 193  
Wireless Remote Controllers................................................. 197  
WR-1 Wireless Remote Controllers ............................................ 197  
WR-R10/WR-T10 Wireless Remote Controllers...................... 197  
Other Shooting Options  
Viewfinder Photography: The P Button.............................. 198  
Two-Button Reset: Restoring Default Settings.................. 199  
Bracketing................................................................................. 202  
Multiple Exposure ................................................................... 216  
Interval Timer Photography.................................................. 222  
Time-Lapse Photography ...................................................... 229  
Non-CPU Lenses....................................................................... 235  
Location Data ........................................................................... 239  
More on Playback  
Viewing Pictures ...................................................................... 241  
Full-Frame Playback........................................................................ 241  
Thumbnail Playback........................................................................ 243  
Calendar Playback............................................................................ 244  
The P Button ...................................................................................... 245  
Photo Information................................................................... 246  
Taking a Closer Look: Playback Zoom................................. 255  
Protecting Photographs from Deletion .............................. 257  
vi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Deleting Photographs............................................................. 258  
Full-Frame, Thumbnail, and Calendar Playback.................... 258  
The Playback Menu.......................................................................... 260  
Connections  
Installing ViewNX 2.................................................................. 262  
Using ViewNX 2 ........................................................................ 266  
Copy Pictures to the Computer................................................... 266  
Ethernet and Wireless Networks................................................. 269  
Printing Photographs.............................................................. 271  
Connecting the Printer................................................................... 271  
Printing Pictures One at a Time................................................... 272  
Printing Multiple Pictures.............................................................. 274  
Creating a DPOF Print Order: Print Set...................................... 275  
Viewing Photographs on TV .................................................. 277  
HDMI Options .................................................................................... 278  
Wi-Fi  
What Wi-Fi Can Do for You..................................................... 281  
Accessing the Camera ............................................................. 282  
WPS (Android Only) ......................................................................... 284  
PIN Entry (Android Only)................................................................ 285  
SSID (Android and iOS)................................................................... 286  
Selecting Pictures for Upload ................................................ 289  
Selecting Individual Pictures for Upload.................................. 289  
Selecting Multiple Pictures for Upload..................................... 291  
Menu Guide  
Defaults...................................................................................... 292  
D The Playback Menu: Managing Images ......................... 300  
Playback Menu Options ................................................................. 300  
Playback Folder........................................................................ 300  
Hide Image................................................................................. 301  
Playback Display Options ..................................................... 302  
vii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copy Image(s)........................................................................... 303  
Image Review ........................................................................... 307  
After Delete ............................................................................... 307  
Rotate Tall.................................................................................. 308  
Slide Show ................................................................................. 308  
C The Photo Shooting Menu:  
Photo Shooting Options................................................... 310  
Photo Shooting Menu Options................................................... 310  
Reset Photo Shooting Menu............................................... 311  
Storage Folder.......................................................................... 311  
File Naming ............................................................................... 313  
Color Space ............................................................................... 314  
Vignette Control...................................................................... 315  
Auto Distortion Control ........................................................ 316  
Long Exposure NR  
(Long Exposure Noise Reduction)................................ 317  
High ISO NR............................................................................... 317  
1 The Movie Shooting Menu:  
Movie Shooting Options................................................... 318  
Movie Shooting Menu Options................................................... 318  
Reset Movie Shooting Menu............................................... 318  
Destination................................................................................ 319  
Frame Size/Frame Rate ......................................................... 319  
Movie Quality ........................................................................... 320  
Microphone Sensitivity ......................................................... 320  
Frequency Response.............................................................. 320  
Wind Noise Reduction........................................................... 321  
White Balance........................................................................... 321  
Set Picture Control.................................................................. 321  
Movie ISO Sensitivity Settings............................................ 322  
A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings........... 323  
Custom Settings ............................................................................... 324  
Reset Custom Settings .......................................................... 326  
viii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
a: Autofocus ....................................................................................326  
a1: AF-C Priority Selection .................................................... 326  
a2: AF-S Priority Selection..................................................... 327  
a3: Focus Tracking with Lock-On....................................... 328  
a4: Focus Point Illumination ................................................ 329  
a5: AF Point Illumination....................................................... 329  
a6: Focus Point Wrap-Around............................................. 330  
a7: Number of Focus Points................................................. 330  
a8: Store Points by Orientation........................................... 331  
a9: Built-in AF-assist Illuminator......................................... 332  
b: Metering/Exposure..................................................................333  
b1: ISO Sensitivity Step Value.............................................. 333  
b2: EV Steps for Exposure Cntrl .......................................... 333  
b3: Easy Exposure Compensation ..................................... 334  
b4: Matrix Metering ................................................................ 335  
b5: Center-Weighted Area ................................................... 335  
b6: Fine-tune Optimal Exposure ........................................ 336  
c: Timers/AE Lock ..........................................................................336  
c1: Shutter-Release Button AE-L......................................... 336  
c2: Standby timer..................................................................... 336  
c3: Self-Timer............................................................................. 337  
c4: Monitor off Delay.............................................................. 337  
c5: Remote on Duration (ML-L3)........................................ 337  
d: Shooting/Display......................................................................338  
d1: Beep ...................................................................................... 338  
d2: Continuous Low-Speed ................................................. 338  
d3: Max. Continuous Release .............................................. 339  
d4: Exposure Delay Mode..................................................... 339  
d5: Flash Warning.................................................................... 339  
d6: File Number Sequence................................................... 340  
d7: Viewfinder Grid Display ................................................. 341  
d8: Easy ISO................................................................................ 341  
d9: Information Display......................................................... 341  
d10: LCD Illumination ............................................................ 342  
ix  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
d11: MB-D16 Battery Type ................................................... 343  
d12: Battery Order................................................................... 344  
e: Bracketing/Flash....................................................................... 345  
e1: Flash Sync Speed.............................................................. 345  
e2: Flash Shutter Speed ........................................................ 346  
e3: Flash Cntrl for Built-in Flash.......................................... 347  
e4: Exposure Comp. for Flash ............................................. 353  
e5: Modeling Flash.................................................................. 353  
e6: Auto Bracketing Set......................................................... 353  
e7: Bracketing Order .............................................................. 354  
f: Controls ........................................................................................ 354  
f1: OK Button............................................................................. 354  
f2: Assign Fn Button ............................................................... 356  
f3: Assign Preview Button .................................................... 361  
f4: Assign AE-L/AF-L Button ................................................ 361  
f5: Customize Command Dials ........................................... 363  
f6: Release Button to Use Dial............................................. 365  
f7: Slot Empty Release Lock................................................. 365  
f8: Reverse Indicators............................................................. 366  
f9: Assign Movie Record Button......................................... 366  
f10: Assign MB-D16 4 Button............................................. 367  
f11: Assign Remote (WR) Fn Button.................................. 368  
g: Movie............................................................................................ 370  
g1: Assign Fn Button.............................................................. 370  
g2: Assign Preview Button................................................... 372  
g3: Assign AE-L/AF-L Button ............................................... 373  
g4: Assign Shutter Button.................................................... 373  
B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup........................................ 374  
Setup Menu Options....................................................................... 374  
Format Memory Card ............................................................ 375  
Monitor Brightness................................................................. 376  
Monitor Color Balance........................................................... 377  
Image Dust Off Ref Photo .................................................... 378  
Flicker Reduction..................................................................... 380  
x
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Time Zone and Date............................................................... 381  
Language.................................................................................... 381  
Auto Image Rotation.............................................................. 382  
Battery Info ................................................................................ 383  
Image Comment...................................................................... 384  
Copyright Information........................................................... 385  
Save/Load Settings ................................................................. 386  
Virtual Horizon.......................................................................... 388  
AF Fine-tune.............................................................................. 389  
Eye-Fi Upload............................................................................ 391  
Conformity Marking ............................................................... 392  
Firmware Version..................................................................... 392  
N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies .......... 393  
Retouch Menu Options .................................................................. 393  
Creating Retouched Copies.......................................................... 395  
D-Lighting .................................................................................. 397  
Red-Eye Correction ................................................................. 398  
Trim............................................................................................... 399  
Monochrome ............................................................................ 400  
Filter Effects ............................................................................... 401  
Color Balance ............................................................................ 402  
Image Overlay........................................................................... 403  
NEF (RAW) Processing............................................................ 406  
Resize ........................................................................................... 408  
Quick Retouch .......................................................................... 411  
Straighten................................................................................... 411  
Distortion Control.................................................................... 412  
Fisheye......................................................................................... 413  
Color Outline............................................................................. 413  
Color Sketch .............................................................................. 414  
Perspective Control ................................................................ 415  
Miniature Effect........................................................................ 416  
Selective Color.......................................................................... 417  
Side-by-side Comparison ..................................................... 419  
xi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
O My Menu/m Recent Settings............................................ 421  
Recent Settings ................................................................................. 425  
Technical Notes  
Compatible Lenses.................................................................. 426  
Optional Flash Units (Speedlights) ...................................... 433  
The Nikon Creative Lighting System (CLS).............................. 433  
Other Accessories.................................................................... 441  
Attaching a Power Connector and AC Adapter .................... 445  
Caring for the Camera ............................................................ 447  
Storage................................................................................................. 447  
Cleaning............................................................................................... 447  
The Low-Pass Filter.......................................................................... 448  
Caring for the Camera and Battery: Cautions .................... 455  
Available Settings.................................................................... 460  
Exposure Program (Mode P).................................................. 462  
Troubleshooting...................................................................... 463  
Battery/Display.................................................................................. 463  
Shooting (All Modes) ...................................................................... 464  
Shooting (P, S, A, M) .......................................................................... 467  
Playback............................................................................................... 468  
Wi-Fi (Wireless Networks).............................................................. 469  
Miscellaneous.................................................................................... 469  
Error Messages......................................................................... 470  
Specifications ........................................................................... 477  
Approved Memory Cards....................................................... 491  
Memory Card Capacity ........................................................... 492  
Battery Life................................................................................ 494  
Lenses That May Block the Built-in Flash and AF-Assist  
Illuminator........................................................................... 496  
Index .......................................................................................... 501  
xii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For Your Safety  
To prevent damage to your Nikon product or injury to yourself or to others,  
read the following safety precautions in their entirety before using this  
equipment. Keep these safety instructions where all those who use the  
product will read them.  
The consequences that could result from failure to observe the precautions  
listed in this section are indicated by the following symbol:  
A This icon marks warnings. To prevent possible injury, read all  
warnings before using this Nikon product.  
❚❚ WARNINGS  
AKeep the sun out of the frame  
Keep the sun well out of the frame  
when shooting backlit subjects.  
Sunlight focused into the camera  
when the sun is in or close to the  
frame could cause a fire.  
ATurn off immediately in the event of  
malfunction  
Should you notice smoke or an  
unusual smell coming from the  
equipment or AC adapter (available  
separately), unplug the AC adapter  
and remove the battery immediately,  
taking care to avoid burns.  
ADo not look at the sun through the  
viewfinder  
Continued operation could result in  
injury. After removing the battery,  
take the equipment to a Nikon-  
authorized service center for  
inspection.  
Viewing the sun or other strong light  
source through the viewfinder could  
cause permanent visual impairment.  
AUsing the viewfinder diopter adjustment  
control  
ADo not use in the presence of flammable  
gas  
Do not use electronic equipment in  
the presence of flammable gas, as  
this could result in explosion or fire.  
When operating the viewfinder  
diopter adjustment control with your  
eye to the viewfinder, care should be  
taken not to put your finger in your  
eye accidentally.  
AKeep out of reach of children  
Failure to observe this precaution  
could result in injury. In addition,  
note that small parts constitute a  
choking hazard. Should a child  
swallow any part of this equipment,  
consult a physician immediately.  
xiii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ADo not disassemble  
AObserve caution when using the flash  
Using the camera with the flash in  
close contact with the skin or other  
objects could cause burns.  
Using the flash close to the subject’s  
eyes could cause temporary visual  
impairment. The flash should be no  
less than one meter (3 ft 4 in.) from  
the subject. Particular care should  
be observed when photographing  
infants.  
Touching the product’s internal parts  
could result in injury. In the event of  
malfunction, the product should be  
repaired only by a qualified  
technician. Should the product break  
open as the result of a fall or other  
accident, remove the battery and/or  
AC adapter and then take the product  
to a Nikon-authorized service center  
for inspection.  
ADo not place the strap around the neck of AAvoid contact with liquid crystal  
an infant or child  
Should the monitor break, care  
Placing the camera strap around the  
neck of an infant or child could result  
in strangulation.  
should be taken to avoid injury due to  
broken glass and to prevent the liquid  
crystal from the monitor touching the  
skin or entering the eyes or mouth.  
ADo not remain in contact with the  
camera, battery, or charger for extended ADo not carry tripods with a lens or camera  
periods while the devices are on or in use  
Parts of the device become hot.  
Leaving the device in direct contact  
with the skin for extended periods  
may result in low-temperature burns.  
attached  
You could trip or accidentally strike  
others, resulting in injury.  
ADo not leave the product where it will be  
exposed to extremely high  
temperatures, such as in an enclosed  
automobile or in direct sunlight  
Failure to observe this precaution  
could cause damage or fire.  
ADo not aim a flash at the operator of a  
motor vehicle  
Failure to observe this precaution  
could result in accidents.  
xiv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AObserve proper precautions when  
handling batteries  
When the battery is not in use,  
attach the terminal cover and store  
in a cool, dry place.  
Batteries may leak or explode if  
improperly handled. Observe the  
following precautions when handling  
batteries for use in this product:  
Use only batteries approved for use  
in this equipment.  
The battery may be hot  
immediately after use or when the  
product has been used on battery  
power for an extended period.  
Before removing the battery turn  
the camera off and allow the battery  
to cool.  
Do not short or disassemble the  
battery.  
Be sure the product is off before  
replacing the battery. If you are  
using an AC adapter, be sure it is  
unplugged.  
Discontinue use immediately  
should you notice any changes in  
the battery, such as discoloration or  
deformation.  
Do not attempt to insert the battery  
upside down or backwards.  
Do not expose the battery to flame  
or to excessive heat.  
Do not immerse in or expose to  
water.  
AObserve proper precautions when  
handling the charger  
Keep dry. Failure to observe this  
precaution could result in injury or  
product malfunction due to fire or  
electric shock.  
Replace the terminal cover when  
transporting the battery. Do not  
transport or store the battery with  
metal objects such as necklaces or  
hairpins.  
Batteries are prone to leakage when  
fully discharged. To avoid damage  
to the product, be sure to remove  
the battery when no charge  
remains.  
Do not short the charger terminals.  
Failure to observe this precaution  
could result in overheating and  
damage to the charger.  
Dust on or near the metal parts of  
the plug should be removed with a  
dry cloth. Continued use could  
result in fire.  
xv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Do not handle the power cable or AUse appropriate cables  
go near the charger during  
When connecting cables to the input  
thunderstorms. Failure to observe  
this precaution could result in  
electric shock.  
and output jacks, use only the cables  
provided or sold by Nikon for the  
purpose to maintain compliance with  
product regulations.  
Do not damage, modify, or forcibly  
tug or bend the power cable. Do  
not place it under heavy objects or  
expose it to heat or flame. Should  
the insulation be damaged and the  
wires become exposed, take the  
power cable to a Nikon-authorized  
service representative for  
inspection. Failure to observe this  
precaution could result in fire or  
electric shock.  
Do not handle the plug or charger  
with wet hands. Failure to observe  
this precaution could result in injury  
or product malfunction due to fire  
or electric shock.  
ACD-ROMs  
CD-ROMs containing software or  
manuals should not be played back  
on audio CD equipment. Playing CD-  
ROMs on an audio CD player could  
cause hearing loss or damage the  
equipment.  
AFollow the directions of airline and  
hospital personnel  
This camera transmits radio  
frequencies that could interfere with  
medical equipment or aircraft  
navigation. Disable the wireless  
network feature and remove all  
wireless accessories from the camera  
before boarding an aircraft, and turn  
the camera off during take off and  
landing. In medical facilities, follow  
staff instructions regarding the use of  
wireless devices.  
Do not use with travel converters or  
adapters designed to convert from  
one voltage to another or with DC-  
to-AC inverters. Failure to observe  
this precaution could damage the  
product or cause overheating or fire.  
xvi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
No part of the manuals included with Nikon will not be held liable for any  
this product may be reproduced,  
transmitted, transcribed, stored in a  
retrieval system, or translated into  
any language in any form, by any  
damages resulting from the use of  
this product.  
While every effort has been made to  
ensure that the information in these  
means, without Nikon’s prior written manuals is accurate and complete,  
permission.  
we would appreciate it were you to  
bring any errors or omissions to the  
attention of the Nikon  
representative in your area (address  
provided separately).  
Nikon reserves the right to change  
the specifications of the hardware  
and software described in these  
manuals at any time and without  
prior notice.  
Notice for Customers in Canada  
CAN ICES-3 B / NMB-3 B  
Notices for Customers in Europe  
CAUTION: RISK OF EXPLOSION IF BATTERY IS REPLACED BY AN INCORRECT  
TYPE. DISPOSE OF USED BATTERIES ACCORDING TO THE INSTRUCTIONS.  
This symbol indicates  
that electrical and  
electronic equipment is  
to be collected  
This symbol on the  
battery indicates that the  
battery is to be collected  
separately.  
separately.  
The following apply only  
to users in European  
The following apply only  
to users in European countries:  
This product is designated for  
separate collection at an  
countries:  
All batteries, whether marked with  
this symbol or not, are designated  
appropriate collection point. Do not for separate collection at an  
dispose of as household waste.  
Separate collection and recycling  
helps conserve natural resources  
appropriate collection point. Do not  
dispose of as household waste.  
For more information, contact the  
and prevent negative consequences retailer or the local authorities in  
for human health and the  
charge of waste management.  
environment that might result from  
incorrect disposal.  
For more information, contact the  
retailer or the local authorities in  
charge of waste management.  
xvii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices for Customers in the U.S.A.  
Power Cable  
At voltages over AC 125 V (U.S.A. only): The power cable must be rated for the  
voltage in use, be at least AWG no. 18 gauge, and have SVG insulation or  
better with a NEMA 6P-15 plug rated for AC 250 V 15 A.  
Federal Communications Commission (FCC) Radio Frequency Interference Statement  
This equipment has been tested and  
found to comply with the limits for a  
Class B digital device, pursuant to Part  
15 of the FCC rules. These limits are  
designed to provide reasonable  
protection against harmful  
interference in a residential  
CAUTIONS  
Modifications  
The FCC requires the user be notified  
that any changes or modifications  
made to this device that are not  
expressly approved by Nikon  
Corporation may void the user’s  
authority to operate the equipment.  
installation. This equipment  
generates, uses, and can radiate radio  
frequency energy and, if not installed  
and used in accordance with the  
instructions, may cause harmful  
interference to radio  
communications. However, there is  
no guarantee that interference will  
not occur in a particular installation. If  
this equipment does cause harmful  
interference to radio or television  
reception, which can be determined  
by turning the equipment off and on,  
the user is encouraged to try to  
correct the interference by one or  
more of the following measures:  
Reorient or relocate the receiving  
antenna.  
Interface Cables  
Use the interface cables sold or  
provided by Nikon for your  
equipment. Using other interface  
cables may exceed the limits of Class  
B Part 15 of the FCC rules.  
Notice for Customers in the State of California  
WARNING: Handling the cord on this  
product may expose you to lead, a  
chemical known to the State of  
California to cause birth defects or  
other reproductive harm. Wash hands  
after handling.  
Increase the separation between the  
equipment and receiver.  
Connect the equipment into an  
outlet on a circuit different from that  
to which the receiver is connected.  
Consult the dealer or an  
Nikon Inc., 1300 Walt Whitman Road,  
Melville, New York 11747-3064, U.S.A.  
Tel.: 631-547-4200  
experienced radio/television  
technician for help.  
xviii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice Concerning Prohibition of Copying or Reproduction  
Note that simply being in possession of material that has been digitally  
copied or reproduced by means of a scanner, digital camera, or other device  
may be punishable by law.  
Items prohibited by law from being copied Cautions on certain copies and  
or reproduced  
reproductions  
Do not copy or reproduce paper  
The government has issued cautions  
money, coins, securities, government on copies or reproductions of  
bonds, or local government bonds,  
even if such copies or reproductions  
are stamped “Sample.”  
securities issued by private  
companies (shares, bills, checks, gift  
certificates, etc.), commuter passes, or  
coupon tickets, except when a  
minimum of necessary copies are to  
be provided for business use by a  
company. Also, do not copy or  
reproduce passports issued by the  
government, licenses issued by public  
agencies and private groups, ID cards,  
and tickets, such as passes and meal  
coupons.  
The copying or reproduction of  
paper money, coins, or securities  
which are circulated in a foreign  
country is prohibited.  
Unless the prior permission of the  
government has been obtained, the  
copying or reproduction of unused  
postage stamps or post cards issued  
by the government is prohibited.  
Comply with copyright notices  
The copying or reproduction of  
stamps issued by the government  
and of certified documents  
The copying or reproduction of  
copyrighted creative works such as  
books, music, paintings, woodcuts,  
prints, maps, drawings, movies, and  
photographs is governed by national  
and international copyright laws. Do  
not use this product for the purpose  
of making illegal copies or to infringe  
copyright laws.  
stipulated by law is prohibited.  
xix  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Disposing of Data Storage Devices  
Please note that deleting images or formatting memory cards or other data  
storage devices does not completely erase the original image data. Deleted  
files can sometimes be recovered from discarded storage devices using  
commercially available software, potentially resulting in the malicious use of  
personal image data. Ensuring the privacy of such data is the user’s  
responsibility.  
Before discarding a data storage device or transferring ownership to another  
person, erase all data using commercial deletion software, or format the  
device and then completely refill it with images containing no private  
information (for example, pictures of empty sky). Be sure to also replace any  
pictures selected for preset manual (0162). Before discarding the camera or  
transferring ownership to another person, you should also use the Wi-Fi >  
Network settings > Reset network settings (0288) and Network >  
Network settings options in the camera setup menu to delete any personal  
network information. For more information on the Network menu, see the  
documentation provided with the optional communication unit. Care should  
be taken to avoid injury when physically destroying data storage devices.  
xx  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AVC Patent Portfolio License  
THIS PRODUCT IS LICENSED UNDER THE AVC PATENT PORTFOLIO LICENSE FOR THE PERSONAL  
AND NON-COMMERCIAL USE OF A CONSUMER TO (i) ENCODE VIDEO IN COMPLIANCE WITH  
THE AVC STANDARD (“AVC VIDEO”) AND/OR (ii) DECODE AVC VIDEO THAT WAS ENCODED  
BY A CONSUMER ENGAGED IN A PERSONAL AND NON-COMMERCIAL ACTIVITY AND/OR WAS  
OBTAINED FROM A VIDEO PROVIDER LICENSED TO PROVIDE AVC VIDEO. NO LICENSE IS  
GRANTED OR SHALL BE IMPLIED FOR ANY OTHER USE. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION MAY BE  
OBTAINED FROM MPEG LA, L.L.C. SEE http://www.mpegla.com  
xxi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Use Only Nikon Brand Electronic Accessories  
Nikon cameras are designed to the highest standards and include complex  
electronic circuitry. Only Nikon brand electronic accessories (including  
chargers, batteries, AC adapters, and flash accessories) certified by Nikon  
specifically for use with this Nikon digital camera are engineered and proven  
to operate within the operational and safety requirements of this electronic  
circuitry.  
The use of non-Nikon electronic accessories could damage  
the camera and may void your Nikon warranty. The use of  
third-party rechargeable Li-ion batteries not bearing the  
Nikon holographic seal shown at right could interfere with  
normal operation of the camera or result in the batteries overheating,  
igniting, rupturing, or leaking.  
For more information about Nikon brand accessories, contact a local  
authorized Nikon dealer.  
xxii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DUse Only Nikon Brand Accessories  
Only Nikon brand accessories certified by Nikon specifically for use  
with your Nikon digital camera are engineered and proven to operate  
within its operational and safety requirements. THE USE OF NON-NIKON  
ACCESSORIES COULD DAMAGE YOUR CAMERA AND MAY VOID YOUR NIKON  
WARRANTY.  
ABefore Taking Important Pictures  
Before taking pictures on important occasions (such as at weddings or  
before taking the camera on a trip), take a test shot to ensure that the  
camera is functioning normally. Nikon will not be held liable for  
damages or lost profits that may result from product malfunction.  
ALife-Long Learning  
As part of Nikon’s “Life-Long Learning” commitment to ongoing  
product support and education, continually-updated information is  
available on-line at the following sites:  
For users in the U.S.A.: http://www.nikonusa.com/  
For users in Europe and Africa: http://www.europe-nikon.com/support/  
For users in Asia, Oceania, and the Middle East: http://www.nikon-asia.com/  
Visit these sites to keep up-to-date with the latest product information,  
tips, answers to frequently-asked questions (FAQs), and general advice  
on digital imaging and photography. Additional information may be  
available from the Nikon representative in your area. See the following  
URL for contact information: http://imaging.nikon.com/  
xxiii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Wireless  
This product, which contains encryption software developed in the United  
States, is controlled by the United States Export Administration Regulations  
and may not be exported or re-exported to any country to which the United  
States embargoes goods. The following countries are currently subject to  
embargo: Cuba, Iran, North Korea, Sudan, and Syria.  
The use of wireless devices may be prohibited in some countries or regions.  
Contact a Nikon-authorized service representative before using the wireless  
features of this product outside the country of purchase.  
Notices for Customers in the U. S. A.  
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the  
following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause harmful interference,  
and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including  
interference that may cause undesired operation.  
FCC WARNING  
The FCC requires the user to be notified that any changes or modifications  
made to this device that are not expressly approved by Nikon Corporation  
may void the user’s authority to operate the equipment.  
FCC Radio Frequency Interference Statement  
Note: This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for  
a Class B digital device, pursuant to part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are  
designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a  
residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio  
frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the  
instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications.  
However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular  
installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or  
television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off  
and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or  
more of the following measures:  
Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.  
Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.  
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to  
which the receiver is connected.  
Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.  
Co-location  
This transmitter must not be co-located or operated in conjunction with any  
other antenna or transmitter.  
Nikon Inc., 1300 Walt Whitman Road, Melville, New York 11747-3064, U.S.A.  
Tel.: 631-547-4200  
xxiv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Notices for Customers in Canada  
CAN ICES-3 B / NMB-3 B  
This device complies with Industry Canada licence-exempt RSS standard(s).  
Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not  
cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference,  
including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.  
FCC/IC RF Exposure Statement  
The available scientific evidence does not show that any health problems are  
associated with using low power wireless devices. There is no proof, however,  
that these low power wireless devices are absolutely safe. Low power  
Wireless devices emit low levels of radio frequency energy (RF) in the  
microwave range while being used. Whereas high levels of RF can produce  
health effects (by heating tissue), exposure of low-level RF that does not  
produce heating effects causes no known adverse health effects. Many  
studies of low-level RF exposures have not found any biological effects. Some  
studies have suggested that some biological effects might occur, but such  
findings have not been confirmed by additional research. The D750, which is  
equipped with a LBWA1U5YR1 (FCC ID:VPYLBYR650 / IC ID:772C-LBYR650)  
wireless LAN module, has been tested and found to comply with FCC/IC  
radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment and  
meets the FCC radio frequency (RF) Exposure Guidelines in Supplement C to  
OET65 and RSS-102 of the IC radio frequency (RF) Exposure rules. Please refer  
to the SAR test report that was uploaded to FCC website.  
xxv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notices for Customers in Europe  
Hereby, Nikon Corporation, declares that the D750 is in  
compliance with the essential requirements and other relevant  
provisions of Directive 1999/5/EC. The declaration of conformity  
may be consulted at http://imaging.nikon.com/support/pdf/DoC_D750.pdf  
Notice for Customers in Singapore  
Trade Name:  
Model: D750  
This device complies with radio-frequency regulations. The content of  
certification labels not affixed to the device is given below.  
Complies with  
IDA Standards  
DA104328  
Security  
Although one of the benefits of this product is that it allows others to freely  
connect for the wireless exchange of data anywhere within its range, the  
following may occur if security is not enabled:  
Data theft: Malicious third-parties may intercept wireless transmissions to  
steal user IDs, passwords, and other personal information.  
Unauthorized access: Unauthorized users may gain access to the network  
and alter data or perform other malicious actions. Note that due to the  
design of wireless networks, specialized attacks may allow unauthorized  
access even when security is enabled.  
xxvi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
Getting to Know the Camera  
Take a few moments to familiarize yourself with camera controls  
and displays. You may find it helpful to bookmark this section  
and refer to it as you read through the rest of the manual.  
The Camera Body  
7 8  
9
10  
11  
6
12  
5
4
4
3
2
1
13  
14  
15  
1 Accessory shoe (for optional flash 8 Movie-record button ................... 68  
unit)...............................................433  
9 Sub-command dial .................... 363  
10 Power switch ............................. 5, 28  
11 Shutter-release button....... 36, 373  
2 Release mode dial ..................7, 103  
3 Release mode dial lock  
release ......................................7, 103  
12 E button  
4 Eyelet for camera strap  
Exposure compensation..... 143  
Two-button reset ................. 199  
5 Mode dial lock release.............6, 34  
6 Mode dial....................................6, 34 13 Focal plane mark (E) ............... 133  
7 Z/Q button  
Metering .................................140  
14 Main command dial................... 363  
15 Control panel....................................8  
Formatting memory cards...375  
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
The Camera Body (Continued)  
1
2
3
14  
15  
16  
4
5
6
17  
13  
18  
7
12  
10  
11  
8
9
1 Built-in flash................................. 180 11 D button  
Bracketing............ 203, 208, 212  
Flash mode.................... 180, 182 12 Mirror.................................... 109, 451  
2 M/Y button  
Flash compensation ............ 188  
3 Infrared receiver (front)............. 194  
4 Cover for accessory terminal ... 443  
5 Audio connector cover........73, 443  
13 Meter coupling lever ................. 480  
14 Accessory terminal..................... 443  
15 Headphone connector.................73  
16 Connector for external  
6 HDMI/USB connector  
microphone..........................73, 443  
cover........................... 266, 271, 277  
17 HDMI connector ......................... 277  
7 Lens release button.......................33  
18 USB connector  
8 AF-mode button...57, 59, 121, 125  
Connecting to  
a computer......................... 266  
Connecting to a printer ...... 271  
9
Focus-mode selector ...57, 120, 132  
10 Lens mounting mark ....................27  
AClose the Connector Cover  
Close the connector cover when the connectors are not in use. Foreign  
matter in the connectors can interfere with data transfer.  
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
1
2
1
3
4
13  
14  
12  
11  
5
6
10  
7
8
9
1 Stereo microphone........68, 71, 320 9 Battery-chamber cover ............... 26  
2 CPU contacts 10 Power connector cover ............. 445  
3 Lens mount ........................... 27, 133 11 Memory card slot cover .............. 26  
4 Contact cover for optional MB-D16 12 Pv button ................70, 92, 361, 372  
battery pack................................441  
13 AF-assist illuminator .................. 332  
Self-timer lamp ........................... 107  
Red-eye reduction lamp ... 181, 183  
5 Tripod socket  
6 AF coupling  
14 Body cap .................................... i, 442  
7 Fn button.....................114, 356, 370  
8 Battery-chamber cover latch ..... 26  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
The Camera Body (Continued)  
1
2
3
4
5
21  
20  
6
7
19  
18  
17  
16  
8
9
10  
15  
11  
12  
14  
13  
1 Viewfinder eyepiece ..............10, 29 14 Tilting monitor...............................17  
Viewing settings......................12  
Live view............................. 54, 66  
Viewing pictures......................37  
Full-frame playback............. 241  
2 Rubber eyecup............................ 107  
3 Diopter adjustment control ........29  
4 A button  
Using the AE/AF lock  
button....... 129, 141, 361, 373  
15 P button  
Changing shooting  
5 R (info) button................ 12, 64, 75  
6 Multi selector...........................19, 21  
7 J (OK) button ...............19, 21, 354  
8 Focus selector lock ..................... 127  
9 Memory card access lamp..36, 225  
10 Infrared receiver (rear)............... 194  
settings................................ 198  
Changing settings during live  
view/movie recording ... 61, 71  
Retouching pictures ............ 396  
16 W/S button  
Playback zoom out/  
thumbnails................ 243, 244  
ISO sensitivity........................ 134  
Auto ISO sensitivity  
control ................................. 136  
Two-button reset ................. 199  
11 Live view selector  
Live view photography..........54  
Movie live view ........................66  
12 a button .................................54, 66  
13 Speaker ............................................80  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
17 X/T button  
Playback zoom in..................255  
Image quality/size.......116, 118  
19 G button  
Menu ................................ 20, 300  
20 K button  
Playback........................... 37, 241  
21 O/Q button  
Delete............................... 38, 258  
Formatting memory cards.... 375  
18 L/U button  
Help............................................ 21  
Protect.....................................257  
White balance  
....................146, 149, 154, 156  
ALCD Illuminators  
Rotating the power switch  
toward activates the standby  
Power switch  
D
timer and control panel  
backlight (LCD illuminator),  
allowing the display to be read  
in the dark. After the power  
switch is released and returns to  
the ON position, the illuminators  
will remain lit for six seconds  
while the standby timer is active or until the shutter is released or the  
power switch is rotated toward  
D
again.  
AThe Speaker  
Do not place the speaker in close proximity to magnetic devices.  
Failure to observe this precaution could affect the data recorded on  
the magnetic devices.  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
The Mode Dial  
The camera offers the modes listed below. To choose a mode,  
press the mode dial lock release and rotate the mode dial.  
Mode dial  
Mode dial lock release  
e, f, g, and h modes:  
e—Programmed auto (089)  
f—Shutter-priority auto (090)  
g—Aperture-priority auto (091)  
h—Manual (093)  
Auto modes:  
i Auto (034)  
j Auto (flash off) (034)  
Scene modes (041)  
j and k modes (099)  
Special effects modes (046)  
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ANon-CPU Lenses  
Non-CPU (0427) lenses can be used only in modes A and M. Selecting  
another mode when a non-CPU lens is attached disables the shutter  
release.  
The Release-Mode Dial  
To choose a release mode, press the release mode dial lock  
release and turn the release mode dial to the desired setting  
(0103).  
Release mode dial lock release  
Release mode dial  
1 2 3 4 5  
6
7
1 S Single frame.............................103 5 M Qc (quiet continuous)  
shutter-release........................... 103  
2 T Continuous low speed ........103  
3 U Continuous high speed.......103  
4 J Quiet shutter-release ............103  
6 E Self-timer........................ 103, 106  
7 V Mirror up..................... 104, 109  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
The Control Panel  
5
6
1
7
8
2
3
9
10  
4
1 Shutter speed ..........................90, 93 5 Aperture stop indicator ......92, 431  
Exposure compensation  
6 Aperture (f-number).............. 91, 93  
Aperture (number of  
stops)......................................92, 431  
Bracketing increment....... 204, 209  
Number of shots in ADL  
bracketing sequence................ 212  
Number of shots per  
interval......................................... 225  
Maximum aperture (non-CPU  
lenses).......................................... 238  
PC mode indicator ..................... 444  
value............................................. 143  
Flash compensation value........ 188  
White balance fine-tuning ....... 150  
Color temperature............. 145, 154  
White balance preset  
number ........................................ 155  
Number of shots in exposure and  
flash bracketing sequence...... 203  
Number of shots in WB bracketing  
sequence ..................................... 208  
Number of intervals for interval  
timer photography ................... 225  
Focal length (non-CPU  
7 Memory card indicator  
(Slot 1)....................................31, 376  
8 Memory card indicator  
(Slot 2)....................................31, 376  
lenses) .......................................... 238  
2 ISO sensitivity indicator ............ 134  
Auto ISO sensitivity  
indicator ...................................... 137  
9 Exposure compensation  
indicator ...................................... 144  
10 Flash compensation  
3 Metering ....................................... 140  
indicator ...................................... 189  
4 ISO sensitivity .............................. 134  
Autofocus mode ......................... 121  
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
16  
17  
11  
12  
18  
13  
14  
15  
19  
11 Wi-Fi indicator .............................288 18 Number of exposures  
remaining...................................... 31  
12 Flash sync indicator....................345  
Number of shots remaining before  
memory buffer fills .......... 105, 492  
AF-area mode indicator ............ 126  
Preset manual white balance  
recording indicator ................... 157  
Time-lapse recording  
indicator ...................................... 233  
Manual lens number.................. 238  
Capture mode indicator............ 444  
HDMI-CEC connection  
13 Exposure/bracketing indicator  
Exposure ................................... 94  
Exposure compensation .....143  
Exposure/flash bracketing...203  
White balance bracketing...208  
ADL bracketing......................212  
14 Exposure/flash bracketing  
indicator.......................................203  
WB bracketing indicator ...........208  
ADL bracketing indicator..........212  
indicator ..................................... 280  
15 Battery indicator ........................... 30  
16 Multiple exposure indicator.....217  
17 Color temperature indicator ....152  
19 “k” (appears when memory  
remains for over 1000  
exposures)..................................... 31  
Note: Display shown with all indicators lit for illustrative purposes.  
ACamera Off Display  
If the camera is turned off with a battery  
and memory card inserted, the memory  
card icon and number of exposures  
remaining will be displayed (some memory  
cards may in rare cases only display this  
information when the camera is on).  
Control panel  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Viewfinder  
6
7
8
9
1
2
10  
3
4
5
11  
12 13 1415 16  
17  
1819 20 21  
22 23  
24 25  
26  
27 2829 30 31  
32  
1 Special effects mode  
indicator .........................................46  
6 Framing grid (displayed when On  
is selected for Custom Setting d7,  
Viewfinder grid display)... 341  
2 Monochrome indicator (displayed  
in % mode or when the  
7 Focus points.........36, 127, 329, 330  
Monochrome Picture Control or  
a Picture Control based on  
Monochrome is  
AF-area mode.............................. 126  
8 + NEF (RAW) indicator .............. 357  
9 1.2× DX crop................................ 111  
selected)................................47, 165  
10 Roll indicator  
3 AF area brackets.............29, 35, 247  
4 Low battery warning ....................30  
5 “No memory card” indicator.......33  
(portrait orientation)................ 359  
11 Roll indicator  
(landscape orientation) ........... 359  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
12 Focus indicator ............ 36, 129, 133 25 Flash sync indicator.................... 345  
13 Metering ..............................139, 140 26 Aperture stop indicator...... 92, 431  
14 Autoexposure (AE) lock.............141 27 Exposure indicator ....................... 94  
Exposure compensation  
display.......................................... 143  
15 Flexible program indicator......... 89  
16 Shutter speed ..........................90, 93  
Autofocus mode.................120, 121  
28 Flash compensation  
indicator ..................................... 188  
17 Aperture (f-number) ..............91, 93  
Aperture (number of  
29 Exposure compensation  
indicator ...................................... 144  
stops)..................................... 92, 431  
30 Auto ISO sensitivity  
18 HDR indicator...............................178  
indicator ...................................... 137  
19 ADL indicator ...............................176  
31 ISO sensitivity .............................. 134  
AF-area mode..................... 123, 125  
20 Exposure/flash bracketing  
indicator.......................................203  
WB bracketing indicator ...........208  
ADL bracketing indicator..........212  
32 Number of exposures  
remaining...................................... 31  
Number of shots remaining before  
memory buffer fills .......... 105, 492  
Preset manual white balance  
recording indicator ................... 157  
Exposure compensation  
21 ISO sensitivity indicator.............134  
22 “k” (appears when memory  
remains for over 1000  
exposures)..................................... 31  
23 Flash-ready indicator .......... 40, 339  
value............................................. 143  
Flash compensation value........ 188  
24 FV lock indicator..........................191  
Note: Display shown with all indicators lit for illustrative purposes.  
D No Battery  
When the battery is totally exhausted or no battery is inserted, the  
display in the viewfinder will dim. This is normal and does not indicate  
a malfunction. The viewfinder display will return to normal when a  
fully-charged battery is inserted.  
D The Control Panel and Viewfinder Displays  
The brightness of the control panel and viewfinder displays varies with  
temperature, and the response times of the displays may drop at low  
temperatures. This is normal and does not indicate a malfunction.  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
The Information Display  
Press the R button to display shutter  
speed, aperture, the number of  
exposures remaining, AF-area mode, and  
other shooting information in the  
monitor.  
R button  
12 3  
4
5
6
25  
24  
23  
22  
21  
20  
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
19 18 17 16 1514 13  
1 Shooting mode ..... 6, 34, 41, 46, 88 5 Aperture stop indicator ......92, 431  
2 Flexible program indicator..........89 6 Aperture (f-number).............. 91, 93  
Aperture (number of  
3 Flash sync indicator.................... 345  
stops)......................................92, 431  
Bracketing increment....... 204, 209  
Number of shots in ADL  
bracketing sequence................ 212  
Maximum aperture (non-CPU  
lenses).......................................... 238  
4 Shutter speed ..........................90, 93  
Number of shots in exposure and  
flash bracketing sequence...... 203  
Number of shots in WB bracketing  
sequence ..................................... 208  
Focal length (non-CPU  
lenses) .......................................... 235  
12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
7 Exposure indicator........................ 94 14 Copyright information .............. 385  
Exposure compensation  
15 “Clock not set” indicator .... 15, 381  
display..........................................143  
Bracketing progress indicator  
Exposure and flash  
bracketing...........................203  
WB bracketing.......................208  
16 Image quality .............................. 116  
Role played by card in slot 2 .... 119  
17 Image size..................................... 118  
18 Autofocus mode ......................... 121  
19 Pv button assignment ............... 361  
20 Active D-Lighting indicator...... 176  
8 Picture Control indicator...........166  
9 White balance..............................146  
White balance fine-tuning  
21 Release mode ..........................7, 103  
Continuous shooting speed..... 338  
indicator.......................................150  
22 Image area indicator.................. 112  
10 HDR indicator...............................178  
HDR strength ...............................178  
Multiple exposure indicator.....219  
23 Metering ....................................... 139  
24 Exposure and flash bracketing  
indicator ...................................... 203  
WB bracketing indicator ........... 208  
ADL bracketing indicator.......... 212  
11 “Beep” indicator ..........................338  
12 “k” (appears when memory  
remains for over 1000  
exposures)..................................... 31  
25 ADL bracketing amount............ 213  
13 Image comment indicator........384  
ATurning the Monitor Off  
To clear shooting information from the monitor, press the R button  
again or press the shutter-release button halfway. The monitor will  
turn off automatically if no operations are performed for about  
10 seconds.  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Information Display (Continued)  
262728293031 32 33  
34  
43  
42  
41  
35  
36  
40  
39 38  
37  
26 Wi-Fi connection indicator....... 288 36 Number of exposures  
Eye-Fi connection indicator ..... 392  
remaining ......................................31  
Time-lapse recording  
indicator ...................................... 233  
27 Satellite signal indicator ........... 240  
28 Long exposure noise reduction  
37 Fn button assignment ............... 356  
38 AE-L/AF-L button assignment ... 361  
39 AF-area mode indicator............ 126  
40 Flash mode ......................... 180, 182  
41 FV lock indicator ......................... 191  
indicator ...................................... 317  
29 Vignette control indicator ........ 315  
30 Auto distortion control ............. 316  
31 Exposure delay mode................ 339  
32 Interval timer indicator ............. 222  
Time-lapse indicator.................. 229 42 Flash compensation  
Remote control mode  
(ML-L3)......................................... 193  
indicator ...................................... 188  
Flash compensation value ....... 188  
33 MB-D16 battery type display... 344 43 Exposure compensation  
MB-D16 battery indicator......... 343  
indicator ...................................... 144  
Exposure compensation  
value............................................. 143  
34 Camera battery indicator.............30  
35 ISO sensitivity indicator ............ 134  
ISO sensitivity .............................. 134  
Auto ISO sensitivity  
indicator ...................................... 137  
Note: Display shown with all indicators lit for illustrative purposes.  
14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ASee Also  
For information on choosing how long the monitor stays on, see  
Custom Setting c4 (Monitor off delay, 0337). For information on  
changing the color of the lettering in the information display, see  
Custom Setting d9 (Information display, 0341).  
AThe Y (“Clock Not Set”) Icon  
The camera clock is powered by an independent, rechargeable power  
source, which is charged as necessary when the main battery is  
installed or the camera is powered by an optional power connector  
and AC adapter (0441). Two days of charging will power the clock for  
about three months. If the camera displays a warning stating that the  
clock is reset and a Y icon flashes in the information display, the clock  
has been reset and the date and time recorded with new photographs  
will not be correct. Use the Time zone and date > Date and time  
option in the setup menu to set the clock to the correct time and date  
The camera clock is less accurate than most watches and household  
clocks. Check the clock regularly against more accurate time pieces  
and reset as necessary.  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
The P button  
Use the P button for quick access to  
frequently-used settings in playback  
mode (0245) and during viewfinder  
(0198) and live view photography  
(061) and movie live view (071).  
P button  
Viewfinder photography  
Playback  
Live view photography  
Movie live view  
16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Using the Tilting Monitor  
The monitor can be angled and rotated as shown below.  
Approx.  
75 °  
Approx. 90 °  
Normal use: The monitor is  
normally used in storage  
position.  
Low-angle shots: Take shots with  
the camera held low.  
High-angle shots: Take shots with  
the camera held high.  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
DUsing the Monitor  
Rotate the monitor gently within the limits shown on page 17. Do not  
use force. Failure to observe these precautions could damage the  
camera or monitor. If the camera is mounted on a tripod, care should  
be taken to ensure that the monitor does not contact the tripod.  
Do not lift or carry the camera by the monitor. Failure to observe this  
precaution could damage the camera. If the monitor is not being  
used to take photographs, return it to the storage position.  
Do not touch the area to the rear of the  
monitor or allow liquid to contact the inner  
surface. Failure to observe these  
precautions could cause product  
malfunction.  
Be particularly careful  
not to touch this area.  
18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Multi Selector  
In this manual, operations using the multi selector are  
represented by 1, 3, 4, and 2icons.  
1: Press the multi selector up  
J button  
4: Press the multi  
2: Press the multi  
selector left  
selector right  
3: Press the multi selector down  
19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Camera Menus  
Most shooting, playback, and setup  
options can be accessed from the camera  
menus. To view the menus, press the  
G button.  
G button  
Tabs  
Choose from the following menus:  
D: Playback (0300)  
B: Setup (0374)  
C: Photo Shooting (0310)  
1: Movie Shooting (0318)  
A: Custom Settings (0323)  
N: Retouch (0393)  
O/m: MY MENU or RECENT SETTINGS  
(defaults to MY MENU; 0421)  
Slider shows position in current  
menu.  
Current settings are shown by icons.  
Menu options  
Options in current menu.  
Help icon (021)  
20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Using Camera Menus  
❚❚ Menu Controls  
The multi selector and J button are used to navigate the  
camera menus.  
Move cursor up  
J button: select  
highlighted item  
Cancel and return to  
previous menu  
Select highlighted item or  
display sub-menu  
Move cursor down  
AThe d (Help) Icon  
If a d icon is displayed at the bottom left corner of the monitor, help  
can be displayed by pressing the L (U) button.  
A description of the currently selected option or menu will be  
displayed while the button is pressed. Press 1or 3to scroll through  
the display.  
L (U) button  
21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
❚❚ Navigating the Menus  
Follow the steps below to navigate the menus.  
1
Display the menus.  
Press the G button to display the  
menus.  
G button  
2
3
Highlight the icon for the  
current menu.  
Press 4to highlight the  
icon for the current menu.  
Select a menu.  
Press 1or 3to select the desired menu.  
4
Position the cursor in the  
selected menu.  
Press 2to position the  
cursor in the selected  
menu.  
22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5
6
7
8
Highlight a menu item.  
Press 1or 3to highlight a  
menu item.  
Display options.  
Press 2to display options  
for the selected menu item.  
Highlight an option.  
Press 1or 3to highlight  
an option.  
Select the highlighted item.  
Press J to select the highlighted item. To exit  
without making a selection, press the G button.  
Note the following:  
Menu items that are displayed in gray are not currently  
available.  
While pressing 2generally has the same effect as pressing J,  
there are some cases in which selection can only be made by  
pressing J.  
To exit the menus and return to shooting mode, press the  
shutter-release button halfway.  
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
First Steps  
Follow the seven steps below to ready the camera for use.  
1
Attach the strap.  
Attach the strap as shown. Repeat for the second eyelet.  
24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
2
Charge the battery.  
Insert the battery and plug the charger in (depending on the  
country or region, the charger comes with either an AC wall  
adapter or a power cable). An exhausted battery will fully  
charge in about two hours and 35 minutes.  
AC wall adapter: Insert the AC wall adapter into the charger AC  
inlet (q). Slide the AC wall adapter latch as shown (w) and  
rotate the adapter 90 ° to fix it in place (e). Insert the  
battery and plug the charger in.  
AC wall adapter latch  
90 °  
Power cable: After connecting the power cable with the plug  
in the orientation shown, insert the battery and plug the  
cable in.  
The CHARGE lamp will flash while the battery charges.  
Battery charging  
Charging complete  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3
Insert the battery and memory card.  
Before inserting or removing the battery or memory cards,  
confirm that power switch is in the OFF position. Insert the  
battery in the orientation shown, using the battery to keep  
the orange battery latch pressed to one side. The latch locks  
the battery in place when the battery is fully inserted.  
Battery latch  
If you are using only one memory card, insert it into slot 1  
(031). Slide the memory card in until it clicks into place.  
AThe Battery and Charger  
Read and follow the warnings and cautions on pages xiii–xvi and 457–459  
of this manual.  
26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
4
Attach a lens.  
Be careful to prevent dust from entering the camera when  
the lens or body cap is removed. The lens generally used in  
this manual for illustrative purposes is an AF-S NIKKOR 24–  
85mm f/3.5–4.5G ED VR.  
Remove the  
camera body cap  
M
M/A  
Remove the rear lens cap  
OFF  
ON  
Mounting mark (camera)  
Align the mounting  
marks  
Mounting mark (lens)  
M
M/A  
OFF  
ON  
Rotate the lens as shown until it clicks into place  
Be sure to remove the lens cap before taking pictures.  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
5
Turn the camera on.  
Power switch  
The control panel will light.  
If this is the first time the  
camera has been turned  
on, a language-selection  
dialog will be displayed.  
Control panel  
AImage Sensor Cleaning  
The camera vibrates the low-pass filter covering the image sensor  
to remove dust when the camera is turned on or off (0448).  
6
Choose a language and  
Move cursor up  
set the camera clock.  
Use the multi selector and  
J button to select a  
language and set the  
camera clock. When  
J button: select  
highlighted item  
Select highlighted  
item or display sub-  
menu  
setting the camera clock,  
you will be prompted to  
choose a time zone, date  
Move cursor down  
format, and daylight saving time option before setting the  
time and date; note that the camera uses a 24-hour clock.  
Language and date/time settings can be changed at any time  
using the Language (0381) and Time zone and date  
(0381) options in the setup menu.  
28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
7
Focus the viewfinder.  
Rotate the diopter  
adjustment control until  
the AF area brackets are  
in sharp focus. When  
operating the control  
with your eye to the  
viewfinder, be careful not to put your fingers or fingernails in  
your eye.  
AF area brackets  
Viewfinder not in focus  
Viewfinder in focus  
The camera is now ready for use. Proceed to page 34 for  
information on taking photographs.  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
❚❚ Battery Level  
The battery level is shown in the control panel and viewfinder.  
Control panel  
Viewfinder  
Control panel  
L
Viewfinder  
Description  
Battery fully charged.  
K
Battery partially discharged.  
J
I
Low battery. Charge battery or ready spare  
battery.  
H
d
H
(flashes)  
d
(flashes)  
Shutter release disabled. Charge or  
exchange battery.  
30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
❚❚ Number of Exposures Remaining  
The camera has two memory card slots:  
slot 1 and slot 2. Slot 1 is for the main  
card; the card in slot 2 plays a backup or  
secondary role. If the default setting of  
Overflow is selected for Role played by  
card in Slot 2 (0119) when two  
memory cards are inserted, the card in  
slot 2 will only be used when the card in  
slot 1 is full.  
Slot 1  
Slot 2  
The control panel shows the slot or slots  
that currently hold a memory card (the  
example at right shows the icons  
displayed when a card is inserted in each  
slot). If the memory card is full or locked  
or an error has occurred, the icon for the  
affected card will flash (0473).  
Control panel  
The control panel and viewfinder show  
the number of photographs that can be  
taken at current settings (values over  
1000 are rounded down to the nearest  
hundred; e.g., values between 1800 and  
1899 are shown as 1.8 k). If two memory  
cards are inserted, the displays show the  
space available on the card in Slot 1.  
Number of exposures  
remaining  
Control panel  
Viewfinder  
31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
❚❚ Removing the Battery and Memory Cards  
Removing the Battery  
Turn the camera off and open the  
battery-chamber cover. Press the battery  
latch in the direction shown by the arrow  
to release the battery and then remove  
the battery by hand.  
Removing Memory Cards  
After confirming that the memory card  
access lamp is off, turn the camera off,  
open the memory card slot cover, and  
press the card in and then release it (q).  
The card can then be removed by hand  
(w).  
GB  
16  
DMemory Cards  
Memory cards may be hot after use. Observe due caution when  
removing memory cards from the camera.  
Turn the power off before inserting or removing memory cards. Do  
not remove memory cards from the camera, turn the camera off, or  
remove or disconnect the power source during formatting or while  
data are being recorded, deleted, or copied to a computer. Failure to  
observe these precautions could result in loss of data or in damage to  
the camera or card.  
Do not touch the card terminals with your fingers or metal objects.  
Do not bend, drop, or subject to strong physical shocks.  
Do not apply force to the card casing. Failure to observe this  
precaution could damage the card.  
Do not expose to water, heat, high levels of humidity, or direct  
sunlight.  
Do not format memory cards in a computer.  
32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ANo Memory Card  
If no memory card is inserted, the control  
panel and viewfinder will show S. If  
the camera is turned off with a charged  
battery and no memory card inserted,  
S will be displayed in the control panel.  
AThe Write Protect Switch  
SD memory cards are equipped  
with a write protect switch to  
prevent accidental loss of data.  
When this switch is in the “lock”  
position, the memory card can not  
be formatted and photos can not  
G B  
1 6  
Write-protect switch  
be deleted or recorded (a warning will be displayed in the monitor if  
you attempt to release the shutter). To unlock the memory card, slide  
the switch to the “write” position.  
❚❚ Detaching the Lens  
Be sure the camera is off when  
removing or exchanging lenses. To  
remove the lens, press and hold the  
lens release button (q) while turning  
the lens clockwise (w). After removing  
the lens, replace the lens caps and  
camera body cap.  
DCPU Lenses with Aperture Rings  
In the case of CPU lenses equipped with an aperture ring (0429), lock  
aperture at the minimum setting (highest f-number).  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Basic Photography and Playback  
“Point-and-Shoot” Photography (i and j  
Modes)  
This section describes how to take photographs  
in i and j modes. i and j are automatic  
“point-and-shoot” modes in which the majority  
of settings are controlled by the camera in  
response to shooting conditions.  
Before proceeding, turn the camera on and  
select the desired mode by pressing the mode dial lock release  
and rotating the mode dial to i or j (the only difference  
between these two modes is that the flash will not fire in j  
mode).  
Mode dial  
Mode dial lock release  
34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
1
2
Ready the camera.  
When framing photographs in the  
viewfinder, hold the handgrip in your  
right hand and cradle the camera  
body or lens with your left.  
When framing photographs in  
portrait (tall) orientation, hold the  
camera as shown at right.  
Frame the photograph.  
Frame a photograph in the viewfinder  
with the main subject in the AF area  
brackets.  
AF area brackets  
AUsing a Zoom Lens  
Use the zoom ring to zoom in on  
the subject so that it fills a larger  
area of the frame, or zoom out to  
increase the area visible in the final  
photograph (select longer focal  
lengths on the lens focal length  
scale to zoom in, shorter focal  
lengths to zoom out).  
Zoom in  
Zoom ring  
M
M/A  
OFF  
ON  
Zoom out  
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3
Press the shutter-release  
button halfway.  
Focus point  
Press the shutter-release  
button halfway to focus (if  
the subject is poorly lit,  
the flash may pop up and  
the AF-assist illuminator  
may light). When the focus  
operation is complete, the  
active focus point and in-  
Focus indicator  
focus indicator (I) will appear in the viewfinder.  
In-focus  
indicator  
I
Description  
Subject in focus.  
F
Focus point is between camera and subject.  
Focus point is behind subject.  
H
F H  
(flashes)  
Camera unable to focus using autofocus. See page 131.  
4
Shoot.  
Smoothly press the  
shutter-release button the  
rest of the way down to  
take the photograph. The  
memory card access lamp  
will light and the  
photograph will be  
displayed in the monitor  
for a few seconds. Do not  
Memory card access  
lamp  
eject the memory card or remove or disconnect the power source  
until the lamp has gone out and recording is complete.  
36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Basic Playback  
1
Press the K button.  
A photograph will be displayed in the  
monitor. The memory card  
containing the picture currently  
displayed is shown by an icon.  
K button  
2
View additional pictures.  
Additional pictures can be  
displayed by pressing 4or  
2.  
To end playback and return to shooting mode, press the  
shutter-release button halfway.  
AImage Review  
When On is selected for Image review in the playback menu (0307),  
photographs are automatically displayed in the monitor for a few  
seconds after shooting.  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Deleting Unwanted Photographs  
To delete the photograph currently displayed in the monitor,  
press the O (Q) button. Note that photographs can not be  
recovered once deleted.  
1
Display the photograph.  
Display the photograph you wish to  
delete as described on the preceding  
page. The location of the current  
image is shown by an icon at the  
bottom left corner of the display.  
2
Delete the photograph.  
Press the O (Q) button. A  
confirmation dialog will be displayed;  
press the O (Q) button again to  
delete the image and return to  
playback. To exit without deleting  
the picture, press K.  
O (Q) button  
ASee Also  
See page 245 for information on choosing a memory card slot.  
38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ADelete  
To delete selected images (0260), all images taken on a selected date  
(0261), or all images in a chosen location on a selected memory card  
(0260), use the Delete option in the playback menu.  
AThe Standby Timer (Viewfinder Photography)  
The viewfinder indicator display and control panel shutter  
speed and aperture display will turn off if no operations  
are performed for about six seconds, reducing the drain on  
the battery. Press the shutter-release button halfway to  
reactivate the display. The length of time before the  
standby timer expires automatically can be selected using Custom  
Setting c2 (Standby timer, 0336).  
Exposure meters off  
Exposure meters on  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
AThe Built-in Flash  
If additional lighting is required for correct  
exposure in i mode, the built-in flash will  
pop up automatically when the shutter-  
release button is pressed halfway. If the flash  
is raised, photographs can only be taken  
when the flash-ready indicator (M) is  
displayed. If the flash-ready indicator is not  
displayed, the flash is charging; remove your  
finger briefly from the shutter-release  
button and try again.  
To save power when the flash is not in use,  
press it gently downward until the latch  
clicks into place.  
40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Matching Settings to the Subject or  
Situation (Scene Mode)  
The camera offers a choice of “scene” modes. Choosing a scene  
mode automatically optimizes settings to suit the selected  
scene, making creative photography as simple as selecting a  
mode, framing a picture, and shooting as described on pages  
The following scenes can be selected by rotating the mode dial  
to h and rotating the main command dial until the desired  
scene appears in the monitor. To view the currently selected  
scene, press R.  
Mode dial  
Main command dial  
Monitor  
Portrait  
Beach/snow  
Sunset  
k
l
p
m
n
o
r
s
t
u
v
w
x
Landscape  
Child  
Dusk/dawn  
Pet portrait  
Candlelight  
Blossom  
Sports  
Close up  
Night portrait  
Night landscape  
Party/indoor  
y
z
0
Autumn colors  
Food  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
k Portrait  
Use for portraits with soft, natural-  
looking skin tones. If the subject is  
far from the background or a  
telephoto lens is used, background  
details will be softened to lend the  
composition a sense of depth.  
l Landscape  
Use for vivid landscape shots in  
daylight.  
ANote  
The built-in flash and AF-assist  
illuminator turn off.  
p Child  
Use for snapshots of children.  
Clothing and background details are  
vividly rendered, while skin tones  
remain soft and natural.  
m Sports  
Fast shutter speeds freeze motion  
for dynamic sports shots in which  
the main subject stands out clearly.  
ANote  
The built-in flash and AF-assist  
illuminator turn off.  
42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
n Close Up  
Use for close-up shots of flowers,  
insects, and other small objects (a  
macro lens can be used to focus at  
very close ranges).  
o Night Portrait  
r Night Landscape  
Use for a natural balance between  
the main subject and the  
background in portraits taken under  
low light.  
Reduce noise and unnatural colors  
when photographing night  
landscapes, including street lighting  
and neon signs.  
ANote  
The built-in flash and AF-assist  
illuminator turn off.  
s Party/Indoor  
Capture the effects of indoor  
background lighting. Use for parties  
and other indoor scenes.  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
t Beach/Snow  
Capture the brightness of sunlight  
expanses of water, snow, or sand.  
ANote  
The built-in flash and AF-assist  
illuminator turn off.  
u Sunset  
Preserves the deep hues seen in  
sunsets and sunrises.  
ANote  
The built-in flash and AF-assist  
illuminator turn off.  
v Dusk/Dawn  
Preserves the colors seen in the  
weak natural light before dawn or  
after sunset.  
ANote  
The built-in flash and AF-assist  
illuminator turn off.  
w Pet Portrait  
Use for portraits of active pets.  
ANote  
The AF-assist illuminator turns off.  
44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
x Candlelight  
y Blossom  
z Autumn Colors  
0 Food  
For photographs taken by  
candlelight.  
ANote  
The built-in flash turns off.  
Use for fields of flowers, orchards in  
bloom, and other landscapes  
featuring expanses of blossoms.  
ANote  
The built-in flash turns off.  
Captures the brilliant reds and  
yellows in autumn leaves.  
ANote  
The built-in flash turns off.  
Use for vivid photographs of food.  
ANote  
For flash photography, press the M (Y)  
button to raise the flash (0182).  
APreventing Blur  
Use a tripod to prevent blur caused by camera shake at slow shutter  
speeds.  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Special Effects  
Special effects can be used when taking photographs and  
shooting movies.  
The following effects can be selected by rotating the mode dial  
to q and rotating the main command dial until the desired  
scene appears in the monitor. To view the currently selected  
effect, press R.  
Mode dial  
Main command dial  
Monitor  
Night vision  
Silhouette  
%
g
i
u
1
2
3
Color sketch  
High key  
Low key  
Miniature effect  
Selective color  
46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
% Night Vision  
Use under conditions of darkness to  
record monochrome images at high  
ISO sensitivities.  
ANote  
Pictures may be affected by noise in the  
form of randomly-spaced bright pixels,  
fog, or lines. Manual focus can be used if  
the camera is unable to focus. The built-  
in flash turns off.  
g Color Sketch  
The camera detects and colors  
outlines for a color sketch effect. The  
effect can be adjusted in live view  
(050).  
ANote  
Movies shot in this mode play back like a  
slide show made up of a series of stills.  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
i Miniature Effect  
Create photos that appear to be  
pictures of dioramas. Works best  
when shooting from a high vantage  
point. Miniature effect movies play  
back at high speed, compressing  
about 45 minutes of footage shot at  
1920 × 1080/30p into a movie that  
plays back in about three minutes.  
The effect can be adjusted in live  
view (051).  
ANote  
Sound is not recorded with movies. The  
built-in flash and AF-assist illuminator  
turn off.  
u Selective Color  
All colors other than the selected  
colors are recorded in black and  
white. The effect can be adjusted in  
live view (052).  
ANote  
The built-in flash turns off.  
1 Silhouette  
Silhouette subjects against bright  
backgrounds.  
ANote  
The built-in flash turns off.  
48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
2 High Key  
Use when shooting bright scenes to  
create bright images that seem filled  
with light.  
ANote  
The built-in flash turns off.  
3 Low Key  
Use when shooting dark scenes to  
create dark, low-key images with  
prominent highlights.  
ANote  
The built-in flash turns off.  
APreventing Blur  
Use a tripod to prevent blur caused by camera shake at slow shutter  
speeds.  
ANEF (RAW)  
NEF (RAW) recording is not available in %, g, i, and u modes.  
Pictures taken when an NEF (RAW) or NEF (RAW) + JPEG option is  
selected in these modes will be recorded as JPEG images. JPEG images  
created at settings of NEF (RAW)+JPEG will be recorded at the selected  
JPEG quality, while images recorded at a setting of NEF (RAW) will be  
recorded as fine-quality images.  
Ag and i Modes  
Autofocus is not available during movie recording. The live view  
refresh rate will drop, together with the frame rate for continuous  
release mode; using autofocus during live view photography will  
disrupt the preview.  
49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Options Available in Live View  
Settings for the selected effect are adjusted in the live view  
display but apply during live view and viewfinder photography  
and movie recording.  
❚❚ g Color Sketch  
1
Select live view.  
Press the a button. The view  
through the lens will be displayed in  
the monitor.  
a button  
2
Adjust options.  
Press J to display the options shown  
at right. Press 1or 3to highlight  
Vividness or Outlines and press 4  
or 2to change. Vividness can be  
increased to make colors more  
saturated, or decreased for a washed-  
out, monochromatic effect, while outlines can be made  
thicker or thinner. Increasing the thickness of the lines also  
makes colors more saturated.  
3
Press J.  
Press J to exit when settings are  
complete. To resume viewfinder  
photography, press the a button.  
The selected settings will continue in  
effect and will apply to photographs  
and movies recorded in live view or  
using the viewfinder.  
50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
❚❚ i Miniature Effect  
1
Select live view.  
Press the a button. The view  
through the lens will be displayed in  
the monitor.  
a button  
2
Position the focus point.  
Use the multi selector to position the  
focus point in the area that will be in  
focus and then press the shutter-  
release button halfway to check  
focus. To temporarily clear miniature  
effect options from the display and  
enlarge the view in the monitor for precise focus, press  
X (T). Press W (S) to restore the miniature effect  
display.  
3
4
Display options.  
Press J to display miniature effect  
options.  
Adjust options.  
Press 4or 2to choose the  
orientation of the area that will be in  
focus and press 1or 3to adjust its  
width.  
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
5
Press J.  
Press J to exit when settings are complete. To resume  
viewfinder photography, press the a button. The selected  
settings will continue in effect and will apply to photographs  
and movies recorded in live view or using the viewfinder.  
❚❚ u Selective Color  
1
Select live view.  
Press the a button. The view  
through the lens will be displayed in  
the monitor.  
a button  
2
3
Display options.  
Press J to display selective color  
options.  
Select a color.  
Selected color  
Frame an object in the white square  
in the center of the display and press  
1to choose the color of the object as  
one that will remain in the final  
image (the camera may have  
difficulty detecting unsaturated  
colors; choose a saturated color). To  
zoom in on the center of the display for more precise color  
selection, press X (T). Press W (S) to zoom out.  
52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4
5
Choose the color range.  
Color range  
Press 1or 3to increase or decrease  
the range of similar hues that will be  
included in the final image. Choose  
from values between 1 and 7; note  
that higher values may include  
hues from other colors.  
Select additional colors.  
To select additional colors,  
rotate the main command  
dial to highlight another of  
the three color boxes at  
the top of the display and  
repeat Steps 3 and 4 to  
select another color. Repeat for a third color if desired. To  
deselect the highlighted color, press O (Q). To remove all  
colors, press and hold O (Q). A confirmation dialog will be  
displayed; select Yes.  
6
Press J.  
Press J to exit when settings are complete. During shooting,  
only objects of the selected hues will be recorded in color; all  
others will be recorded in black-and-white. To resume  
viewfinder photography, press the a button. The selected  
settings will continue in effect and will apply to photographs  
and movies recorded in live view or using the viewfinder.  
53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Live View Photography  
Follow the steps below to take photographs in live view.  
1
Rotate the live view selector to C  
(live view photography).  
Live view selector  
DCover the Viewfinder  
To prevent light entering via the viewfinder from interfering with  
photographs and exposure, remove the rubber eyecup and cover  
the viewfinder with the supplied eyepiece cap before shooting  
2
3
Press the a button.  
The mirror will be raised and the view  
through the lens will be displayed in  
the camera monitor. The subject will  
no longer be visible in the viewfinder.  
a button  
Position the focus point.  
Position the focus point over your subject as described on  
page 57.  
54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
4
Focus.  
Press the shutter-release button  
halfway to focus.  
The focus point will flash green while  
the camera focuses. If the camera is  
able to focus, the focus point will be  
displayed in green; if the camera is  
unable to focus, the focus point will  
flash red (note that pictures can be  
taken even when the focus point  
flashes red; check focus in the  
A AE-L/AF-L button  
monitor before shooting). Exposure can be locked by  
pressing the A AE-L/AF-L button (0141); focus locks while the  
shutter-release button is pressed halfway.  
If exposure preview is enabled, the  
effects of shutter speed, aperture, ISO  
sensitivity, and exposure  
compensation (0143) can be  
previewed in the monitor as shown  
at right (note that although exposure  
can be adjusted by 5 EV, only values  
between –3 and +3 EV will be reflected in the preview  
display). To enable exposure preview, press the P button and  
select On for Exposure preview (062).  
5
Take the picture.  
Press the shutter-release button the  
rest of the way down to shoot. The  
monitor will turn off.  
55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
6
Exit live view mode.  
Press the a button to exit live view  
mode.  
ALive View Zoom Preview  
Press the X (T) button to magnify the view in the monitor up to a  
maximum of about 19 ×. A navigation window will appear in a gray  
frame at the bottom right corner of the display. Use the multi selector  
to scroll to areas of the frame not visible in the monitor or press  
W (S) to zoom out.  
X (T) button  
Navigation window  
AThe Standby Timer  
Regardless of the setting selected for Custom Setting c2 (Standby  
timer, 0336), the standby timer will not expire during live view  
photography.  
APreviewing Focus During Live View Photography (P, S, A, and M Modes Only)  
To temporarily select maximum aperture for an improved focus  
preview during live view photography, press the Pv button. To return  
aperture to its original value, press the button again or focus using  
autofocus. If the shutter-release button is pressed all the way down to  
take a picture during focus preview, aperture will return to the original  
value before the photo is taken.  
56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Focus  
To focus using autofocus,  
rotate the focus-mode  
selector to AF and follow the  
steps below to choose  
autofocusandAF-areamodes.  
For information on focusing  
Focus-mode selector  
❚❚ Choosing a Focus Mode  
The following autofocus modes are available during live view  
photography and movie live view:  
Mode  
AF-S  
Description  
Single-servo AF: For stationary subjects. Focus locks when  
shutter-release button is pressed halfway.  
Full-time servo AF: For moving subjects. Camera focuses  
AF-F continuously until shutter-release button is pressed. Focus  
locks when shutter-release button is pressed halfway.  
To choose an autofocus mode, press the AF-mode button and  
rotate the main command dial until the desired mode is  
displayed in the monitor.  
AF-mode button  
Main command  
dial  
Monitor  
57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                     
❚❚ Choosing an AF-Area Mode  
The following AF-area modes can be selected during live view  
photography and movie live view:  
Mode  
Description  
Face-priority AF: Use for portraits. The camera automatically  
detects and focuses on portrait subjects; the selected subject  
is indicated by a double yellow border (if multiple faces are  
detected, the camera will focus on the closest subject; to  
choose a different subject, use the multi selector). If the  
camera can no longer detect the subject (because, for  
example, the subject has turned to face away from the  
camera), the border will no longer be displayed.  
!
Wide-area AF: Use for hand-held shots of landscapes and other  
non-portrait subjects. Use the multi selector to move the focus  
point anywhere in the frame, or press J to position the focus  
point in the center of the frame.  
$
%
Normal-area AF: Use for pin-point focus on a selected spot in the  
frame. Use the multi selector to move the focus point  
anywhere in the frame, or press J to position the focus point  
in the center of the frame. A tripod is recommended.  
Subject-tracking AF: Use the multi selector to position the focus  
point over your subject and press J to start tracking. The  
focus point will track the selected subject as it moves through  
the frame. To end tracking, press J again. Note that the  
camera may be unable to track subjects if they move quickly,  
leave the frame or are obscured by other objects, change  
visibly in size, color, or brightness, or are too small, too large,  
too bright, too dark, or similar in color or brightness to the  
background.  
&
58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
To choose an AF-area mode, press the AF-mode button and  
rotate the sub-command dial until the desired mode is displayed  
in the monitor.  
AF-mode button  
Sub-command  
dial  
Monitor  
DUsing Autofocus in Live View Photography and Movie Live View  
Use an AF-S lens. The desired results may not be achieved with other  
lenses or teleconverters. Note that in live view, autofocus is slower and  
the monitor may brighten or darken while the camera focuses. The  
focus point may sometimes be displayed in green when the camera is  
unable to focus. The camera may be unable to focus in the following  
situations:  
The subject contains lines parallel to the long edge of the frame  
The subject lacks contrast  
The subject in the focus point contains areas of sharply contrasting  
brightness, or includes spot lighting or a neon sign or other light  
source that changes in brightness  
Flicker or banding appears under fluorescent, mercury-vapor,  
sodium-vapor, or similar lighting  
A cross (star) filter or other special filter is used  
The subject appears smaller than the focus point  
The subject is dominated by regular geometric patterns (e.g., blinds  
or a row of windows in a skyscraper)  
The subject is moving  
59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Manual Focus  
To focus in manual focus mode (0132),  
rotate the lens focus ring until the  
subject is in focus.  
To magnify the view in the monitor for  
precise focus, press the X (T) button.  
X (T) button  
60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Using the P Button  
The options listed below can be  
accessed by pressing the P button  
during live view photography. Highlight  
items using the multi selector and press  
2to view options for the highlighted  
item. After choosing the desired setting,  
press J to return to the P-button menu.  
Press the P button again to exit to the  
shooting display.  
P button  
Option  
Description  
Choose an image area for live view photography  
Choose image area  
Image quality Choose image quality (0115).  
Image size Choose image size (0118).  
Set Picture Control Choose a Picture Control (0165).  
Active D-Lighting Adjust Active D-Lighting (0175).  
Remote control  
Choose a remote control mode (0193).  
mode (ML-L3)  
61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Option  
Description  
Press 1or 3to adjust  
monitor brightness for live  
view photography (note  
that this affects live view  
only and has no effect on  
photographs or movies or  
on the brightness of the  
monitor for menus or  
Monitor  
brightness  
playback; to adjust the brightness of the monitor for  
menus and playback without affecting live view  
photography or movie live view, use the Monitor  
brightness option in the setup menu as described on  
Enable or disable exposure preview. If exposure  
preview is enabled, the effects of shutter speed,  
aperture, and ISO sensitivity on exposure can be  
previewed during live view photography.  
Exposure preview  
AExposure Preview  
When exposure preview is enabled,  
exposure can be adjusted by 5 EV (0143),  
although only values between –3 and +3 EV  
are reflected in the preview display. Note  
that the preview may not accurately reflect  
the final results when flash lighting is used,  
Active D-Lighting (0175), High Dynamic  
Range (HDR; 0177), or bracketing is in effect, A (auto) is selected for  
the Picture Control Contrast parameter (0168), or a value other than  
0 is selected for Clarity (0168), or v is selected for shutter speed.  
If the subject is very bright or very dark, the exposure indicators will  
flash to warn that the preview may not accurately reflect exposure.  
Exposure preview is not available in special effect modes or when  
A or % is selected for shutter speed.  
62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
The Live View Display: Live View Photography  
we  
q
r
t
Item  
Description  
0
The amount of time remaining before live  
view ends automatically. Displayed if  
shooting will end in 30 s or less.  
The current autofocus mode.  
q
Time remaining  
w
e
Autofocus mode  
AF-area mode  
The current AF-area mode.  
The current focus point. The display varies  
with the option selected for AF-area  
mode.  
r
Focus point  
When On is selected for Exposure  
preview, the exposure indicator shows  
the difference between the metered  
exposure and the exposure that will be  
achieved at current settings.  
t
Exposure indicator  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
The Information Display: Live View Photography  
To hide or display indicators in the monitor during live view  
photography, press the R button.  
Virtual horizon  
(0388)  
Information on  
Information off  
Histogram (exposure  
preview only; 062)  
Framing guides  
64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
DShooting in Live View Mode  
Although they will not appear in the final picture, jagged edges, color  
fringing, moiré, and bright spots may appear in the monitor, while  
bright bands may appear in some areas with flashing signs and other  
intermittent light sources or if the subject is briefly illuminated by a  
strobe or other bright, momentary light source. In addition, distortion  
may occur if the camera is panned horizontally or an object moves at  
high speed through the frame. Flicker and banding visible in the  
monitor under fluorescent, mercury vapor, or sodium lamps can be  
reduced using Flicker reduction (0380), although they may still be  
visible in the final photograph at some shutter speeds. When shooting  
in live view mode, avoid pointing the camera at the sun or other strong  
light sources. Failure to observe this precaution could result in  
damage to the camera’s internal circuitry.  
Movie recording is not available during live view photography and  
pressing the movie-record button has no effect. Select movie live view  
(066) to shoot movies.  
DThe Count Down Display  
A count down will be displayed 30 s before live view ends  
automatically (063; the timer turns red if live view is about to end to  
protect the internal circuits or, if an option other than No limit is  
selected for Custom Setting c4—Monitor off delay > Live view;  
0337—5 s before the monitor is due to turn off automatically).  
Depending on shooting conditions, the timer may appear  
immediately when live view is selected.  
AHDMI  
If the camera is attached to an HDMI video device during live view  
photography, the camera monitor will remain on and the video device  
will display the view through the lens.  
65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Movie Live View  
Movies can be recorded in live view.  
1
Rotate the live view selector to 1  
(movie live view).  
Live view selector  
2
Press the a button.  
The mirror will be raised and the view  
through the lens will be displayed in  
the camera monitor as it would  
appear in the actual movie, modified  
for the effects of exposure. The  
subject will no longer be visible in the  
viewfinder.  
a button  
AThe 0 Icon  
A 0 icon (074) indicates that movies can not be recorded.  
3
Choose a focus mode (057).  
66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
4
5
Choose an AF-area mode (058).  
Focus.  
Frame the opening shot and focus as  
described in Steps 3 and 4 on pages  
54 and 55 (for more information on  
focusing in movie live view, see page 59). Note that the  
number of subjects that can be detected in face-priority AF  
drops during movie recording.  
AExposure  
The following settings can be adjusted in movie live view:  
ISO  
Shutter  
speed  
Exposure  
compensation  
Aperture  
sensitivity  
Metering  
P, S  
A
M
h, %  
Other  
shooting  
modes  
In mode M, shutter speed can be set to values between 1  
/
25 s and  
1
/4000 s (the slowest available shutter speed varies with the frame  
rate; 0319). Spot metering is not available during movie live view.  
If the result is over- or under-exposed, exit and restart movie live  
view.  
67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AWhite Balance  
In modes P, S, A, and M, white balance can be set at any time by  
pressing the L (U) button and rotating the main command dial  
6
Start recording.  
Press the movie-record button to  
start recording. A recording indicator  
and the time available are displayed  
in the monitor. Exposure can be  
locked by pressing the A AE-L/AF-L  
Movie-record button  
button (0141) or altered by up to  
3 EV in steps of 1  
3 EV using  
/
Recording indicator  
exposure compensation (0143). In  
autofocus mode, the camera can be  
refocused by pressing the shutter-  
release button halfway.  
Time remaining  
AAudio  
The camera can record both video and sound; do not cover the  
microphone on the front of the camera during movie recording  
(03). Note that the built-in microphone may record sounds made  
by the camera or lens during autofocus, vibration reduction, or  
changes to aperture.  
68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
7
End recording.  
Press the movie-record button again  
to end recording. Recording will end  
automatically when the maximum  
length is reached, or the memory card  
is full.  
AMaximum Length  
The maximum length for individual movie files is 4 GB (for  
maximum recording times, see page 319); note that depending on  
memory card write speed, shooting may end before this length is  
reached (0491).  
DThe Count-Down Display  
A count down will be displayed 30 s before movie recording ends  
automatically (063). Depending on shooting conditions, the  
timer may appear immediately when movie recording begins.  
Note that regardless of the amount of recording time available, live  
view will still end automatically when the timer expires. Wait for  
the internal circuits to cool before resuming movie recording.  
8
Exit movie live view.  
Press the a button to exit movie live  
view.  
69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Indices  
If Index marking is selected as the  
“press” option for Custom Setting g1  
(Assign Fn button, 0370), g2 (Assign  
preview button, 0372), or g3 (Assign  
AE-L/AF-L button, 0373), you can press  
the selected button during recording to  
add indices that can be used to locate  
frames during editing and playback  
(080; note that indices can not be  
added in i mode). Up to 20 indices can  
be added to each movie.  
Pv button  
Index  
ASee Also  
Frame size, frame rate, microphone sensitivity, card slot, and ISO  
sensitivity options are available in the movie shooting menu (0318).  
Focus can be adjusted manually as described on page 60. The roles  
played by the J, Fn, Pv, and A AE-L/AF-L buttons can be chosen using  
Custom Settings f1 (OK button; 0354), g1 (Assign Fn button;  
0370), g2 (Assign preview button; 0372), and g3 (Assign AE-L/  
AF-L button, 0373), respectively (the last three options also allow  
you to lock exposure without having to keep a button pressed).  
Custom Setting g4 (Assign shutter button; 0373) controls whether  
the shutter-release button can be used to start movie live view or to  
start and end movie recording.  
70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Using the P Button  
The options listed below can be  
accessed by pressing the P button in  
movie live view (Microphone  
sensitivity, Frequency response, Wind  
noise reduction, Multi-selector power  
aperture, and Highlight display can be  
adjusted while recording is in progress).  
Highlight items using the multi selector  
and press 2to view options for the  
highlighted item. After choosing the  
desired setting, press J to return to the  
P-button menu. Press the P button  
again to exit to the shooting display.  
P button  
Option  
Description  
Choose image area Choose image area for movie live view (076).  
Frame size/  
frame rate  
Select a frame size and rate (0319).  
Movie quality Choose movie quality (0320).  
Press 1or 3to adjust  
microphone sensitivity  
(0320). Both the built-in  
and optional stereo  
microphones are affected.  
Microphone  
sensitivity  
Frequency  
response  
Control the frequency response of the built-in  
microphone or optional stereo microphones (0320).  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
Option  
Wind noise  
reduction  
Description  
Enable or disable wind noise reduction using the  
built-in microphone’s low-cut filter (0 321).  
Choose a Picture Control (0 321). The Clarity  
parameter does not apply to movies.  
When two memory cards are inserted, you can choose  
the card to which movies are recorded (0 319).  
Press 1 or 3 to adjust  
Set Picture Control  
Destination  
monitor brightness for  
movie live view (note that  
this affects live view only  
and has no effect on  
photographs or movies or  
Monitor  
brightness  
on the brightness of the  
monitor for menus or  
playback; 0 62).  
Select Enable to enable power aperture (P, S, A, and M  
modes only). Press 1 to narrow the aperture, 3 to  
widen the aperture.  
Multi-selector  
power aperture  
Choose whether the  
Highlights  
brightest areas of the  
frame (highlights) are  
shown by slanting lines in  
the display during movie  
live view. To access this  
option, select mode P, S, A,  
or M.  
Highlight display  
Press 1 or 3 to adjust  
headphone volume  
(0 73).  
Headphone  
volume  
72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
APower Aperture  
Power aperture is not available with some lenses. Power aperture is  
available only in modes A and M and can not be used while photo  
shooting info is displayed (a 6 icon indicates that power aperture can  
not be used).  
AUsing an External Microphone  
The optional stereo microphone can be used to record sound in stereo  
or to avoid recording focus noise and other sounds made by the lens  
(0443).  
AHeadphones  
Third-party headphones can be used. Note that high sound levels may  
result in high volume; particular care should be taken when  
headphones are used.  
ASee Also  
For information on assigning power aperture to the Fn and Pv buttons,  
see Custom Settings g1 (Assign Fn button, 0370) and g2 (Assign  
preview button, 0372). The Fn button can be used to widen the  
aperture, the Pv button to narrow the aperture.  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
The Live View Display: Movie Live View  
ui  
q
w
e
o
r
t
y
Item  
“No movie” icon  
Description  
0
q
w
Indicates that movies can not be recorded.  
Volume of audio output to headphones.  
Headphone volume Displayed when third-party headphones  
are connected.  
Microphone  
71,  
e
r
Microphone sensitivity.  
sensitivity  
Sound level for audio recording. Displayed  
Sound level  
in red if level is too high; adjust microphone 71  
sensitivity accordingly.  
71,  
72,  
t
y
u
i
o
Frequency response The current frequency response.  
Wind noise  
reduction  
Displayed when wind noise reduction is on.  
Time remaining  
(movie live view)  
The recording time available for movies.  
The frame size for movie recording.  
71,  
Movie frame size  
Highlight display  
indicator  
Appears when highlight display is enabled. 72  
74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
The Information Display: Movie Live View  
To hide or display indicators in the monitor during movie live  
view, press the R button.  
Virtual horizon  
(0388)  
Information on  
Information off  
Histogram  
Framing guides  
75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Image Area  
Movies and photographs recorded in movie live view (066)  
have an aspect ratio of 16 : 9.  
FX-format crop  
DX-format crop  
DX-based movie  
format crop  
FX-based movie  
format crop  
Images recorded with On selected for  
Image area > Auto DX crop in the  
movie shooting menu (0318) and a DX  
lens attached use a DX-based movie  
format, as do images recorded with DX  
(24×16) selected for Image area >  
Choose image area. Other images use  
an FX-based movie format. A a icon is  
a icon  
displayed when the DX-based movie format is selected. The  
approximate size of the area at the center of the image sensor  
used to record photographs taken in movie live view is 35.9 ×  
20.2 mm when the FX-based movie format is selected and 23.5 ×  
13.2 mm when the DX-based movie format is selected.  
76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Taking Photos During Movie Live View  
If Take photos is selected for Custom Setting g4  
(Assign shutter button, 0373), photographs can be  
taken at any time during movie live view by pressing  
the shutter-release button all the way down. If movie  
recording is in progress, recording will end and the footage  
recorded to that point will be saved. The photograph will be  
recorded at the current image area setting using a crop with an  
aspect ratio of 16 : 9. Image quality is determined by the option  
selected for Image quality in the photo shooting menu (0115).  
Note that the exposure for photographs can not be previewed  
during movie live view. For accurate results when shooting in  
mode M, adjust exposure in live view photography (093), then  
start movie live view and check the image area before beginning  
recording.  
AImage Size  
The following table shows the size of photographs taken in movie live  
view:  
Image area  
Option  
Large  
Medium  
Small  
Large  
Medium  
Small  
Size (pixels)  
6016 × 3376  
4512 × 2528  
3008 × 1688  
3936 × 2224  
2944 × 1664  
1968 × 1112  
Print size (cm/in.)*  
50.9 × 28.6/20.1 × 11.3  
38.2 × 21.4/15.0 × 8.4  
25.5 × 14.3/10.0 × 5.6  
33.3 × 18.8/13.1 × 7.4  
24.9 × 14.1/ 9.8 × 5.5  
16.7 × 9.4/ 6.6 × 3.7  
FX-based  
movie  
format  
DX-based  
movie  
format  
*Approximate size when printed at 300 dpi. Print size in inches equals image size in pixels  
divided by printer resolution in dots per inch (dpi; 1 inch = approximately 2.54 cm).  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
AHDMI  
If the camera is connected to an HDMI device (0277), the view  
through the lens will appear both in the camera monitor and on the  
HDMI device. To use live view when the camera is connected to an  
HDMI-CEC device, select Off for HDMI > Device control in the setup  
menu (0278).  
AWireless Remote Controllers and Remote Cords  
If Record movies is selected for Custom Setting g4 (Assign shutter  
button, 0373), the shutter-release buttons on optional wireless  
remote controllers (0197, 444) and remote cords (0443) can be used  
to start movie live view and to start and end movie recording.  
DRecording Movies  
Movies are recorded in the sRGB color space. Flicker, banding, or  
distortion may be visible in the monitor and in the final movie under  
fluorescent, mercury vapor, or sodium lamps or if the camera is panned  
horizontally or an object moves at high speed through frame (for  
information on reducing flicker and banding, see Flicker reduction,  
0380). Flicker may also appear while power aperture is in use.  
Jagged edges, color fringing, moiré, and bright spots may also appear.  
Bright bands may appear in some areas of the frame with flashing  
signs and other intermittent light sources or if the subject is briefly  
illuminated by a strobe or other bright, momentary light source. When  
recording movies, avoid pointing the camera at the sun or other strong  
light sources. Failure to observe this precaution could result in  
damage to the camera’s internal circuitry. Note that noise (randomly-  
spaced bright pixels, fog, or lines) and unexpected colors may appear  
if you zoom in on the view through the lens (056) during movie live  
view.  
Flash lighting can not be used during movie live view.  
Recording ends automatically if the mode dial is rotated.  
78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Viewing Movies  
Movies are indicated by a 1 icon in full-frame playback (0241).  
Press J to start playback; your current position is indicated by  
the movie progress bar.  
1 icon  
Length  
Current position/total length  
Movie  
progress  
bar  
Volume  
Guide  
The following operations can be performed:  
To  
Use  
Description  
Pause playback.  
Resume playback when movie is  
Pause  
Play  
J
paused or during rewind/advance.  
Speed  
increases with  
each press, from 2× to 4× to 8× to 16×;  
keep pressed to skip to beginning or  
end of movie (first frame is indicated by  
h in top right corner of monitor, last  
frame by i). If playback is paused,  
movie rewinds or advances one frame  
at a time; keep pressed for continuous  
rewind or advance.  
Rewind/  
advance  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
To  
Use  
Description  
Rotate the main command dial one stop  
to skip ahead or back 10 s.  
Skip 10 s  
Rotate the sub-command dial to skip to  
next or previous index, or to skip to the  
last or first frame if the movie contains  
no indices.  
Skip ahead/  
back  
(T)/  
W (S)  
Press (T) to increase volume,  
W (S) to decrease.  
X
X
Adjust volume  
Trim movie  
See page 81 for more information.  
P
Exit  
Exit to full-frame playback.  
/K  
Return to  
shooting  
mode  
Press the shutter-release button  
halfway to exit to shooting mode.  
AThe p Icon  
Movies with indices (070) are indicated  
by a p icon in full-frame playback.  
80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Editing Movies  
Trim footage to create edited copies of movies or save selected  
frames as JPEG stills.  
Option  
Description  
Create a copy from which the opening or  
closing footage has been removed.  
Choose start/end point  
Save selected frame  
9
4
Save a selected frame as a JPEG still.  
Trimming Movies  
To create trimmed copies of movies:  
1
2
Display a movie full frame (0241).  
Pause the movie on the new opening  
or closing frame.  
Play the movie back as described on  
page 79, pressing J to start and  
resume playback and 3to pause and  
pressing 4or 2or rotating the main  
or sub-command dial to locate the  
desired frame. Your approximate  
Movie progress bar  
position in the movie can be ascertained from the movie  
progress bar. Pause playback when you reach the new  
opening or closing frame.  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
3
Select Choose start/end point.  
Press the P button, then highlight  
Choose start/end point and press  
J.  
P button  
82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4
Choose the current frame as the  
new start or end point.  
To create a copy that begins from the  
current frame, highlight Start point  
and press J. The frames before the  
current frame will be removed when  
you save the copy.  
Start point  
To create a copy that ends at the current frame, highlight End  
point and press J. The frames after the current frame will be  
removed when you save the copy.  
End point  
5
Confirm the new start or end point.  
If the desired frame is not currently  
displayed, press 4or 2to advance  
or rewind (to skip to 10 s ahead or  
back, rotate the main command dial  
one stop; to skip to an index, or to the  
first or last frame if the movie  
contains no indices, rotate the sub-command dial).  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6
7
Create the copy.  
Once the desired frame is displayed, press 1.  
Preview the movie.  
To preview the copy, highlight  
Preview and press J (to interrupt  
the preview and return to the save  
options menu, press 1). To abandon  
the current copy and return to Step 5,  
highlight Cancel and press J; to  
save the copy, proceed to Step 8.  
8
Save the copy.  
Highlight Save as new file and press  
J to save the copy to a new file. To  
replace the original movie file with  
the edited copy, highlight Overwrite  
existing file and press J.  
84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ATrimming Movies  
Movies must be at least two seconds long. The copy will not be saved  
if there is insufficient space available on the memory card.  
Copies have the same time and date of creation as the original.  
AChoosing the Role of the Current Frame  
To make the frame displayed in Step 5 the new end point (x) instead of  
the new start point (w) or vice versa, press the L (U) button.  
L (U) button  
AThe Retouch Menu  
Movies can also be edited using the Edit movie option in the retouch  
menu (0393).  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Saving Selected Frames  
To save a copy of a selected frame as a JPEG still:  
1
Pause the movie on the desired  
frame.  
Play the movie back as described on  
page 79, pressing J to start and  
resume playback and 3to pause.  
Pause the movie at the frame you  
intend to copy.  
2
Choose Save selected frame.  
Press the P button, then highlight  
Save selected frame and press J.  
P button  
86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
3
4
Create a still copy.  
Press 1to create a still copy of the  
current frame.  
Save the copy.  
Highlight Yes and press J to create a  
fine-quality (0115) JPEG copy of the  
selected frame.  
ASave Selected Frame  
JPEG movie stills created with the Save selected frame option can not  
be retouched. JPEG movie stills lack some categories of photo  
information (0246).  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
P, S, A, and M Modes  
P, S, A, and M modes offer different degrees of  
control over shutter speed and aperture.  
Mode  
Description  
Programmed auto (089): Camera sets shutter speed and  
aperture for optimal exposure. Recommended for snapshots  
and in other situations in which there is little time to adjust  
camera settings.  
P
Shutter-priority auto (090): User chooses shutter speed; camera  
selects aperture for best results. Use to freeze or blur motion.  
Aperture-priority auto (091): User chooses aperture; camera  
selects shutter speed for best results. Use to blur background  
or bring both foreground and background into focus.  
Manual (093): User controls both shutter speed and aperture.  
Set shutter speed to Bulb (A) or Time (%) for long time-  
exposures.  
S
A
M
ALens Types  
When using a CPU lens equipped with an aperture ring (0429), lock  
the aperture ring at the minimum aperture (highest f-number). Type G  
and E lenses are not equipped with an aperture ring.  
Non-CPU lenses can only be used in modes A (aperture-priority auto)  
and M (manual), when aperture can only be adjusted using the lens  
aperture ring. Selecting any other mode disables the shutter release.  
For more information, see “Compatible Lenses” (0426).  
88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
P: Programmed Auto  
In this mode, the camera automatically adjusts shutter speed  
and aperture according to a built-in program to ensure optimal  
exposure in most situations.  
AFlexible Program  
In mode P, different combinations of shutter  
speed and aperture can be selected by  
rotating the main command dial while the  
exposure meters are on (“flexible program”).  
Rotate the dial to the right for large  
apertures (low f-numbers) that blur  
background details or fast shutter speeds  
Main command dial  
that “freeze” motion. Rotate the dial to the  
left for small apertures (high f-numbers) that  
increase depth of field or slow shutter  
speeds that blur motion. All combinations  
produce the same exposure. While flexible  
Viewfinder  
program is in effect, a O indicator appears in the viewfinder. To restore  
default shutter speed and aperture settings, rotate the main command  
dial until the indicator is no longer displayed, choose another mode, or  
turn the camera off.  
ASee Also  
See page 462 for information on the built-in exposure program. For  
information on activating the exposure meters, see “The Standby  
Timer (Viewfinder Photography)” on page 39.  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
S: Shutter-Priority Auto  
In shutter-priority auto, you choose the shutter speed while the  
camera automatically selects the aperture that will produce the  
optimal exposure.  
To choose a shutter speed, rotate the  
main command dial while the exposure  
meters are on. Shutter speed can be set  
to “v” or to values between 30 s and  
1
/
4000 s.  
Main command dial  
Control panel  
ASee Also  
See page 472 for information on what to do if flashing “A” or “%”  
indicator appears in the shutter-speed displays.  
90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
A: Aperture-Priority Auto  
In aperture-priority auto, you choose the aperture while the  
camera automatically selects the shutter speed that will produce  
the optimal exposure.  
To choose an aperture between the  
minimum and maximum values for the  
lens, rotate the sub-command dial while  
the exposure meters are on.  
Sub-command dial  
Control panel  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ANon-CPU Lenses (0427)  
Use the lens aperture ring to adjust  
aperture. If the maximum aperture of  
the lens has been specified using the  
Non-CPU lens data item in setup menu  
(0235) when a non-CPU lens is  
attached, the current f-number will be  
displayed in the viewfinder and control  
panel, rounded to the nearest full stop.  
Otherwise the aperture displays will show only the number of stops  
(F, with maximum aperture displayed as FA) and the f-number must  
be read from the lens aperture ring.  
ADepth-of-Field Preview  
To preview the effects of aperture, press and  
hold the Pv button. The lens will be stopped  
down to the aperture value selected by the  
camera (modes P and S) or the value chosen  
by the user (modes A and M), allowing depth  
of field to be previewed in the viewfinder.  
Pv button  
ACustom Setting e5—Modeling Flash  
This setting controls whether the built-in flash and optional flash units  
that support the Nikon Creative Lighting System (CLS; 0433) will emit  
a modeling flash when the Pv button is pressed. See page 353 for more  
information.  
92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
M: Manual  
In manual exposure mode, you control both shutter speed and  
aperture. While the exposure meters are on, rotate the main  
command dial to choose a shutter speed, and the sub-command  
dial to set aperture. Shutter speed can be set to “v” or to  
values between 30 s and 1  
4000 s, or the shutter can be held open  
/
indefinitely for a long time-exposure (A or %, 095).  
Aperture can be set to values between the minimum and  
maximum values for the lens. Use the exposure indicators to  
check exposure.  
Sub-command dial  
Aperture  
Shutter speed  
Main command dial  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
AAF Micro NIKKOR Lenses  
Provided that an external exposure meter is used, the exposure ratio  
need only be taken into account when the lens aperture ring is used to  
set aperture.  
AThe Exposure Indicators  
If a shutter speed other than “bulb” or “time” is selected, the exposure  
indicators in the viewfinder and control panel show whether the  
photograph would be under- or over-exposed at current settings.  
Depending on the option chosen for Custom Setting b2 (EV steps for  
exposure cntrl, 0333), the amount of under- or over-exposure is  
shown in increments of 1  
metering system are exceeded, the displays will flash.  
Custom Setting b2 set to 1  
3 step  
Underexposed by Overexposed by  
2 EV  
/
3 EV or 1  
/2 EV. If the limits of the exposure  
/
Optimal exposure  
1
/
3 EV  
Control panel  
Viewfinder  
ASee Also  
For information on reversing the exposure indicators so that negative  
values are displayed on the right and positive values on the left, see  
Custom Setting f8 (Reverse indicators, 0366).  
94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Long Time-Exposures (M Mode Only)  
Select the following shutter speeds for  
long time-exposures of moving lights,  
the stars, night scenery, or fireworks.  
Bulb (A): The shutter remains open  
while the shutter-release button is  
held down. To prevent blur, use a  
tripod or an optional wireless remote  
Length of exposure: 35 s  
Aperture: f/25  
Time (%): Start the exposure using the shutter-release button  
on the camera or on an optional remote control, remote cord,  
or wireless remote controller. The shutter remains open for  
thirty minutes or until the button is pressed a second time.  
Before proceeding, mount the camera on a tripod or place it on  
a stable, level surface. To prevent light entering via the  
viewfinder from appearing in the photograph or interfering with  
exposure, remove the rubber eyecup and cover the viewfinder  
with the supplied eyepiece cap (0107). Nikon recommends  
using a fully charged battery or an optional AC adapter and  
power connector to prevent loss of power while the shutter is  
open. Note that noise (bright spots, randomly-spaced bright  
pixels, or fog) may be present in long exposures; before  
shooting, choose On for Long exposure NR in the photo  
shooting menu (0317).  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
❚❚ Bulb  
1
Rotate the mode dial to M.  
Mode dial  
2
Choose a shutter speed.  
While the exposure meters are on,  
rotate the main command dial to  
choose a shutter speed of “Bulb”  
(A).  
Main command dial  
Control panel  
3
Take the photograph.  
After focusing, press the shutter-release button on the  
camera, optional wireless remote controller or remote cord  
all the way down. Remove your finger from the shutter-  
release button when the exposure is complete.  
96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
❚❚ Time  
1
Rotate the mode dial to M.  
Mode dial  
2
Choose a shutter speed.  
While the exposure meters are on,  
rotate the main command dial left to  
choose a shutter speed of “Time” (%).  
Main command dial  
Control panel  
3
4
Open the shutter.  
After focusing, press the shutter-release button on the  
camera or optional remote control, remote cord, or wireless  
remote controller all the way down.  
Close the shutter.  
Repeat the operation performed in Step 3 (shooting ends  
automatically if the button is not pressed after 30 minutes).  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AML-L3 Remote Controls  
If you will be using an ML-L3 remote control, select a remote control  
mode (Delayed remote, Quick-response remote, or Remote mirror-  
up) using the Remote control mode (ML-L3) option in the photo  
shooting menu (0193). Note that if you are using an ML-L3 remote  
control, pictures will be taken in “Time” mode even when “Bulb”/A  
is selected for shutter speed.  
98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
User Settings: U1 and U2 Modes  
Assign frequently-used settings to the U1 and U2 positions on the  
mode dial.  
Saving User Settings  
1
2
Select a mode.  
Rotate the mode dial to the  
desired mode.  
Mode dial  
Adjust settings.  
Make the desired adjustments to flexible program (mode P),  
shutter speed (modes S and M), aperture (modes A and M),  
exposure and flash compensation, flash mode, focus point,  
metering, autofocus and AF-area modes, bracketing, and  
settings in the shooting (0310, 318) and Custom Settings  
(0323) menus.  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
3
Select Save user settings.  
Press the G button to display the  
menus. Highlight Save user settings  
in the setup menu and press 2.  
G button  
4
5
Select Save to U1 or Save to U2.  
Highlight Save to U1 or Save to U2  
and press 2.  
Save user settings.  
Highlight Save settings and press J  
to assign the settings selected in  
Steps 1 and 2 to the mode dial  
position selected in Step 4.  
ASaved Settings  
Some photo and movie shooting menu settings are not stored. See  
pages 310 and 318 for more information.  
100  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recalling User Settings  
Simply rotate the mode dial to  
U1 to recall the settings  
Mode dial  
assigned to Save to U1, or to  
U2 to recall the settings  
assigned to Save to U2.  
Resetting User Settings  
To reset settings for U1 or U2 to default values:  
1
Select Reset user settings.  
Press the G button to display the  
menus. Highlight Reset user  
settings in the setup menu and press  
2.  
G button  
2
Select Reset U1 or Reset U2.  
Highlight Reset U1 or Reset U2 and  
press 2.  
101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
3
Reset user settings.  
Highlight Reset and press J.  
102  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Release Mode  
Choosing a Release Mode  
To choose a release mode, press the  
release mode dial lock release and turn  
the release mode dial to the desired  
setting.  
Mode  
Description  
Single frame: Camera takes one photograph each time shutter-  
release button is pressed.  
S
Continuous low speed: While shutter-release button is held down,  
camera records 1–6 frames per second. * Frame rate can be  
chosen using Custom Setting d2 (Continuous low-speed,  
0338). Note that only one picture will be taken if the flash  
fires.  
Continuous high speed: While shutter-release button is held down,  
camera records up to 6.5 frames per second. * Use for active  
subjects. Note that only one picture will be taken if the flash  
fires.  
T
U
Quiet shutter-release: As for single frame, except that mirror does  
not click back into place while shutter-release button is fully  
pressed, allowing user to control timing of click made by mirror,  
which is also quieter than in single frame mode. In addition,  
beep does not sound regardless of setting selected for Custom  
Setting d1 (Beep; 0338).  
J
Qc (quiet continuous) shutter-release: While shutter-release button is  
held down, camera records up to 3 frames per second. * Camera  
noise is reduced. Note that only one picture will be taken if the  
flash fires.  
M
E
Self-timer: Take pictures with the self-timer (0106).  
103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                     
Mode  
Description  
Mirror up: Choose this mode to minimize camera shake in  
telephoto or close-up photography or in other situations in  
which the slightest camera movement can result in blurred  
photographs (0109).  
V
* Average frame rate with an EN-EL15 battery, continuous-servo AF, manual or shutter-priority  
auto exposure, a shutter speed of 1  
200 s or faster, remaining settings (or in the case of T,  
/
remaining settings other than Custom Setting d2) at default values, and memory remaining in  
memory buffer. The stated rates may not be available under some conditions. Frame rates may  
drop at extremely small apertures (high f-numbers) or slow shutter speeds, when vibration  
reduction (available with VR lenses) or auto ISO sensitivity control (0136) is on, or when the  
battery is low, a non-CPU lens is attached, or Aperture ring is selected for Custom Setting  
f5 (Customize command dials) > Aperture setting (0364).  
104  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
AThe Memory Buffer  
The camera is equipped with a memory buffer for temporary storage,  
allowing shooting to continue while photographs are being saved to  
the memory card. Up to 100 photographs can be taken in succession;  
note, however, that the frame rate will drop when the buffer is full  
(tAA).  
The approximate number of images that  
can be stored in the buffer at current  
settings is shown in the exposure-count  
displays in the viewfinder and control  
panel while the shutter-release button is  
pressed. The illustration at right shows the  
display when space remains in the buffer  
for about 41 pictures.  
While photographs are being recorded to the memory card, the  
memory card access lamp will light. Depending on shooting  
conditions and memory card performance, recording may take from a  
few seconds to a few minutes. Do not remove the memory card or  
remove or disconnect the power source until the access lamp has gone  
out. If the camera is switched off while data remain in the buffer, the  
power will not turn off until all images in the buffer have been  
recorded. If the battery is exhausted while images remain in the buffer,  
the shutter release will be disabled and the images transferred to the  
memory card.  
ALive View  
If a continuous release mode is used during live view photography  
(054) or in movie live view (066), photographs will be displayed in  
place of the view through the lens while the shutter-release button is  
pressed.  
ASee Also  
For information on choosing the maximum number of photographs  
that can be taken in a single burst, see Custom Setting d3 (Max.  
continuous release, 0339). For information on the number of  
pictures that can be taken in a single burst, see page 492.  
105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Self-Timer Mode (E)  
The self-timer can be used to reduce camera shake or for self-  
portraits.  
1
2
Mount the camera on a tripod.  
Mount the camera on a tripod or place the camera on a  
stable, level surface.  
Select self-timer mode.  
Press the release mode dial  
lock release and turn the  
release mode dial to E.  
Release mode dial  
106  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
3
Frame the photograph and focus.  
In single-servo AF (0121), photographs can only  
be taken if the in-focus (I) indicator appears in  
the viewfinder.  
ACover the Viewfinder  
When taking photos without your eye to the viewfinder, remove  
the rubber eyecup (q) and insert the supplied eyepiece cap as  
shown (w). This prevents light entering via the viewfinder from  
appearing in photographs or interfering with exposure. Hold the  
camera firmly when removing the rubber eyecup.  
Rubber eyecup  
Eyepiece cap  
4
Start the timer.  
Press the shutter-release  
button all the way down to  
start the timer. The self-  
timer lamp will start to  
flash. Two seconds before the photograph is taken, the self-  
timer lamp will stop flashing. The shutter will be released  
about ten seconds after the timer starts.  
To turn the self-timer off before a photograph is taken, turn the  
release mode dial to another setting.  
107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
DUsing the Built-in Flash  
Before taking a photograph with the flash in modes that require the  
flash to be raised manually, press the M (Y) button to raise the flash  
and wait for the M indicator to be displayed in the viewfinder (0182).  
Shooting will be interrupted if the flash is raised after the self-timer has  
started. Note that only one photograph will be taken when the flash  
fires, regardless of the number of exposures selected for Custom  
Setting c3 (Self-timer; 0337).  
ASee Also  
For information on choosing the duration of the self-timer, the number  
of shots taken, and the interval between shots, see Custom Setting c3  
(Self-timer; 0337). For information on controlling the beeps that  
sound when the self-timer is used, see Custom Setting d1 (Beep;  
0338).  
108  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mirror up Mode (V)  
Choose this mode to minimize blurring caused by camera  
movement when the mirror is raised. To use mirror-up mode,  
press the release mode dial lock release and rotate the release  
mode dial to V (mirror up).  
Release mode dial lock release  
Release mode dial  
After pressing the shutter-release button halfway to set focus  
and exposure, press the shutter-release button the rest of the  
way down to raise the mirror and then press the shutter-release  
button all the way down again to take the picture. The mirror  
lowers when shooting ends.  
DMirror Up  
While the mirror is raised, photos can not be framed in the viewfinder  
and autofocus and metering will not be performed.  
AMirror up Mode  
A picture will be taken automatically if no operations are performed for  
about 30 s with the mirror raised.  
APreventing Blur  
To prevent blurring caused by camera movement, press the shutter-  
release button smoothly, or use an optional remote cord (0443). For  
information on using the optional ML-L3 remote control for mirror-up  
photography, see page 193. Use of a tripod is recommended.  
109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Image Recording Options  
Image Area  
Choose from image areas of FX (36 × 24) 1.0× (FX format), DX  
(24 × 16) 1.5× (DX format), and 1.2× (30 × 20) 1.2×. See page  
492 for information on the number of pictures that can be stored  
at different image area settings.  
FX format  
DX format (24×16)  
image circle  
DX format  
1.2×  
FX format (36×24)  
image circle  
110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
❚❚ Image Area Options  
The camera offers a choice of the following image areas:  
Option  
Description  
Images are recorded in FX format using the full  
area of the image sensor (35.9 × 24.0 mm),  
producing an angle of view equivalent to a  
NIKKOR lens on a 35mm format camera.  
A 29.9 × 19.9 mm area at the center of the image  
sensor is used to record photographs. To  
calculate the approximate focal length of the lens  
in 35mm format, multiply by 1.2. This option is  
not available in movie shooting menu.  
FX (36×24)  
1.0×  
(FX format)  
c
Z
1.2× (30×20)  
1.2×  
An area at the center of the image sensor 23.5 ×  
15.7 mm is used to record pictures in DX format.  
To calculate the approximate focal length of the  
lens in 35mm format, multiply by 1.5.  
DX (24×16)  
1.5×  
(DX format)  
a
❚❚ Automatic Crop Selection  
To automatically select a DX crop when a DX lens is attached,  
select On for Image area > Auto DX crop in the shooting menus  
(0310, 318). The image area selected in the shooting menus or  
with the camera controls will be used only when a non-DX lens is  
attached. Select Off to use the currently-selected image area  
with all lenses.  
DAuto DX Crop  
The controls listed on page 114 can not be used to select image area  
when a DX lens is attached and Auto DX crop is on.  
111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
AImage Area  
The selected option is shown in the  
information display.  
ADX Lenses  
DX lenses are designed for use with DX format cameras and have a  
smaller angle of view than lenses for 35mm format cameras. If Auto  
DX crop is off and an option other than DX (24×16) (DX format) is  
selected for Choose image area when a DX lens is attached, the edges  
of the image may be eclipsed. This may not be apparent in the  
viewfinder, but when the images are played back you may notice a  
drop in resolution or that the edges of the picture are blacked out.  
AThe Viewfinder Display  
The 1.2 × and DX format crops are shown below.  
1.2×  
DX format  
ASee Also  
See page 76 for information on the crops available in movie live view.  
112  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
The image area can be selected using the Image area > Choose  
image area option in the shooting menus or by pressing a  
control and rotating a command dial.  
❚❚ The Image Area Menu  
1
2
3
Select Image area.  
Highlight Image area in either of the  
shooting menus and press 2.  
Select Choose image area.  
Highlight Choose image area and  
press 2.  
Adjust settings.  
Choose an option and press J. The  
selected crop is displayed in the  
viewfinder (0112).  
AImage Size  
Image size varies with the option selected for image area (0118).  
113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
❚❚ Camera Controls  
1
Assign image area selection to a camera control.  
Select Choose image area as the “press + command dials”  
option for a camera control in the Custom Settings menu  
(0323). Image area selection can be assigned to the Fn  
button (Custom Setting f2, Assign Fn button, 0356), the Pv  
button (Custom Setting f3, Assign preview button, 0361),  
or the A AE-L/AF-L button (Custom Setting f4, Assign AE-L/  
AF-L button, 0361).  
2
Use the selected control to choose an image area.  
The image area can be  
selected by pressing the  
selected button and rotating  
the main or sub-command  
dial until the desired crop is  
displayed in the viewfinder  
Fn button Main command  
dial  
The option currently  
selected for image area can be  
viewed by pressing the button to  
display the image area in the control  
panel, viewfinder, or information display. FX format is  
displayed as “36 – 24, 1.2 × as “30 – 20, and DX format as  
“24 – 16.  
114  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Image Quality and Size  
Together, image quality and size determine how much space  
each photograph occupies on the memory card. Larger, higher  
quality images can be printed at larger sizes but also require  
more memory, meaning that fewer such images can be stored  
on the memory card (0492).  
Image Quality  
Choose a file format and compression ratio (image quality).  
Option  
File type  
Description  
Raw data from the image sensor are saved  
without additional processing. Settings such  
as white balance and contrast can be  
adjusted after shooting.  
NEF (RAW)  
NEF  
Record JPEG images at a compression ratio of  
roughly 1:4 (fine quality). *  
Record JPEG images at a compression ratio of  
roughly 1:8 (normal quality). *  
Record JPEG images at a compression ratio of  
roughly 1:16 (basic quality). *  
JPEG fine  
JPEG normal  
JPEG basic  
JPEG  
NEF (RAW)+  
JPEG fine  
Two images are recorded, one NEF (RAW)  
image and one fine-quality JPEG image.  
NEF (RAW)+  
JPEG normal  
NEF (RAW)+  
JPEG basic  
NEF/ Two images are recorded, one NEF (RAW)  
JPEG image and one normal-quality JPEG image.  
Two images are recorded, one NEF (RAW)  
image and one basic-quality JPEG image.  
* Size priority selected for JPEG compression. The compression ratio is an  
approximation only; the actual ratio varies with ISO sensitivity and the scene recorded.  
115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Image quality can be set by pressing the X (T) button and  
rotating the main command dial until the desired setting is  
displayed in the information display.  
X (T) button  
Main command  
dial  
Information display  
ANEF (RAW) Images  
NEF (RAW) images can be viewed on the camera or using software  
such as ViewNX 2 or Capture NX-D (ViewNX 2 can be installed from the  
supplied installer CD, while Capture NX-D can be downloaded from a  
link in the ViewNX 2 installer; 0262, 268). Note that the option  
selected for image size does not affect the size of NEF (RAW) images;  
when viewed on a computer, NEF (RAW) images have the dimensions  
given for large (#-size) images in the table on page 118. JPEG copies  
of NEF (RAW) images can be created using the NEF (RAW) processing  
option in the retouch menu (0406).  
ANEF+JPEG  
When photographs taken at settings of NEF (RAW) + JPEG are viewed  
on the camera with only one memory card inserted, only the JPEG  
image will be displayed. If both copies are recorded to the same  
memory card, both copies will be erased when the photo is deleted. If  
the JPEG copy is recorded to a separate memory card using the Role  
played by card in Slot 2 > RAW Slot 1—JPEG Slot 2 option, deleting  
the JPEG copy will not delete the NEF (RAW) image.  
AThe Photo Shooting Menu  
Image quality can also be adjusted using the Image quality option in  
the photo shooting menu (0310).  
116  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
❚❚ JPEG Compression  
To choose the type of compression for JPEG images, highlight  
JPEG compression in the photo shooting menu and press 2.  
Option  
Description  
Images are compressed to produce relatively  
uniform file size.  
Size priority  
O
P
Optimal image quality. File size varies with scene  
recorded.  
Optimal quality  
❚❚ Type  
To choose the type of compression for NEF (RAW) images,  
highlight NEF (RAW) recording > Type in the photo shooting  
menu and press 2.  
Option  
Description  
NEF images are compressed using a reversible  
algorithm, reducing file size by about 20–40%  
with no effect on image quality.  
NEF images are compressed using a non-  
reversible algorithm, reducing file size by about  
35–55% with almost no effect on image quality.  
Lossless  
compressed  
N
O
Compressed  
❚❚ NEF (RAW) Bit Depth  
To choose a bit depth for NEF (RAW) images, highlight NEF  
(RAW) recording > NEF (RAW) bit depth in the photo shooting  
menu and press 2.  
Option  
12-bit  
Description  
NEF (RAW) images are recorded at a bit-depth of  
12 bits.  
NEF (RAW) images are recorded at a bit depth of  
14 bits, producing files larger than those with a  
bit depth of 12 bits but increasing the color data  
recorded.  
q
r
14-bit  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Image Size  
Image size is measured in pixels. Choose from # Large,  
$ Medium, or % Small (note that image size varies depending  
on the option selected for Image area, 0110):  
Image area  
Option  
Large  
Medium  
Small  
Size (pixels)  
6016 × 4016  
4512 × 3008  
3008 × 2008  
5008 × 3336  
3752 × 2504  
2504 × 1664  
3936 × 2624  
2944 × 1968  
1968 × 1312  
Print size (cm/in.)*  
50.9 × 34.0/20.1 × 13.4  
38.2 × 25.5/15.0 × 10.0  
25.5 × 17.0/10.0 × 6.7  
42.4 × 28.2/16.7 × 11.1  
31.8 × 21.2/12.5 × 8.3  
21.2 × 14.1/ 8.3 × 5.5  
33.3 × 22.2/13.1 × 8.7  
24.9 × 16.7/ 9.8 × 6.6  
16.7 × 11.1/ 6.6 × 4.4  
FX (36×24)  
(FX format)  
Large  
1.2× (30×20) Medium  
Small  
Large  
DX (24×16)  
Medium  
(DX format)  
Small  
* Approximate size when printed at 300 dpi. Print size in inches equals image size in pixels  
divided by printer resolution in dots per inch (dpi; 1 inch=approximately 2.54 cm).  
Image size can be set by pressing the X (T) button and  
rotating the sub-command dial until the desired setting is  
displayed in the information display.  
X (T) button  
Sub command  
dial  
Information display  
AThe Photo Shooting Menu  
Image size can also be adjusted using the Image size option in the  
photo shooting menu (0310).  
118  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Using Two Memory Cards  
When two memory cards are inserted in the camera, you can use  
the Role played by card in Slot 2 item in the photo shooting  
menu to choose the role played by the card in Slot 2. Choose  
from Overflow (the card in Slot 2 is used only when the card in  
Slot 1 is full), Backup (each picture is recorded twice, once to the  
card in Slot 1 and again to the card in Slot 2), and RAW Slot 1—  
JPEG Slot 2 (as for Backup, except that the NEF/RAW copies of  
photos recorded at settings of NEF/RAW + JPEG are recorded  
only to the card in Slot 1 and the JPEG copies only to the card in  
Slot 2).  
A“Backup” and “RAW Slot 1—JPEG Slot 2”  
The camera shows the number of exposures remaining on the card  
with the least amount of memory. Shutter release will be disabled  
when either card is full.  
ARecording Movies  
When two memory cards are inserted in the camera, the slot used to  
record movies can be selected using the Destination option in the  
movie shooting menu (0319).  
119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Focus  
This section describes the focus options available when  
photographs are framed in the viewfinder. Focus can be  
adjusted automatically (see below) or manually (0132). The  
user can also select the focus point for automatic or manual  
focus (0127) or use focus lock to focus to recompose  
photographs after focusing (0129).  
Autofocus  
To use autofocus, rotate the  
Focus-mode selector  
focus-mode selector to AF.  
120  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Autofocus Mode  
The following autofocus modes can be selected during  
viewfinder photography:  
Mode  
Description  
Auto-servo AF: Camera automatically selects single-servo autofocus  
AF-A if subject is stationary, continuous-servo autofocus if subject is  
moving.  
Single-servo AF: For stationary subjects. Focus locks when shutter-  
release button is pressed halfway. At default settings, shutter can  
only be released when in-focus indicator (I) is displayed (focus  
AF-S  
priority; 0327).  
Continuous-servo AF: For moving subjects. Camera focuses  
continuously while shutter-release button is pressed halfway; if  
subject moves, camera will engage predictive focus tracking  
(0122) to predict final distance to subject and adjust focus as  
AF-C  
necessary. At default settings, shutter can be released whether or  
not subject is in focus (release priority; 0326).  
Autofocus mode can be  
selected by pressing the AF-  
mode button and rotating the  
main command dial until the  
desired setting is displayed in  
the viewfinder or control panel.  
AF-mode button Main command  
dial  
AF-A  
AF-S  
AF-C  
121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
APredictive Focus Tracking  
In AF-C mode or when continuous-servo autofocus is selected in AF-A  
mode, the camera will initiate predictive focus tracking if the subject  
moves toward or away from the camera while the shutter-release  
button is pressed halfway. This allows the camera to track focus while  
attempting to predict where the subject will be when the shutter is  
released.  
ASee Also  
For information on using focus priority in continuous-servo AF, see  
Custom Setting a1 (AF-C priority selection, 0326). For information  
on using release priority in single-servo AF, see Custom Setting a2  
(AF-S priority selection, 0327). See Custom Setting f5 (Customize  
command dials) > Change main/sub (0363) for information on  
using the sub-command dial to choose the focus mode. See page 57  
for information on the autofocus options available in live view or  
during movie recording.  
122  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
AF-Area Mode  
Choose how the focus point is selected during viewfinder  
photography.  
Single-point AF: Select the focus point as described on page 127;  
the camera will focus on the subject in the selected focus  
point only. Use with stationary subjects.  
Dynamic-area AF: Select the focus point as described on page  
127. In AF-A and AF-C focus modes, the camera will focus based  
on information from surrounding focus points if the subject  
briefly leaves the selected point. The number of focus points  
varies with the mode selected:  
-
9-point dynamic-area AF: Choose when there is time to  
compose the photograph or when photographing subjects  
that are moving predictably (e.g., runners or race cars on a  
track).  
-
-
21-point dynamic-area AF: Choose when photographing  
subjects that are moving unpredictably (e.g., players at a  
football game).  
51-point dynamic-area AF: Choose when photographing  
subjects that are moving quickly and can not be easily  
framed in the viewfinder (e.g., birds).  
123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
3D-tracking: Select the focus point as described on page 127. In  
AF-A and AF-C focus modes, the camera will track subjects that  
leave the selected focus point and select new focus points as  
required. Use to quickly compose pictures with subjects that  
are moving erratically from side to side (e.g., tennis players). If  
the subject leaves viewfinder, remove your finger from the  
shutter-release button and recompose the photograph with  
the subject in the selected focus point.  
Group-area AF: The camera focuses using a group of focus points  
selected by the user, reducing the risk of the camera focusing  
on the background instead of on the main subject. Choose for  
subjects that are difficult to photograph using a single focus  
point. If faces are detected in AF-S focus mode, the camera will  
give priority to portrait subjects.  
Auto-area AF: The camera automatically  
detects the subject and selects the  
focus point; if a face is detected, the  
camera will give priority to the portrait  
subject. The active focus points are  
highlighted briefly after the camera  
focuses; in AF-C mode or when  
continuous-servo autofocus is selected in AF-A mode, the main  
focus point remains highlighted after the other focus points  
have turned off.  
124  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
AF-area mode can be selected  
by pressing the AF-mode  
button and rotating the sub-  
command dial until the desired  
setting is displayed in the  
viewfinder or control panel.  
AF-mode button  
Sub-command  
dial  
Control panel  
Viewfinder  
A3D-tracking  
When the shutter-release button is pressed halfway, the colors in the  
area surrounding the focus point are stored in the camera.  
Consequently 3D-tracking may not produce the desired results with  
subjects that are similar in color to the background or that occupy a  
very small area of the frame.  
125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
AAF-Area Mode  
AF-area mode is shown in the control panel and viewfinder.  
AF-area mode  
Control panel  
Viewfinder  
Single-point AF  
9-point dynamic-area AF *  
21-point dynamic-area AF *  
51-point dynamic-area AF *  
3D-tracking  
Group-area AF  
Auto-area AF  
*Only active focus point is displayed in the viewfinder. Remaining focus points provide  
information to assist focus operation.  
AManual Focus  
Single-point AF is automatically selected when manual focus is used.  
ASee Also  
For information on adjusting how long the camera waits before  
refocusing when an object moves in front of the camera, see Custom  
Setting a3 (Focus tracking with lock-on, 0328). See Custom Setting  
a4 (Focus point illumination, 0329) for information on choosing  
how the focus point is displayed in dynamic-area and group-area AF.  
See Custom Setting f5 (Customize command dials) > Change main/  
sub (0363) for information on using the main command dial to  
choose the AF-area mode. See page 58 for information on the  
autofocus options available in live view or during movie recording.  
126  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Focus Point Selection  
The camera offers a choice of 51 focus points that can be used to  
compose photographs with the main subject positioned almost  
anywhere in the frame. Follow the steps below to choose the  
focus point (in group-area AF, you can follow these steps to  
choose a group of focus points).  
1
Rotate the focus selector  
lock to .  
This allows the multi  
selector to be used to  
select the focus point.  
Focus selector lock  
2
Select the focus point.  
Use the multi selector to select the  
focus point in the viewfinder while the  
exposure meters are on. Press J to  
select the center focus point.  
The focus selector lock can  
be rotated to the locked (L)  
position following  
selection to prevent the  
selected focus point from  
changing when the multi  
selector is pressed.  
127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
AAuto-area AF  
The focus point for auto-area AF is selected automatically; manual  
focus-point selection is not available.  
ASee Also  
For information on choosing when the focus point is illuminated, see  
Custom Setting a5 (AF point illumination, 0329). For information  
on setting focus-point selection to “wrap around,see Custom Setting  
a6 (Focus point wrap-around, 0330). For information on choosing  
the number of focus points that can be selected using the multi  
selector, see Custom Setting a7 (Number of focus points, 0330). For  
information on choosing separate focus points for vertical and  
horizontal orientations, see Custom Setting a8 (Store points by  
orientation, 0331). For information on changing the role of the J  
button, see Custom Setting f1 (OK button, 0354).  
128  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Focus Lock  
Focus lock can be used to change the composition after  
focusing, making it possible to focus on a subject that will not be  
in a focus point in the final composition. If the camera is unable  
to focus using autofocus (0131), focus lock can also be used to  
recompose the photograph after focusing on another object at  
the same distance as your original subject. Focus lock is most  
effective when an option other than auto-area AF is selected for  
AF-area mode (0123).  
1
Focus.  
Position the subject in the  
selected focus point and  
press the shutter-release  
button halfway to initiate  
focus. Check that the in-  
focus indicator (I)  
appears in the viewfinder.  
2
Lock focus.  
AF-A and AF-C focus modes: With the  
shutter-release button pressed  
halfway (q), press the A AE-L/AF-L  
button (w) to lock both focus and  
exposure (an AE-L icon will be  
displayed in the viewfinder). Focus  
will remain locked while the A AE-L/  
AF-L button is pressed, even if you  
later remove your finger from the  
shutter-release button.  
Shutter-release button  
A AE-L/AF-L button  
129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
AF-S focus mode: Focus locks automatically when the in-focus  
indicator (I) appears, and remain locked until you remove  
your finger from the shutter-release button. Focus can also  
be locked by pressing the A AE-L/AF-L button (see above).  
3
Recompose the  
photograph and shoot.  
Focus will remain locked  
between shots if you keep  
the shutter-release button  
pressed halfway (AF-S) or  
keep the A AE-L/AF-L button  
pressed, allowing several photographs in succession to be  
taken at the same focus setting.  
Do not change the distance between the camera and the  
subject while focus lock is in effect. If the subject moves, focus  
again at the new distance.  
ASee Also  
See Custom setting c1 (Shutter-release button AE-L, 0336) for  
information on using the shutter-release button to lock exposure,  
Custom Setting f4 (Assign AE-L/AF-L button, 0361) for information  
on choosing the role played by the A AE-L/AF-L button.  
130  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
AGetting Good Results with Autofocus  
Autofocus does not perform well under the conditions listed below.  
The shutter release may be disabled if the camera is unable to focus  
under these conditions, or the in-focus indicator (I) may be displayed  
and the camera may sound a beep, allowing the shutter to be released  
even when the subject is not in focus. In these cases, focus manually  
(0132) or use focus lock (0129) to focus on another subject at the  
same distance and then recompose the photograph.  
There is little or no contrast between the subject and  
the background.  
Example: Subject is the same color as the  
background.  
The focus point contains objects at different  
distances from the camera.  
Example: Subject is inside a cage.  
The subject is dominated by regular geometric  
patterns.  
Example: Blinds or a row of windows in a  
skyscraper.  
The focus point contains areas of sharply  
contrasting brightness.  
Example: Subject is half in the shade.  
Background objects appear larger than the subject.  
Example: A building is in the frame behind the  
subject.  
The subject contains many fine details.  
Example: A field of flowers or other subjects that  
are small or lack variation in brightness.  
131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Manual Focus  
Manual focus is available for lenses that do not support  
autofocus (non-AF NIKKOR lenses) or when the autofocus does  
not produce the desired results (0131).  
AF lenses: Set the lens focus  
mode switch (if present)  
and camera focus-mode  
selector to M.  
Focus-mode selector  
DAF Lenses  
Do not use AF lenses with the lens focus mode switch set to M and  
the camera focus-mode selector set to AF. Failure to observe this  
precaution could damage the camera or lens. This does not apply  
to AF-S lenses, which can be used in M mode without setting the  
camera focus-mode selector to M.  
Manual focus lenses: Focus manually.  
To focus manually, adjust the lens focus  
ring until the image displayed on the  
clear matte field in the viewfinder is in  
focus. Photographs can be taken at any  
time, even when the image is not in  
focus.  
132  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
❚❚ The Electronic Rangefinder  
The viewfinder focus indicator can be  
used to confirm whether the subject in  
the selected focus point is in focus (the  
focus point can be selected from any of  
the 51 focus points). After positioning  
the subject in the selected focus point,  
press the shutter-release button halfway  
and rotate the lens focus ring until the in-focus indicator (I) is  
displayed. Note that with the subjects listed on page 131, the in-  
focus indicator may sometimes be displayed when the subject is  
not in focus; confirm focus in the viewfinder before shooting.  
For information on using the electronic rangefinder with  
optional AF-S/AF-I teleconverters, see page 430.  
AFocal Plane Position  
To determine the distance between  
your subject and the camera, measure  
from the focal plane mark (E) on the  
camera body. The distance between the  
46.5mm  
lens mounting flange and the focal  
plane is 46.5 mm (1.83 in.).  
Focal plane mark  
133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ISO Sensitivity  
The camera’s sensitivity to light can be adjusted according to the  
amount of light available. Choose from settings that range from  
ISO 100 to ISO 12800 in steps equivalent to 1  
3 EV. Settings of  
/
from about 0.3 to 1 EV below ISO 100 and 0.3 to 2 EV above ISO  
12800 are also available for special situations. Auto, scene, and  
special effect modes also offer an AUTO option, which allows the  
camera to set ISO sensitivity automatically in response to  
lighting conditions. The higher the ISO sensitivity, the less light  
needed to make an exposure, allowing higher shutter speeds or  
smaller apertures.  
Modes  
P, S, A, M  
Options  
Lo 1–Lo 0.3; 100–12800 in steps of 1  
/
3 EV; Hi 0.3–Hi 2  
Auto  
%
Other shooting Auto; Lo 1–Lo 0.3; 100–12800 in steps of 1  
/3 EV; Hi 0.3–  
modes  
Hi 2  
ISO sensitivity can be adjusted  
by pressing the W (S) button  
and rotating the main  
command dial until the desired  
setting is displayed in the  
control panel, viewfinder or  
information display.  
W (S) button Main command  
dial  
Control panel  
Viewfinder  
Information display  
134  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
AISO Sensitivity  
The higher the ISO sensitivity, the less light needed to make an  
exposure, allowing faster shutter speeds or smaller apertures, but the  
more likely the image is to be affected by noise (randomly-spaced  
bright pixels, fog, or lines). Noise is particularly likely at settings  
between Hi 0.3 and Hi 2.  
AAUTO  
If the mode dial is rotated to P, S, A, or M after AUTO is selected for ISO  
sensitivity in another mode, the ISO sensitivity last selected in P, S, A, or  
M mode will be restored.  
AHi 0.3–Hi 2  
The settings Hi 0.3 through Hi 2 correspond to ISO sensitivities 0.3–  
2 EV over ISO 12800 (ISO 16000–51200 equivalent).  
ALo 0.3–Lo 1  
The settings Lo 0.3 through Lo 1 correspond to ISO sensitivities 0.3–  
1 EV below ISO 100 (ISO 80–50 equivalent). Use for larger apertures  
when lighting is bright. Contrast is slightly higher than normal; in most  
cases, ISO sensitivities of ISO 100 or above are recommended.  
AThe Shooting Menus  
ISO sensitivity can also be adjusted from the photo and movie  
shooting menus. Choose ISO sensitivity settings in photo shooting  
menu to adjust settings for viewfinder and live view photography  
(0310) and Movie ISO sensitivity settings in the movie shooting  
menu to adjust settings for movie live view (0322).  
ASee Also  
For information on choosing the ISO sensitivity step size, see Custom  
Setting b1 (ISO sensitivity step value; 0333). For information on  
adjusting ISO sensitivity without using the W (S) button, see  
Custom Setting d8 (Easy ISO; 0341). For information on using the  
High ISO NR option in the shooting menus to reduce noise at high ISO  
sensitivities, see page 317.  
135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Auto ISO Sensitivity Control  
(P, S, A, and M Modes Only)  
If On is selected for ISO sensitivity settings > Auto ISO  
sensitivity control in the photo shooting menu, ISO sensitivity  
will automatically be adjusted if optimal exposure can not be  
achieved at the value selected by the user (ISO sensitivity is  
adjusted appropriately when the flash is used).  
1
Select Auto ISO sensitivity control.  
Select ISO sensitivity settings in the  
photo shooting menu, highlight Auto  
ISO sensitivity control and press 2.  
2
Select On.  
Highlight On and press J (if Off is  
selected, ISO sensitivity will remain  
fixed at the value selected by the  
user).  
136  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
3
Adjust settings.  
The maximum value for auto ISO  
sensitivity can be selected using  
Maximum sensitivity (note that if the  
ISO sensitivity selected by the user is  
higher than that chosen for  
Maximum sensitivity, the value  
selected by the user will be used instead). In modes P and A,  
sensitivity will only be adjusted if underexposure would  
result at the shutter speed selected for Minimum shutter  
speed (1  
2000–30 s, or Auto; in modes S and M, ISO sensitivity  
/
will be adjusted for optimal exposure at the shutter speed  
selected by the user). If Auto is selected, the camera will  
choose the minimum shutter speed based on the focal  
length of the lens. Press J to exit when settings are  
complete.  
When On is selected, the viewfinder  
and control panel show ISO AUTO. When  
sensitivity is altered from the value  
selected by the user, these indicators  
flash and the altered value is shown in  
viewfinder.  
137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
AMinimum Shutter Speed  
Auto shutter-speed selection can be fine-tuned by highlighting Auto  
and pressing 2: for example, values faster than those usually selected  
automatically can be used with telephoto lenses to reduce blur. Note,  
however, that Auto functions only with CPU lenses; if a non-CPU lens is  
used without lens data, minimum shutter speed is fixed at 1  
30 s.  
/
Shutter speeds may drop below the selected minimum if optimum  
exposure can not be achieved at the ISO sensitivity chosen for  
Maximum sensitivity.  
AAuto ISO Sensitivity Control  
Noise (randomly-spaced bright pixels, fog, or lines) is more likely at  
higher sensitivities. Use the High ISO NR option in the shooting  
menus to reduce noise (see page 317). When a flash is used, minimum  
shutter speed will be set to the value selected for Minimum shutter  
speed unless this value is faster than Custom Setting e1 (Flash sync  
speed, 0345) or slower than Custom Setting e2 (Flash shutter  
speed, 0346), in which case the value selected for Custom Setting e2  
will be used instead. Note that ISO sensitivity may be raised  
automatically when auto ISO sensitivity control is used in combination  
with slow sync flash modes (available with the built-in flash and the  
optional flash units listed on page 433), possibly preventing the  
camera from selecting slow shutter speeds.  
AEnabling and Disabling Auto ISO Senstivity Control  
You can turn auto ISO sensitivity control on or off by pressing the  
W (S) button and rotating the sub-command dial. ISO AUTO is  
displayed when auto ISO sensitivity control is on.  
138  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Exposure  
Metering  
(P, S, A, and M Modes Only)  
Choose how the camera sets exposure in P, S, A, and M modes (in  
other modes, the camera selects the metering method  
automatically).  
Option  
Description  
Matrix: Produces natural results in most situations. Camera  
meters a wide area of the frame and set exposure according to  
tone distribution, color, composition, and, with type G, E, or D  
lenses (0429), distance information (3D color matrix metering  
III; with other CPU lenses, camera uses color matrix metering III,  
which does not include 3D distance information).  
a
Center-weighted: Camera meters entire frame but assigns greatest  
weight to center area (if CPU lens is attached, size of area can be  
selected using Custom Setting b5, Center-weighted area,  
0335; if non-CPU lens is attached, area is equivalent to circle  
12 mm in diameter). Classic meter for portraits; recommended  
when using filters with an exposure factor (filter factor) over 1×.  
Spot: Camera meters circle 4 mm (0.16 in.) in diameter  
Z
(approximately 1.5% of frame). Circle is centered on current  
focus point, making it possible to meter off-center subjects (if  
non-CPU lens is used or if auto-area AF is in effect, camera will  
meter center focus point). Ensures that subject will be correctly  
exposed, even when background is much brighter or darker.  
Highlight-weighted: Camera assigns greatest weight to highlights.  
Use to reduce loss of detail in highlights, for example when  
photographing spotlit performers on a stage.  
b
h
139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                     
To choose a metering option,  
press the Z (Q) button and  
rotate the main command dial  
until the desired setting is  
displayed in the viewfinder and  
control panel.  
Z (Q) button Main command  
dial  
Control panel  
Viewfinder  
ANon-CPU Lens Data  
Specifying the focal length and maximum aperture of non-CPU lenses  
using the Non-CPU lens data option in the setup menu (0236)  
allows the camera to use color matrix metering when matrix is selected  
and improves the accuracy of center-weighted and spot metering.  
Center-weighted metering will be used if highlight-weighted metering  
is selected with non-CPU lenses or if matrix metering is selected with  
non-CPU lenses for which lens data have not been supplied. Note that  
center-weighted metering may also be used if highlight-weighted  
metering is selected with certain CPU lenses (AI-P NIKKOR lenses and  
AF lenses that are not of type G, E, or D).  
ASee Also  
See Custom Setting b4 (Matrix metering, 0335) for information on  
choosing whether matrix metering uses face detection. For  
information on making separate adjustments to optimal exposure for  
each metering method, see Custom Setting b6 (Fine-tune optimal  
exposure, 0336).  
140  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Autoexposure Lock  
Use autoexposure lock to recompose photographs after using  
center-weighted metering and spot metering (0139) to meter  
exposure.  
1
Lock exposure.  
Shutter-release button  
Position the subject in the selected  
focus point and press the shutter-  
release button halfway. With the  
shutter-release button pressed  
halfway and the subject positioned  
in the focus point, press the A AE-L/  
AF-L button to lock focus and  
exposure (if you are using autofocus,  
confirm that the in-focus indicator  
(I) appears in the viewfinder).  
A AE-L/AF-L button  
While exposure lock is in effect, an  
AE-L indicator will appear in the  
viewfinder.  
2
Recompose the  
photograph.  
Keeping the A AE-L/AF-L  
button pressed,  
recompose the  
photograph and shoot.  
141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
AMetered Area  
In spot metering, exposure will be locked at the value metered in a  
4-mm (0.16 in.) circle centered on the selected focus point. In center-  
weighted metering, exposure will be locked at the value metered in a  
12-mm circle in the center of the viewfinder.  
AAdjusting Shutter Speed and Aperture  
While exposure lock is in effect, the following settings can be adjusted  
without altering the metered value for exposure:  
Mode  
P
S
Setting  
Shutter speed and aperture (flexible program; 089)  
Shutter speed  
A
Aperture  
The new values can be confirmed in the viewfinder and control panel.  
Note that metering can not be changed while exposure lock is in  
effect.  
ASee Also  
If On is selected for Custom Setting c1 (Shutter-release button AE-L,  
0336), exposure will lock when the shutter-release button is pressed  
halfway. For information on changing the role of the A AE-L/AF-L  
button, see Custom Setting f4 (Assign AE-L/AF-L button, 0361).  
142  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Exposure Compensation  
(P, S, A, M, h, and %Modes Only)  
Exposure compensation is used to alter exposure from the value  
suggested by the camera, making pictures brighter or darker. It  
is most effective when used with center-weighted or spot  
metering (0139). Choose from values between –5 EV  
(underexposure) and +5 EV (overexposure) in increments of  
1
/
3 EV. In general, positive values make the subject brighter while  
negative values make it darker.  
–1 EV  
No exposure  
compensation  
+1 EV  
To choose a value for exposure  
compensation, press the E button and  
rotate the main command dial until the  
desired value is displayed in the control  
panel or viewfinder.  
E button  
Main command dial  
0 EV  
–0.3 (–1  
/3) EV  
+2.0 EV  
(E button pressed)  
143  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
At values other than 0.0, the 0 at the  
center of the exposure indicators will  
flash (modes P, S, A, h, and %) and a  
E icon will be displayed in the control  
panel and viewfinder after you release  
the E button. The current value for  
exposure compensation can be confirmed in the exposure  
indicator by pressing the E button.  
Normal exposure can be restored by setting exposure  
compensation to 0 (adjustments to exposure compensation in  
h and % modes will be reset when another mode is  
selected). Exposure compensation is not reset when the camera  
is turned off.  
AMode M  
In mode M, exposure compensation affects only the exposure  
indicator; shutter speed and aperture do not change.  
ASee Also  
For information on choosing the size of the increments available for  
exposure compensation, see Custom Setting b2 (EV steps for  
exposure cntrl, 0333). For information on making adjustments to  
exposure compensation without pressing the E button, see Custom  
Setting b3 (Easy exposure compensation, 0334). For information  
on restricting the effects of exposure compensation to the background  
when using a flash for foreground lighting, see Custom Setting e4  
(Exposure comp. for flash, 0353). For information on automatically  
varying exposure, flash level, white balance, or Active D-Lighting, see  
page 202.  
144  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
White Balance  
(P, S, A, and M Modes Only)  
White balance ensures that colors are unaffected by the color of  
the light source. In modes other than P, S, A, and M, white balance  
is set automatically by the camera. Auto white balance is  
recommended for most light sources in P, S, A, and M modes, but  
other values can be selected if necessary according to the type  
of source:  
Option  
Color temp. *  
3500–8000 K  
3000 K  
Auto  
Normal  
v
Keep warm lighting colors  
Incandescent  
J
I
Fluorescent  
Sodium-vapor lamps  
Warm-white fluorescent  
White fluorescent  
Cool-white fluorescent  
Day white fluorescent  
Daylight fluorescent  
High temp. mercury-vapor  
Direct sunlight  
2700 K  
3000 K  
3700 K  
4200 K  
5000 K  
6500 K  
7200 K  
5200 K  
5400 K  
6000 K  
8000 K  
2500–10,000 K  
H
N
Flash  
Cloudy  
G
M
K
Shade  
Choose color temp. (0152)  
Preset manual (0155)  
L
* All values are approximate and do not reflect fine-tuning (if applicable).  
145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                     
White balance is set by pressing the L (U) button and  
rotating the main command dial until the desired setting is  
displayed in the information display.  
L (U) button  
Main command  
dial  
Information display  
AThe Shooting Menus  
White balance can also be adjusted using the White balance option in  
either of the shooting menus (0310, 321), which also can be used to  
fine-tune white balance (0149) or measure a value for preset manual  
white balance (0155). The Auto option in the White balance menu  
offers a choice of Normal and Keep warm lighting colors, which  
preserves the warm colors produced by incandescent lighting, while  
the I Fluorescent option can be used to select the light source from  
the bulb types. The item in the movie shooting menu offers a Same as  
photo settings option that sets the white balance for movies to the  
same as that used for photographs.  
AStudio Flash Lighting  
Auto white balance may not produce the desired results with large  
studio flash units. Use preset manual white balance or set white  
balance to Flash and use fine tuning to adjust white balance.  
146  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
AColor Temperature  
The perceived color of a light source varies with the viewer and other  
conditions. Color temperature is an objective measure of the color of a  
light source, defined with reference to the temperature to which an  
object would have to be heated to radiate light in the same  
wavelengths. While light sources with a color temperature in the  
neighborhood of 5000–5500 K appear white, light sources with a lower  
color temperature, such as incandescent light bulbs, appear slightly  
yellow or red. Light sources with a higher color temperature appear  
tinged with blue.  
“Warmer” (redder) colors  
“Cooler” (bluer) colors  
3000  
4000  
5000  
6000  
8000  
10000  
[
]
K
q
w
e
r
tyu  
i
o
!
!
I (sodium-vapor lamps): 2700 K  
q
w
e
r
t
y
u
i
o
!
!
J (incandescent)/I (warm-white fluorescent.): 3000 K  
I (white fluorescent): 3700 K  
I (cool-white fluorescent): 4200 K  
I (day white fluorescent): 5000 K  
H (direct sunlight): 5200 K  
N (flash): 5400 K  
G (cloudy): 6000 K  
I (daylight fluorescent): 6500 K  
I (high temp. mercury-vapor): 7200 K  
M (shade): 8000 K  
Note: All figures are approximate.  
147  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ASee Also  
When WB bracketing is selected for Custom Setting e6 (Auto  
bracketing set, 0353), the camera will create several images each  
time the shutter is released. White balance will be varied with each  
image, “bracketing” the value currently selected for white balance  
148  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fine-Tuning White Balance  
At settings other than K (Choose color temp.), white balance  
can be “fine-tuned” to compensate for variations in the color of  
the light source or to introduce a deliberate color cast into an  
image.  
❚❚ The White Balance Menu  
To fine-tune white balance from the shooting menus, select  
White balance and follow the steps below.  
1
2
Display fine-tuning options.  
Highlight a white balance option and  
press 2(if a sub-menu is displayed,  
select the desired option and press 2  
again to display fine-tuning options;  
for information on fine-tuning preset  
manual white balance, see page 164).  
Fine tune white balance.  
Use the multi selector to fine-tune  
white balance. White balance can be  
fine-tuned on the amber (A)–blue (B)  
axis in steps of 0.5 and the green (G)–  
magenta (M) axis in steps of 0.25. The  
horizontal (amber-blue) axis  
Coordinates  
Adjustment  
corresponds to color temperature,  
while the vertical (green-magenta)  
axis has the similar effects to the corresponding color  
compensation (CC) filters. The horizontal axis is ruled in  
increments equivalent to about 5 mired, the vertical axis in  
increments of about 0.05 diffuse density units.  
149  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
3
Press J.  
Press J to save settings and return to the shooting menus.  
❚❚ The L(U) Button  
At settings other than K (Choose color temp.) and L (Preset  
manual), the L (U) button can be used to fine-tune white  
balance on the amber (A)–blue (B) axis (0149; to fine-tune  
white balance when L is selected, use the shooting menus as  
described on page 164). Press the L (U) button and rotate  
the sub-command dial to fine-tune white balance in steps of 0.5  
(with each full increment equivalent to about 5 mired) until the  
desired value is displayed in the control panel and information  
display. Rotating the sub-command dial to the left increases the  
amount of amber (A). Rotating the sub-command dial to the  
right increases the amount of blue (B).  
Control panel  
L (U) button  
Sub-command  
dial  
Information display  
150  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
AWhite Balance Fine-Tuning  
If white balance has been fine-tuned, an  
asterisk (“E”) will be displayed in the  
information display. Note that the colors on  
the fine-tuning axes are relative, not  
absolute. For example, moving the cursor  
to B (blue) when a “warm” setting such as J  
(incandescent) is selected for white balance  
will make photographs slightly “colder” but  
will not actually make them blue.  
Information display  
A“Mired”  
Any given change in color temperature produces a greater difference  
in color at low color temperatures than it would at higher color  
temperatures. For example, a change of 1000 K produces a much  
greater change in color at 3000 K than at 6000 K. Mired, calculated by  
multiplying the inverse of the color temperature by 10 6, is a measure of  
color temperature that takes such variation into account, and as such is  
the unit used in color-temperature compensation filters. E.g.:  
4000 K–3000 K (a difference of 1000 K)=83 mired  
7000 K–6000 K (a difference of 1000 K)=24 mired  
151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Choosing a Color Temperature  
Follow the steps below to choose a color temperature when  
K (Choose color temp.) is selected for white balance.  
DChoose Color Temperature  
Note that the desired results will not be obtained with flash or  
fluorescent lighting. Choose N (Flash) or I (Fluorescent) for these  
sources. With other light sources, take a test shot to determine if the  
selected value is appropriate.  
❚❚ The White Balance Menu  
Color temperature can be selected using the White balance  
options in the shooting menus. Enter values for the amber–blue  
and green–magenta axes (0149) as described below.  
1
Select Choose color temp.  
Select White balance in either of the  
shooting menus, then highlight  
Choose color temp. and press 2.  
2
Select a value for amber-blue.  
Press 4or 2to highlight digits and  
press 1or 3to change.  
Value for amber (A)-  
blue (B) axis  
152  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
3
4
Select a value for green-magenta.  
Press 4or 2to highlight the G  
(green) or M (magenta) axis and press  
1or 3to select a value.  
Value for green (G)-  
magenta (M) axis  
Press J.  
Press J to save changes and return  
to the shooting menus. If a value  
other than 0 is selected for the green  
(G)–magenta (M) axis, an asterisk  
(“E”) will be displayed in the  
information display.  
153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
❚❚ The L(U) Button  
When K (Choose color temp.) is selected, the L (U) button  
can be used to select the color temperature, although only for  
the amber (A)–blue (B) axis. Press the L (U) button and  
rotate the sub-command dial until the desired value is displayed  
in the control panel and information display (adjustments are  
made in mireds; 0151). To enter a color temperature directly,  
press the L (U) button and press 4or 2to highlight a digit  
and press 1or 3to change.  
Control panel  
L (U) button  
Sub-command  
dial  
Information display  
154  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Preset Manual  
Preset manual is used to record and recall custom white balance  
settings for shooting under mixed lighting or to compensate for  
light sources with a strong color cast. The camera can store up to  
six values for preset manual white balance in presets d-1  
through d-6. Two methods are available for setting preset  
manual white balance:  
Method  
Description  
Neutral gray or white object is placed under  
lighting that will be used in final photo and  
white balance measured by camera (0155).  
In live view photography and movie live view  
(054, 66), white balance can be measured in  
a selected area of the frame (spot white  
balance, 0159).  
Direct measurement  
Copy from existing  
photograph  
White balance is copied from photo on  
memory card (0162).  
Viewfinder Photography  
1
Light a reference object.  
Place a neutral gray or white object under the lighting that  
will be used in the final photograph. In studio settings, a  
standard gray panel can be used as a reference object. Note  
that exposure is automatically increased by 1 EV when  
measuring white balance; in mode M, adjust exposure so that  
the exposure indicator shows 0 (094).  
155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
2
3
Set white balance to L (Preset manual).  
Press the L (U) button and rotate the main command dial  
until L is displayed in the information display.  
L (U) button  
Main command  
dial  
Information display  
Select a preset.  
Press the L (U) button and rotate the sub-command dial  
until the desired white balance preset (d-1 to d-6) is displayed  
in the information display.  
L (U) button  
Sub-command  
dial  
Information display  
AMeasuring Preset Manual White Balance (Viewfinder Photography)  
Preset manual white balance can not be measured while you are  
shooting an HDR photograph (0177) or multiple exposure (0216), or  
when Record movies is selected for Custom Setting g4 (Assign  
shutter button, 0373) and the live view selector is rotated to 1.  
156  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
4
5
Select direct measurement mode.  
Release the L (U) button briefly  
and then press the button until D  
starts to flash in the control panel  
and viewfinder. The displays will  
flash for about six seconds.  
Control panel  
Viewfinder  
Measure white balance.  
Before the indicators stop flashing,  
frame the reference object so that it  
fills the viewfinder and press the  
shutter-release button all the way down. The camera will  
measure a value for white balance and store it in the preset  
selected in Step 3. No photograph will be recorded; white  
balance can be measured accurately even when the camera is  
not in focus.  
AProtected Presets  
If the current preset is protected (0164), 3 or Prt will flash in the  
control panel, viewfinder, and information display if you attempt to  
measure a new value.  
157  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6
Check the results.  
If the camera was able to measure  
a value for white balance, C  
will flash in the control panel for  
about six seconds, while the  
viewfinder will show a flashing a.  
Control panel  
Viewfinder  
If lighting is too dark or too bright,  
the camera may be unable to  
measure white balance. A flashing  
b a will appear in the control  
panel and viewfinder for about six  
seconds. Press the shutter-release  
button halfway to return to Step 5  
and measure white balance again.  
Control panel  
Viewfinder  
DDirect Measurement Mode  
If no operations are performed during viewfinder photography while  
the displays are flashing, direct measurement mode will end in the  
time selected for Custom Setting c2 (Standby timer, 0336).  
ASelecting a Preset  
Selecting Preset manual for the White  
balance option in either of the shooting  
menus displays the dialog shown at right;  
highlight a preset and press J. If no value  
currently exists for the selected preset, white  
balance will be set to 5200 K, the same as  
Direct sunlight.  
158  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Live View (Spot White Balance)  
In live view photography and movie live view (054, 66), white  
balance can be measured in a selected area of the frame,  
eliminating the need to prepare a reference object or change  
lenses during telephoto photography.  
1
Press the a button.  
The mirror will be raised and the view  
through the lens will be displayed in  
the camera monitor.  
a button  
2
Set white balance to L (Preset manual).  
Press the L (U) button and rotate the main command dial  
until L is displayed in the monitor.  
L (U) button  
Main command  
dial  
Monitor  
159  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
3
Select a preset.  
Press the L (U) button and rotate the sub-command dial  
until the desired white balance preset (d-1 to d-6) is displayed  
in the monitor.  
L (U) button  
Sub-command  
dial  
Monitor  
4
5
Select direct measurement mode.  
Release the L (U) button briefly  
and then press the button until the  
Licon in the monitor starts to flash.  
A spot white balance target (r) will  
be displayed at the selected focus  
point.  
Monitor  
Position the target over a white or grey area.  
While L flashes in the display, use  
the multi selector to position the r  
over a white or grey area of the  
subject. To zoom the area around the  
target in for more precise positioning,  
press the X (T) button.  
160  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6
Measure white balance.  
Press J or press the shutter-release  
button all the way down to measure  
white balance. The time available to  
measure white balance is that  
selected for Custom Setting c4  
(Monitor off delay) > Live view  
(0337).  
If the camera is unable to measure  
white balance, the message shown at  
right will be displayed. Choose a new  
white balance target and repeat the  
process from Step 5.  
7
Exit direct measurement mode.  
Press the L (U) button to exit direct measurement mode.  
When Preset manual is selected for  
White balance in either of the  
shooting menus, the position of the  
target used to measure preset  
manual white balance will be  
displayed on presets recorded during  
live view photography and movie live  
view.  
AMeasuring Preset Manual White Balance (Live View)  
Preset manual white balance can not be measured when Record  
movies is selected for Custom Setting g4 (Assign shutter button,  
0373) and the live view selector is rotated to 1. Preset manual white  
balance can not be set while an HDR exposure is in progress (0177).  
161  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Managing Presets  
❚❚ Copying White Balance from a Photograph  
Follow the steps below to copy a value for white balance from an  
existing photograph to a selected preset.  
1
2
Select Preset manual.  
Select White balance in either of the  
shooting menus, then highlight  
Preset manual and press 2.  
Select a destination.  
Highlight the destination preset (d-1  
to d-6) and press W (S).  
W (S) button  
3
Choose Select image.  
Highlight Select image and press 2.  
162  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
4
5
Highlight a source image.  
Highlight the source image.  
Copy white balance.  
Press J to copy the white balance value for the highlighted  
photograph to the selected preset. If the highlighted  
photograph has a comment (0384), the comment will be  
copied to the comment for the selected preset.  
AChoosing a Source Image  
To view the image highlighted in Step 4 full frame, press and hold the  
X (T) button.  
X (T) button  
163  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AChoosing a White Balance Preset  
Press 1to highlight the current white  
balance preset (d-1–d-6) and press 2to  
select another preset.  
AFine-Tuning Preset Manual White Balance  
The selected preset can be fine-tuned by  
selecting Fine-tune and adjusting white  
balance as described on page 149.  
AEdit Comment  
To enter a descriptive comment of up to 36  
characters for the current white-balance  
preset, select Edit comment in the preset  
manual white balance menu and enter a  
comment as described on page 171.  
AProtect  
To protect the current white-balance preset,  
select Protect in the preset manual white  
balance menu, then highlight On and press  
J. Protected presets can not be modified  
and the Fine-tune and Edit comment  
options can not be used.  
164  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Image Enhancement  
Picture Controls  
(P, S, A, and M Modes Only)  
In P, S, A, and M modes, your choice of Picture Control determines  
how pictures are processed (in other modes, the camera selects  
a Picture Control automatically).  
Selecting a Picture Control  
Choose a Picture Control according to the subject or type of  
scene.  
Option  
Description  
Standard processing for balanced results.  
Recommended for most situations.  
Minimal processing for natural results. Choose for  
photographs that will later be processed or  
retouched.  
Pictures are enhanced for a vivid, photoprint effect.  
Choose for photographs that emphasize primary  
colors.  
Standard  
Q
R
Neutral  
Vivid  
S
Monochrome Take monochrome photographs.  
T
e
f
Process portraits for skin with natural texture and a  
rounded feel.  
Portrait  
Landscape  
Produces vibrant landscapes and cityscapes.  
Details are preserved over a wide tone range, from  
highlights to shadows. Choose for photographs that  
will later be extensively processed or retouched.  
Flat  
q
AThe Movie Shooting Menu  
The Set Picture Control option in the movie shooting menu also  
offers a Same as photo settings option that sets the Picture Control  
for movies to the same as that used for photographs.  
165  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                       
1
2
Select Set Picture Control.  
Highlight Set Picture Control in  
either of the shooting menus and  
press 2.  
Select a Picture Control.  
Highlight a Picture Control and press  
J.  
ACustom Picture Controls  
Custom Picture Controls are created through modifications to existing  
Picture Controls using the Manage Picture Control option in the  
shooting menus (0170). Custom Picture Controls can be saved to a  
memory card for sharing among other cameras of the same model and  
compatible software (0173).  
AThe Picture Control Indicator  
The current Picture Control is shown in the  
information display when the R button is  
pressed.  
Picture Control indicator  
166  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Modifying Picture Controls  
Existing preset or custom Picture Controls (0170) can be  
modified to suit the scene or the user’s creative intent. Choose a  
balanced combination of settings using Quick adjust, or make  
manual adjustments to individual settings.  
1
Select a Picture Control.  
Highlight the desired Picture Control  
in the Picture Control list (0165) and  
press 2.  
2
Adjust settings.  
Press 1or 3to highlight the desired  
setting and press 4or 2to choose a  
value in increments of 1, or rotate the  
sub-command dial to choose a value  
in increments of 0.25 (0168). Repeat  
this step until all settings have been  
adjusted, or select a preset combination of settings by using  
the multi selector to choose Quick adjust. Default settings  
can be restored by pressing the O (Q) button.  
3
Press J.  
AModifications to Original Picture Controls  
Picture Controls that have been modified  
from default settings are indicated by an  
asterisk (“E”).  
167  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
❚❚ Picture Control Settings  
Option  
Description  
Mute or heighten the effect of the selected Picture  
Control (note that this resets all manual adjustments).  
Not available with Neutral, Monochrome, Flat, or  
custom Picture Controls (0170).  
Quick adjust  
Control the sharpness of outlines. Select A to adjust  
Sharpening sharpening automatically according to the type of  
scene.  
Adjust clarity manually or select A to let the camera  
adjust clarity automatically. Depending on the scene,  
Clarity  
shadows may appear around bright objects or halos  
may appear around dark objects at some settings.  
Clarity is not applied to movies.  
Adjust contrast manually or select A to let the camera  
adjust contrast automatically.  
Contrast  
Raise or lower brightness without loss of detail in  
highlights or shadows.  
Brightness  
Control the vividness of colors. Select A to adjust  
Saturation saturation automatically according to the type of  
scene.  
Hue  
Adjust hue.  
Filter  
Simulate the effect of color filters on monochrome  
effects  
photographs (0169).  
Choose the tint used in monochrome photographs  
Toning  
168  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
D“A” (Auto)  
Results for auto sharpening, clarity, contrast, and saturation vary with  
exposure and the position of the subject in the frame. Use a type G, E,  
or D lens for best results.  
ASwitching Between Manual and Auto  
Press the X (T) button to switch back  
and forth between manual and auto (A)  
settings for sharpening, clarity, contrast, and  
saturation.  
ACustom Picture Controls  
The options available with custom Picture Controls are the same as  
those on which the custom Picture Control was based.  
APrevious Settings  
The j indicator under the value display in  
the Picture Control setting menu indicates  
the previous value for the setting. Use this as  
a reference when adjusting settings.  
AFilter Effects (Monochrome Only)  
The options in this menu simulate the effect of color filters on  
monochrome photographs. The following filter effects are available:  
Option  
Description  
Y
Yellow Enhances contrast. Can be used to tone down the  
brightness of the sky in landscape photographs.  
Orange produces more contrast than yellow, red more  
contrast than orange.  
O
Orange  
Red  
R
G
Green Softens skin tones. Can be used for portraits.  
Note that the effects achieved with Filter effects are more  
pronounced than those produced by physical glass filters.  
169  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
AToning (Monochrome Only)  
Pressing 3when Toning is selected displays  
saturation options. Press 4or 2to adjust  
saturation in increments of 1, or rotate the  
sub-command dial to choose a value in  
increments of 0.25. Saturation control is not  
available when B&W (black-and-white) is  
selected.  
Creating Custom Picture Controls  
The Picture Controls supplied with the camera can be modified  
and saved as custom Picture Controls.  
1
2
3
Select Manage Picture Control.  
Highlight Manage Picture Control in  
either of the shooting menus and  
press 2.  
Select Save/edit.  
Highlight Save/edit and press 2.  
Select a Picture Control.  
Highlight an existing Picture Control  
and press 2, or press J to proceed to  
Step 5 to save a copy of the  
highlighted Picture Control without  
further modification.  
170  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
4
Edit the selected Picture Control.  
See page 168 for more information.  
To abandon any changes and start  
over from default settings, press the  
O (Q) button. Press J when settings  
are complete.  
5
6
Select a destination.  
Choose a destination for the custom  
Picture Control (C-1 through C-9) and  
press 2.  
Name the Picture Control.  
Keyboard area  
The text-entry dialog shown at right  
will be displayed. By default, new  
Picture Controls are named by adding  
a two-digit number (assigned  
automatically) to the name of the  
existing Picture Control; to use the  
default name, proceed to Step 7. To  
move the cursor in the name area,  
Name area  
hold the W (S) button and press 4or 2. To enter a new  
letter at the current cursor position, use the multi selector to  
highlight the desired character in the keyboard area and  
press J. To delete the character at the current cursor  
position, press the O (Q) button.  
Custom Picture Control names can be up to nineteen  
characters long. Any characters after the nineteenth will be  
deleted.  
171  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7
Press X (T).  
Press the X (T) button to save  
changes and exit. The new Picture  
Control will appear in the Picture  
Control list.  
X (T) button  
AManage Picture Control > Rename  
Custom Picture Controls can be renamed at  
any time using the Rename option in the  
Manage Picture Control menu.  
AManage Picture Control > Delete  
The Delete option in the Manage Picture  
Control menu can be used to delete  
selected custom Picture Controls when they  
are no longer needed.  
AThe Original Picture Control Icon  
The original preset Picture Control on which  
the custom Picture Control is based is  
indicated by an icon in the top right corner  
of the edit display.  
Original Picture  
Control icon  
172  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sharing Custom Picture Controls  
Use the Load/save option in the Manage Picture Control menu  
to copy custom Picture Controls to and from memory cards.  
Custom Picture Controls can be created on a computer using  
Picture Control Utility 2, a utility launched from ViewNX 2  
(supplied) or Capture NX-D (0268), then saved to a memory  
card and copied to the camera. Custom Picture Controls created  
on the camera can be copied to a memory card for use in other  
D750s. Once the copies are no longer needed, they can be  
deleted using the Delete from card option.  
To copy custom Picture Controls to or  
from the memory card, or to delete  
custom Picture Controls from the  
memory card, highlight Load/save in the  
Manage Picture Control menu and  
press 2. The following options will be  
displayed:  
Copy to camera: Copy custom Picture Controls from the memory  
card to custom Picture Controls C-1 through C-9 on the  
camera and name them as desired.  
Delete from card: Delete selected custom  
Picture Controls from the memory  
card. The confirmation dialog shown  
at right will be displayed before a  
Picture Control is deleted; to delete  
the selected Picture Control, highlight  
Yes and press J.  
Copy to card: Copy a custom Picture Control (C-1 through C-9)  
from the camera to a selected destination (1 through 99) on  
the memory card.  
173  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ASaving Custom Picture Controls  
Up to 99 custom Picture Controls can be stored on the memory card at  
any one time. The memory card can only be used to store user-created  
custom Picture Controls. The preset Picture Controls supplied with the  
camera (0165) can not be copied to the memory card, renamed, or  
deleted.  
The options in the Manage Picture Control menu apply only to the  
memory card in Slot 1. Custom Picture Controls can not be deleted  
from or copied to or from the card in Slot 2.  
174  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Preserving Detail in Highlights and  
Shadows  
Active D-Lighting  
(P, S, A, and M Modes Only)  
Active D-Lighting preserves details in highlights and shadows,  
creating photographs with natural contrast. Use for high  
contrast scenes, for example when photographing brightly lit  
outdoor scenery through a door or window or taking pictures of  
shaded subjects on a sunny day. It is most effective when used  
with matrix metering (0139).  
Active D-Lighting off  
Active D-Lighting: YAuto  
D“Active D-Lighting” Versus “D-Lighting”  
The Active D-Lighting option in the photo shooting menu adjusts  
exposure before shooting to optimize the dynamic range, while the  
D-Lighting option in the retouch menu (0397) brightens shadows in  
images after shooting.  
175  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
To use Active D-Lighting:  
1
Select Active D-Lighting.  
Highlight Active D-Lighting in the  
photo shooting menu and press 2.  
2
Choose an option.  
Highlight the desired option and  
press J. If YAuto is selected, the  
camera will automatically adjust  
Active D-Lighting according to  
shooting conditions (in mode M,  
however, YAuto is equivalent to  
Q Normal).  
DActive D-Lighting  
Noise (randomly-spaced bright pixels, fog, or lines) may appear in  
photographs taken with Active D-Lighting. With some subjects, you  
may notice uneven shading, shadows around bright objects, or halos  
around dark objects. Active D-Lighting can not be used at ISO  
sensitivities of Hi 0.3 or above.  
ASee Also  
When ADL bracketing is selected for Custom Setting e6 (Auto  
bracketing set, 0353), the camera varies Active D-Lighting over a  
series of shots (0212). For information on using the Fn button and  
main command dial to select an Active D-Lighting option, see page  
176  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
High Dynamic Range (HDR)  
Used with high-contrast subjects, High Dynamic Range (HDR)  
preserves details in highlights and shadows by combining two  
shots taken at different exposures. HDR is most effective when  
used with matrix metering (0139; with spot or center-weighted  
metering and a non-CPU lens, a strength of Auto is equivalent to  
Normal). It can not be used to record NEF (RAW) images. Flash  
lighting, bracketing (0202), multiple exposure (0216), and  
time-lapse photography (0229) can not be used while HDR is in  
effect and shutter speeds of A and % are not available.  
+
First exposure (darker)  
Second exposure  
(brighter)  
Combined HDR image  
1
Select HDR (high dynamic range).  
Highlight HDR (high dynamic range)  
in the photo shooting menu and  
press 2.  
177  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
2
Select a mode.  
Highlight HDR mode and press 2.  
Highlight one of the following and  
press J.  
To take a series of HDR photographs, select  
6 On (series). HDR shooting will  
continue until you select Off for  
HDR mode.  
To take one HDR photograph, select On  
(single photo). Normal shooting will resume automatically  
after you have created a single HDR photograph.  
To exit without creating additional HDR photographs, select Off.  
If On (series) or On (single photo) is  
selected, a l icon will be displayed  
in the viewfinder.  
Viewfinder  
3
Choose the HDR strength.  
To choose the difference in exposure  
between the two shots (HDR  
strength), highlight HDR strength  
and press 2.  
Highlight the desired option and  
press J. If Auto is selected, the  
camera will automatically adjust HDR  
strength to suit the scene.  
178  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4
Frame a photograph, focus, and shoot.  
The camera takes two exposures  
when the shutter-release button is  
pressed all the way down. l j  
will flash in the control panel and  
l l in the viewfinder while the  
images are combined; no  
Control panel  
Viewfinder  
photographs can be taken until  
recording is complete. Regardless of  
the option currently selected for  
release mode, only one photograph  
will be taken each time the shutter-  
release button is pressed.  
If On (series) is selected, HDR will only turn off when Off is  
selected for HDR mode; if On (single photo) is selected, HDR  
turns off automatically after the photograph is taken. The  
l icon clears from the display when HDR shooting ends.  
DFraming HDR Photographs  
The edges of the image will be cropped out. The desired results may  
not be achieved if the camera or subject moves during shooting. Use  
of a tripod is recommended. Depending on the scene, the effect may  
not be visible, shadows may appear around bright objects, or halos  
may appear around dark objects. Uneven shading may be visible with  
some subjects.  
AInterval Timer Photography  
If On (series) is selected for HDR mode before interval timer shooting  
begins, the camera will continue to shoot HDR photographs at the  
selected interval (if On (single photo) is selected, interval timer  
shooting will end after a single shot).  
179  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Flash Photography  
Using the Built-in Flash  
The built-in flash can be used not only when natural lighting is  
inadequate but to fill in shadows and backlit subjects or to add a  
catch light to the subject’s eyes.  
Auto Pop-up Modes  
In i, k, p, n, o, s, w, and g modes, the built-in flash  
automatically pops up and fires as required.  
1
Choose a flash mode.  
Keeping the M (Y) button pressed, rotate the main  
command dial until the desired flash mode appears in the  
information display.  
M (Y) button  
Main command  
dial  
Information display  
180  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
2
Take pictures.  
The flash will pop up as  
required when the shutter-  
release button is pressed  
halfway and fire when a  
photograph is taken. If the  
flash does not pop up  
automatically, DO NOT attempt to raise it by hand. Failure to  
observe this precaution could damage the flash.  
❚❚ Flash Modes  
The following flash modes are available:  
Auto flash: When lighting is poor or the subject is backlit, the  
flash pops up automatically when the shutter-release button  
is pressed halfway and fires as required. Not available in o  
mode.  
Auto with red-eye reduction: Use for portraits. The flash pops up  
and fires as required, but before it fires the red-eye reduction  
lamp lights to help reduce “red-eye. Not available in o mode.  
Auto slow sync with red-eye reduction: As for auto with red-eye  
reduction, except that slow shutter speeds are used to  
capture background lighting. Use for portraits taken at night  
or under low light. Available in o mode.  
Auto slow sync: Slow shutter speeds are used to capture  
background lighting in shots taken at night or under low  
light. Available in o mode.  
Off: The flash does not fire.  
j
181  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Manual Pop-up Modes  
In P, S, A, M, and 0 modes, the flash must be raised manually. The  
flash will not fire if it is not raised.  
1
Raise the flash.  
Press the M (Y) button to raise the  
flash. Note that if the flash is off or an  
optional external flash unit is  
attached, the built-in flash will not  
pop up; proceed to Step 2.  
M (Y) button  
2
Choose a flash mode (P, S, A, and M modes only).  
Keeping the M (Y) button pressed, rotate the main  
command dial until the desired flash mode appears in the  
information display.  
M (Y) button  
Main command  
dial  
Information display  
3
Take pictures.  
If an option other than j is selected, the flash will fire  
whenever a picture is taken.  
182  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
❚❚ Flash Modes  
The following flash modes are available:  
Fill flash: The flash fires with every shot.  
Red-eye reduction: Use for portraits. The flash fires with every  
shot, but before it fires, the red-eye reduction lamp lights to  
help reduce “red-eye. Not available in 0 mode.  
Red-eye reduction with slow sync: As for “red-eye reduction, above,  
except that shutter speed slows automatically to capture  
background lighting at night or under low light. Use when  
you want to include background lighting in portraits. Not  
available in modes S, M, and 0.  
Slow sync: As for “fill flash, above, except that shutter speed  
slows automatically to capture background lighting at night  
or under low light. Use when you want to capture both  
subject and background. Not available in modes S, M, and 0.  
Slow rear-curtain sync: As for “rear-curtain sync, below, except  
that shutter speed slows automatically to capture  
background lighting at night or under low light. Use when  
you want to capture both subject and background. Not  
available in modes S, M, and 0. S is displayed when  
setting is complete.  
Rear-curtain sync: The flash fires just before the shutter closes,  
creating a stream of light behind moving light sources as  
shown below at right. Not available in modes P, A, and 0.  
Front-curtain sync  
Rear-curtain sync  
Off: The flash does not fire. Not available in 0 mode.  
j
183  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
AMetering  
Select matrix, center-weighted, or highlight-weighted metering to  
activate i-TTL balanced fill-flash for digital SLR. Standard i-TTL flash for  
digital SLR is activated automatically when spot metering is selected.  
ALowering the Built-in Flash  
To save power when the flash is not in use,  
press it gently downward until the latch  
clicks into place.  
DThe Built-in Flash  
Remove lens hoods to prevent shadows. The flash has a minimum  
range of 0.6 m (2 ft) and can not be used in the macro range of zoom  
lenses with a macro function. i-TTL flash control is available at ISO  
sensitivities between 100 and 12800; at other sensitivities, the desired  
results may not be achieved at some ranges or aperture values.  
If the flash fires in continuous release modes (0103), only one picture  
will be taken each time the shutter-release button is pressed.  
The shutter release may be briefly disabled to protect the flash after it  
has been used for several consecutive shots. The flash can be used  
again after a short pause.  
184  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
AShutter Speeds Available with the Built-in Flash  
The following shutter speeds are available with the built-in flash.  
Mode  
Shutter speed  
1
i, k, p, n, s, w, 0, g  
/
2001  
/
60 s  
1
o
P *, A *  
S *  
/
/
200–1 s  
1
2501  
/60 s  
1
/250–30 s  
1
M *  
/
250–30 s, A, %  
* Speeds as fast as 1  
/4000 s are available with optional flash units that support auto FP high-  
speed sync (0436) when 1/250 s (Auto FP) or 1/200 s (Auto FP) is selected  
for Custom Setting e1 (Flash sync speed, 0345). When 1/250 s (Auto FP) is  
selected, shutter speeds as fast as 1  
250 s are available with the built-in flash.  
/
AFlash Control Mode  
The camera supports the following i-TTL flash control modes:  
i-TTL balanced fill-flash for digital SLR: Flash emits series of nearly invisible  
preflashes (monitor preflashes) immediately before main flash.  
Preflashes reflected from objects in all areas of frame are picked up by  
RGB sensor with approximately 91K (91,000) pixels and are analyzed  
in combination with range information from matrix metering system  
to adjust flash output for natural balance between main subject and  
ambient background lighting. If type G, E, or D lens is used, distance  
information is included when calculating flash output. Precision of  
calculation can be increased for non-CPU lenses by providing lens  
data (focal length and maximum aperture; see 0235). Not available  
when spot metering is used.  
Standard i-TTL flash for digital SLR: Flash output adjusted to bring lighting  
in frame to standard level; brightness of background is not taken into  
account. Recommended for shots in which main subject is  
emphasized at expense of background details, or when exposure  
compensation is used. Standard i-TTL flash for digital SLR is activated  
automatically when spot metering is selected.  
185  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
The flash control mode for the built-in flash can be selected using  
Custom Setting e3 (Flash cntrl for built-in flash, 0347). The  
information display shows the flash control mode for the built-in flash  
as follows:  
Flash sync  
Auto FP (0345)  
i-TTL  
Manual  
Repeating flash  
Commander mode  
186  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AAperture, Sensitivity, and Flash Range  
Flash range varies with sensitivity (ISO equivalency) and aperture.  
Aperture at ISO equivalent of  
Range  
100 200 400 800 1600 3200 6400 12800  
m
ft  
1.4  
2
2.8  
4
5.6  
8
11  
16  
2
2.8  
4
5.6  
8
11  
16  
22  
2.8  
4
5.6  
8
11  
16  
22  
32  
4
5.6  
8
11  
16  
22  
32  
5.6  
8
8
11  
16  
22  
11  
16  
22  
16 0.7–8.5 2ft 4in.–27ft 10in.  
22 0.6–6.0  
32 0.6–4.2  
2ft–19ft 8in.  
2ft–13ft 9in.  
2ft–9ft 10in.  
2ft–6ft 10in.  
2ft–4ft 11in.  
2ft–3ft 7in.  
2ft–2ft 7in.  
11  
16  
22  
32  
32  
0.6–3.0  
0.6–2.1  
0.6–1.5  
0.6–1.1  
0.6–0.8  
32  
The built-in flash has a minimum range of 0.6 m (2 ft).  
In mode P, the maximum aperture (minimum f-number) is limited  
according to ISO sensitivity, as shown below:  
Maximum aperture at ISO equivalent of:  
100  
200  
400  
800  
1600  
3200  
6400  
12800  
2.8  
3.5  
4
5
5.6  
7.1  
8
10  
If the maximum aperture of the lens is smaller than given above, the  
maximum value for aperture will be the maximum aperture of the lens.  
ASee Also  
See page 190 for information on locking flash value (FV) for a metered  
subject before recomposing a photograph.  
For information on auto FP high-speed sync and choosing a flash sync  
speed, see Custom Setting e1 (Flash sync speed, 0345). For  
information on choosing the slowest shutter speed available when  
using the flash, see Custom Setting e2 (Flash shutter speed, 0346).  
For information on flash control and using the built-in flash in  
commander mode, see Custom Setting e3 (Flash cntrl for built-in  
flash, 0347).  
See page 433 for information on using optional flash units.  
187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Flash Compensation (P, S, A, M, and hModes Only)  
Flash compensation is used to alter flash output by from –3EV to  
+1EV in increments of 1  
3 EV, changing the brightness of the main  
/
subject relative to the background. Flash output can be  
increased to make the main subject appear brighter, or reduced  
to prevent unwanted highlights or reflections.  
Press the M (Y) button and rotate the sub-command dial until  
the desired value is displayed in the control panel, viewfinder, or  
information display. In general, choose positive values to make  
the main subject brighter, negative values to make it darker.  
M (Y) button  
Sub-command dial  
Control panel  
Information display  
0 EV  
(M (Y) button pressed)  
–0.3 (–1  
/3) EV  
+1.0 EV  
188  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
At values other than 0.0, a Y icon will be displayed in the  
control panel and viewfinder after you release the M (Y) button.  
The current value for flash compensation can be confirmed by  
pressing the M (Y) button.  
Normal flash output can be restored by setting flash  
compensation to 0.0. Flash compensation is not reset when  
the camera is turned off.  
AOptional Flash Units  
The flash compensation selected with the optional flash unit is added  
to the flash compensation selected with the camera.  
ASee Also  
For information on choosing the size of the increments available for  
flash compensation, see Custom Setting b2 (EV steps for exposure  
cntrl, 0333). For information on choosing how flash and exposure  
compensation combine, see Custom Setting e4 (Exposure comp. for  
flash, 0353). For information on automatically varying flash level  
over a series of shots, see page 202.  
189  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
FV Lock  
This feature is used to lock flash output, allowing photographs to  
be recomposed without changing the flash level and ensuring  
that flash output is appropriate to the subject even when the  
subject is not positioned in the center of the frame. Flash output  
is adjusted automatically for any changes in ISO sensitivity and  
aperture.  
To use FV lock:  
1
Assign FV lock to a camera control.  
Select FV lock as the “press” option  
for Custom Setting f2 (Assign Fn  
button, 0356), f3 (Assign preview  
button, 0361), or f4 (Assign AE-L/  
AF-L button, 0361).  
2
Raise the flash.  
In P, S, A, M, and 0 modes, the flash can  
be raised by pressing the M (Y)  
button. In i, k, p, n, o, s, w, and  
g modes, the flash will pop up  
automatically when required.  
M (Y) button  
3
Focus.  
Position the subject in the  
center of the frame and  
press the shutter-release  
button halfway to focus.  
190  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4
5
Lock flash level.  
After confirming that the flash ready  
indicator (M) is displayed in the  
viewfinder, press the button selected in Step 1. The flash will  
emit a monitor preflash to determine the appropriate flash  
level. Flash output will be locked at this level and FV lock  
icons (e) will appear in the viewfinder.  
Recompose the photograph.  
6
7
Take the photograph.  
Press the shutter-release button the rest of the way down to  
shoot. If desired, additional pictures can be taken without  
releasing FV lock.  
Release FV lock.  
Press the button selected in Step 1 to release FV lock.  
Confirm that the FV lock icon (e) is no longer displayed in the  
viewfinder.  
191  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
AUsing FV Lock with the Built-in Flash  
FV lock is only available with the built-in flash when TTL is selected for  
Custom Setting e3 (Flash cntrl for built-in flash, 0347).  
AUsing FV Lock with Optional Flash Units  
FV lock is also available with optional flash units in TTL and (where  
supported) monitor pre-flash AA and monitor pre-flash A flash control  
modes. Note that when commander mode is selected for Custom  
Setting e3 (Flash cntrl for built-in flash, 0347), you will need to set  
the flash control mode for the master or at least one remote group to  
TTL or AA.  
AMetering  
The metering areas for FV lock when using optional flash unit are as  
follows:  
Flash unit  
Flash mode  
Metered area  
5-mm circle in center of  
frame  
Area metered by flash  
exposure meter  
Entire frame  
i-TTL  
Stand-alone flash unit  
AA  
i-TTL  
AA  
A (master  
flash)  
Used with other flash  
units (Advanced Wireless  
Lighting)  
Area metered by flash  
exposure meter  
192  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Remote Control Photography  
Using an Optional ML-L3 Remote Control  
The optional ML-L3 remote control (0444) can be used to  
reduce camera shake or for self-portraits.  
1
2
Select Remote control mode (ML-L3).  
Highlight Remote control mode  
(ML-L3) in the photo shooting menu  
and press 2.  
Choose a remote control mode.  
Highlight one of the following options and press J.  
Option  
Description  
Shutter is released 2 s after ML-L3 shutter-  
release button is pressed.  
Quick-response Shutter is released when ML-L3 shutter-release  
Delayed remote  
%
$
remote  
button is pressed.  
Press ML-L3 shutter-release button once to  
raise mirror, again to release shutter and take  
photograph. Prevents blur caused by camera  
moving when mirror is raised.  
The shutter can not be released using the  
ML-L3.  
Remote  
mirror-up  
&
7
Off  
3
Frame the photograph.  
Mount the camera on a tripod or place the camera on a  
stable, level surface.  
193  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
4
Take the photograph.  
From a distance of 5 m (16 ft) or less,  
aim the transmitter on the ML-L3 at  
either of the infrared receivers on the  
camera (02, 4) and press the ML-L3  
shutter-release button. In delayed  
remote mode, the self-timer lamp will  
light for about two seconds before the  
shutter is released. In quick-response remote mode, the self-  
timer lamp will flash after the shutter has been released. In  
remote mirror-up mode, pressing the ML-L3 shutter-release  
button once raises the mirror; the shutter will be released and  
the self-timer lamp will flash after 30 s or when the button is  
pressed a second time.  
ARelease Mode  
When an optional ML-L3 remote control is used, the release mode  
selected with the release mode dial (0103) is ignored in favor of the  
option selected for Remote control mode (ML-L3) in the shooting  
menu.  
DBefore Using Optional ML-L3 Remote Controls  
Before using the remote control for the first time, remove the clear  
plastic battery-insulator sheet.  
194  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
AUsing the Built-in Flash  
Before taking a photograph with the flash in manual pop-up modes  
(0182), press the M (Y) button to raise the flash and wait for the M  
indicator to be displayed in the viewfinder (011). Shooting will be  
interrupted if the flash is raised while remote control mode is in effect.  
If the flash is required, the camera will only respond to the ML-L3  
shutter-release button once the flash has charged. In auto pop-up  
modes (0180), the flash will begin charging when remote control  
mode is selected; once the flash is charged, it will automatically pop up  
and fire when required.  
In flash modes that support red-eye reduction, the red-eye reduction  
lamp will light for about one second before the shutter is released. In  
delayed remote mode, the self-timer lamp will light for two seconds,  
followed by the red-eye reduction lamp which lights for one second  
before the shutter is released.  
AFocusing in Remote Control Mode  
The camera will not adjust focus continuously when continuous-servo  
autofocus is selected; note however that regardless of the autofocus  
mode selected, you can focus by pressing the camera shutter-release  
button halfway before shooting. If auto- or single-servo autofocus is  
selected or the camera is in live view in delayed or quick-response  
remote mode, the camera will automatically adjust focus before  
shooting; if the camera is unable to focus in viewfinder photography, it  
will return to stand-by without releasing the shutter.  
ARemote Mirror-up Mode  
While the mirror is raised, photos can not be framed in the viewfinder  
and autofocus and metering will not be performed.  
AExiting Remote Control Mode  
Remote control is cancelled automatically if no photograph is taken  
before the time selected for Custom Setting c5 (Remote on duration  
(ML-L3), 0337), Off is selected for Remote control mode (ML-L3), a  
two-button reset is performed (0199), or shooting options are reset  
using Reset photo shooting menu (0311).  
195  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DAssign Shutter Button  
If Record movies is selected for Custom Setting g4 (Assign shutter  
button, 0373), the ML-L3 can not be used when the live view selector  
is rotated to 1.  
ACover the Viewfinder  
To prevent light entering via the viewfinder from appearing in  
photographs or interfering with exposure, remove the rubber eyecup  
and cover the viewfinder with the supplied eyepiece cap (0107).  
ASee Also  
For information on choosing the length of time the camera will remain  
in stand-by mode waiting for a signal from the remote control, see  
Custom Setting c5 (Remote on duration (ML-L3); 0337). For  
information on controlling the beeps that sound when the remote  
control is used, see Custom Setting d1 (Beep; 0338).  
196  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wireless Remote Controllers  
When the camera is used with optional WR-1 (0444) and  
WR-R10/WR-T10 (0444) wireless remote controllers, the  
shutter-release buttons on the WR-1 and WR-T10 perform the  
same functions as the camera shutter-release button, allowing  
remote continuous and self-timer photography.  
WR-1 Wireless Remote Controllers  
The WR-1 can function as either a transmitter or a receiver and is  
used in combination either with another WR-1 or a WR-R10 or  
WR-T10 wireless remote controller. For example, a WR-1 can be  
connected to the accessory terminal for use as a receiver,  
allowing camera settings to be changed or the shutter to be  
released remotely by another WR-1 acting as a transmitter.  
WR-R10/WR-T10 Wireless Remote Controllers  
When a WR-R10 (transceiver) is connected to the camera, the  
shutter can be released using a WR-T10 (transmitter).  
197  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Other Shooting Options  
Viewfinder Photography: The P Button  
Pressing the P button during viewfinder  
photography displays a menu with the  
following options:  
P button  
Option  
Choose image area  
Set Picture Control  
Active D-Lighting  
HDR (high dynamic range)  
Remote control mode (ML-L3)  
0
Option  
0
110 Assign Fn button  
165 Assign preview button  
175 Assign AE-L/AF-L button  
177 Long exposure NR  
193 High ISO NR  
To exit the P-button menu and return to the shooting display,  
press the P button again.  
198  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Two-Button Reset: Restoring Default  
Settings  
The camera settings listed  
below can be restored to  
E button  
default values by holding the  
W(S) and E buttons down  
together for more than two  
seconds (these buttons are  
marked by a green dot). The  
control panel turns off briefly  
while settings are reset.  
W (S) button  
Option  
Image quality  
Image size  
White balance  
Fine tuning  
Picture Control settings 1  
HDR (high dynamic range)  
ISO sensitivity settings  
ISO sensitivity  
Default  
JPEG normal  
Large  
Auto > Normal  
A-B: 0, G-M: 0  
Unmodified  
Off2  
0
P, S, A, M  
Other modes  
Auto ISO sensitivity control  
Remote control mode (ML-L3)  
Interval timer shooting  
100  
Auto  
Off  
Off  
Off 3  
199  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Option  
Default  
0
Autofocus (viewfinder)  
Autofocus mode  
%
AF-S  
AF-A  
Other modes  
AF-area mode  
n, x, 0, 1, 2, 3  
m, w  
i, j, k, l, p, o, r, s, t, u, v, y, z,  
g, u, P, S, A, M  
Single-point AF  
51-point dynamic-area AF  
Auto-area AF  
AF-S  
Autofocus (live view/movie)  
Autofocus mode  
AF-area mode  
m, r, w, %, g, u, 1, 2, 3, P, S, A, M  
n, 0  
i, j, k, l, p, o, s, t, u, v, x, y, z  
Focus point 4  
Wide-area AF  
Normal-area AF  
Face-priority AF  
Center  
Exposure preview  
Off  
Multi-selector power aperture  
Highlight display  
Disable  
Off  
Headphone volume  
15  
Metering  
Matrix  
AE lock hold  
Off  
Bracketing  
Off5  
Off  
Off  
Off  
Flash compensation  
Exposure compensation  
Exposure delay mode  
200  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Option  
Default  
0
Flash mode  
i, k, p, n, w, g  
Auto  
s
Auto+red-eye reduction  
181,  
o
Auto+slow sync  
0, P, S, A, M  
Fill flash  
FV lock  
Off  
Off 6  
Off  
Multiple exposure  
Flexible program  
+ NEF (RAW)  
Off  
1
2
3
Current Picture Control only.  
HDR strength is not reset.  
If interval timer shooting is currently in progress, shooting will end. Starting time, shooting  
interval, number of intervals and shots, and exposure smoothing are not reset.  
Focus point not displayed if auto-area AF is selected for AF-area mode.  
Number of shots is reset to zero. Bracketing increment is reset to 1 EV (exposure/flash  
bracketing) or 1 (white balance bracketing). Y Auto is selected for the second shot of two-  
shot ADL bracketing programs.  
4
5
6
If multiple exposure is currently in progress, shooting will end and multiple exposure will be  
created from exposures recorded to that point. Gain and number of shots are not reset.  
201  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Bracketing  
(P, S, A, and M Modes Only)  
Bracketing automatically varies exposure, flash level, Active  
D-Lighting (ADL), or white balance slightly with each shot,  
“bracketing” the current value. Choose in situations in which it is  
difficult to set exposure, flash level (i-TTL and, where supported,  
auto aperture flash control modes only; see pages 185, 347, and  
435), white balance, or Active D-Lighting and there is not time to  
check results and adjust settings with each shot, or to  
experiment with different settings for the same subject.  
❚❚ Exposure and Flash Bracketing  
Vary exposure and/or flash level over a series of photographs.  
Exposure modified by: Exposure modified by: Exposure modified by:  
0 EV  
–1 EV  
+1 EV  
1
Select flash or exposure bracketing.  
Select Custom Setting e6 (Auto  
bracketing set) in the Custom  
Settings menu, highlight an option,  
and press J. Choose AE & flash to  
vary both exposure and flash level, AE  
only to vary only exposure, or Flash  
only to vary only flash level.  
202  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
2
Choose the number of shots.  
Pressing the D button, rotate the main command dial to  
choose the number of shots in the bracketing sequence. The  
number of shots is shown in the information display and  
control panel.  
Number of shots  
D button  
Main command  
dial  
Exposure and flash bracketing  
indicator  
Information display  
At settings other than zero, a M icon  
is displayed in the control panel.  
D appears in the viewfinder, while the information display  
provides a bracketing indicator and an icon showing the type  
of bracketing: v (exposure and flash bracketing), w  
(exposure bracketing only), or x (flash bracketing only).  
203  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
3
Select an exposure increment.  
Pressing the D button and rotate the sub-command dial to  
choose the exposure increment.  
Exposure increment  
D button  
Sub-command  
dial  
Information display  
At default settings, the size of the increment can be chosen  
from 0.3 (1  
/
3), 0.7 (2  
3), 1, 2, and 3 EV. The bracketing programs  
/
with an increment of 0.3 (1  
3) EV are listed below.  
/
No. of  
shots  
Information display  
Bracketing order (EVs)  
0
3
3
2
2
3
5
7
0
0/+0.3/+0.7  
0/–0.7/–0.3  
0/+0.3  
0/–0.3  
0/–0.3/+0.3  
0/–0.7/–0.3/+0.3/+0.7  
0/–1.0/–0.7/–0.3/+0.3/+0.7/+1.0  
0/–1.3/–1.0/–0.7/–0.3/+0.3/+0.7/  
+1.0/+1.3  
9
Note that for exposure increments of 2 EV or more, the  
maximum number of shots is 5; if a higher value was selected  
in Step 2, the number of shots will automatically be set to 5.  
204  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4
Frame a photograph, focus, and shoot.  
The camera will vary exposure and/or flash level  
shot-by-shot according to the bracketing program  
selected. Modifications to exposure are added to  
those made with exposure compensation (see page 143).  
A bracketing progress indicator is displayed while bracketing  
is in effect. A segment will disappear from the indicator after  
each shot.  
No. shots: 3; increment: 0.7  
Display after first shot  
ASee Also  
For information on choosing the size of the increment, see Custom  
Setting b2 (EV steps for exposure cntrl, 0333). For information on  
choosing the order in which bracketing is performed, see Custom  
Setting e7 (Bracketing order, 0354).  
205  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
❚❚ Canceling Bracketing  
To cancel bracketing, press the D button and rotate the main  
command dial until the number of shots in the bracketing  
sequence is zero (0F/r) and the exposure/flash bracketing  
indicators are no longer displayed. The program last in effect will  
be restored the next time bracketing is activated. Bracketing can  
also be cancelled by performing a two-button reset (0199),  
although in this case the bracketing program will not be  
restored the next time bracketing is activated.  
AExposure and Flash Bracketing  
In continuous release modes (0103), shooting will pause after the  
number of shots specified in the bracketing program have been taken.  
Shooting will resume the next time the shutter-release button is  
pressed. In self-timer mode, the camera will take the number of shots  
selected in Step 2 on page 203 each time the shutter-release button is  
pressed, regardless of the option selected for Custom Setting c3 (Self-  
timer) > Number of shots (0337); the interval between shots is  
however controlled by Custom Setting c3 (Self-timer) > Interval  
between shots. In other modes, one shot will be taken each time the  
shutter-release button is pressed.  
If the memory card fills before all shots in the sequence have been  
taken, shooting can be resumed from the next shot in the sequence  
after the memory card has been replaced or shots have been deleted  
to make room on the memory card. If the camera is turned off before  
all shots in the sequence have been taken, bracketing will resume from  
the next shot in the sequence when the camera is turned on.  
206  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AExposure Bracketing  
The camera modifies exposure by varying shutter speed and aperture  
(mode P), aperture (mode S), or shutter speed (modes A and M). If On is  
selected for ISO sensitivity settings > Auto ISO sensitivity control  
(0136) in modes P, S, and A, the camera will automatically vary ISO  
sensitivity for optimum exposure when the limits of the camera  
exposure system are exceeded; in mode M, the camera will first use  
auto ISO sensitivity control to bring exposure as close as possible to  
the optimum and then bracket this exposure by varying shutter speed.  
207  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
❚❚ White Balance Bracketing  
The camera creates multiple copies of each photograph, each  
with a different white balance. For more information on white  
1
Select white balance bracketing.  
Choose WB bracketing for Custom  
Setting e6 Auto bracketing set.  
2
Choose the number of shots.  
Pressing the D button, rotate the main command dial to  
choose the number of shots in the bracketing sequence. The  
number of shots is shown in the information display and  
control panel.  
Number of shots  
D button  
Main command  
dial  
WB bracketing indicator  
Information display  
At settings other than zero, M and  
D are displayed respectively in the  
control panel and viewfinder; a y icon and a bracketing  
indicator appear in the information display.  
208  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
3
Select a white balance increment.  
Pressing the D button, rotate the sub-command dial to  
choose from increments of 1 (5 mired; 0151), 2 (10 mired),  
or 3 (15 mired). The B value indicates the amount of blue, the  
A value the amount of amber (0149).  
White balance increment  
D button  
Sub-command  
dial  
Information display  
The bracketing programs with an increment of 1 are listed  
below.  
No. of White balance  
Information display  
Bracketing order  
shots  
increment  
2
2
3
1 B  
1 A  
1 A, 1 B  
0/1 B  
0/1 A  
0/1 A/1 B  
209  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4
Frame a photograph, focus, and  
shoot.  
Each shot will be processed to create  
the number of copies specified in the  
bracketing program, and each copy will have a different  
white balance. Modifications to white balance are added to  
the white balance adjustment made with white balance fine-  
tuning.  
If the number of shots in the  
bracketing program is greater than  
the number of exposures remaining,  
n and the icon for the affected  
card will flash in the control panel, a  
flashing j icon will appear in the  
viewfinder as shown at right, and  
the shutter release will be disabled.  
Shooting can begin when a new memory card is inserted.  
210  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
❚❚ Canceling Bracketing  
To cancel bracketing, press the D button and rotate the main  
command dial until the number of shots in the bracketing  
sequence is zero (0F/r) and the white balance bracketing  
indicators are no longer displayed. The program last in effect will  
be restored the next time bracketing is activated. Bracketing can  
also be cancelled by performing a two-button reset (0199),  
although in this case the bracketing program will not be  
restored the next time bracketing is activated.  
AWhite Balance Bracketing  
White balance bracketing is not available at an image quality of NEF  
(RAW). Selecting NEF (RAW), NEF (RAW)+JPEG fine, NEF  
(RAW)+JPEG normal, or NEF (RAW)+JPEG basic cancels white  
balance bracketing.  
White balance bracketing affects only color temperature (the amber-  
blue axis in the white balance fine-tuning display, 0149). No  
adjustments are made on the green-magenta axis.  
In self-timer mode (0106), the number of copies specified in the  
white-balance program will be created each time the shutter is  
released, regardless of the option selected for Custom Setting c3 (Self-  
timer) > Number of shots (0337).  
If the camera is turned off while the memory card access lamp is lit, the  
camera will power off only after all photographs in the sequence have  
been recorded.  
211  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
❚❚ ADL Bracketing  
The camera varies Active D-Lighting over a series of exposures.  
For more information on Active D-Lighting, see page 175.  
1
2
Select ADL bracketing.  
Choose ADL bracketing for Custom  
Setting e6 Auto bracketing set.  
Choose the number of shots.  
Pressing the D button, rotate the main command dial to  
choose the number of shots in the bracketing sequence. The  
number of shots is shown in the information display and  
control panel.  
Number of shots  
D button  
Main command  
dial  
ADL bracketing amount  
Information display  
At settings other than zero, M and D are displayed  
respectively in the control panel and viewfinder; a z icon  
and the bracketing amount appear in the information  
display.  
212  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Choose two shots to take one photograph with Active  
D-Lighting off and another at a selected value. Choose three  
to five shots to take a series of photographs with Active  
D-Lighting set to Off, Low, and Normal (three shots), Off,  
Low, Normal, and High (four shots), or Off, Low, Normal,  
High, and Extra high (five shots). If you choose more than  
two shots, proceed to Step 4.  
3
Select Active D-Lighting.  
Pressing the D button, rotate the sub-command dial to  
choose Active D-Lighting.  
D button  
Sub-command dial  
Active D-Lighting is shown in the information display and  
control panel.  
Active D-Lighting  
Information display  
Control panel display  
Auto  
Y
R
Q
P
Z
Low  
Normal  
High  
Extra high  
213  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
4
Frame a photograph, focus, and shoot.  
The camera will vary Active D-Lighting shot-by-  
shot according to the bracketing program  
selected. A bracketing progress indicator is  
displayed while bracketing is in effect. A segment will  
disappear from the indicator after each shot.  
No. shots: 3  
Display after first shot  
214  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
❚❚ Canceling Bracketing  
To cancel bracketing, press the D button and rotate the main  
command dial until the number of shots in the bracketing  
sequence is zero (0F/r) and the ADL bracketing indicators are  
no longer displayed. The program last in effect will be restored  
the next time bracketing is activated. Bracketing can also be  
cancelled by performing a two-button reset (0199), although  
in this case the bracketing program will not be restored the next  
time bracketing is activated.  
AADL Bracketing  
In continuous release modes (0103), shooting will pause after the  
number of shots specified in the bracketing program have been taken.  
Shooting will resume the next time the shutter-release button is  
pressed. In self-timer mode, the camera will take the number of shots  
selected in Step 2 on page 212 each time the shutter-release button is  
pressed, regardless of the option selected for Custom Setting c3 (Self-  
timer) > Number of shots (0337); the interval between shots is  
however controlled by Custom Setting c3 (Self-timer) > Interval  
between shots. In other modes, one shot will be taken each time the  
shutter-release button is pressed.  
If the memory card fills before all shots in the sequence have been  
taken, shooting can be resumed from the next shot in the sequence  
after the memory card has been replaced or shots have been deleted  
to make room on the memory card. If the camera is turned off before  
all shots in the sequence have been taken, bracketing will resume from  
the next shot in the sequence when the camera is turned on.  
215  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Multiple Exposure  
(P, S, A, and M Modes Only)  
Follow the steps below to record a series of two or three  
exposures in a single photograph. Multiple exposures can make  
use of RAW data from the camera image sensor to produce  
colors noticeably superior to those in software-generated  
photographic overlays.  
❚❚ Creating a Multiple Exposure  
Multiple exposures can not be recorded in live view. Exit live  
view before proceeding. Note that at default settings, shooting  
will end and a multiple exposure will be recorded automatically  
if no operations are performed for 30 s.  
AExtended Recording Times  
For an interval between exposures of more than 30 s, extend the  
meter-off delay using Custom Setting c2 (Standby timer, 0336). The  
maximum interval between exposures is 30 s longer than the option  
selected for Custom Setting c2. If the monitor turns off during  
playback or menu operations and no operations are performed for 30 s  
after the standby timer has expired, shooting will end and a multiple  
exposure will be created from the exposures that have been recorded  
to that point.  
1
Select Multiple exposure.  
Highlight Multiple exposure in the  
photo shooting menu and press 2.  
216  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
2
Select a mode.  
Highlight Multiple exposure mode  
and press 2.  
Highlight one of the following and  
press J.  
To take a series of multiple exposures,  
select 6 On (series). Multiple  
exposure shooting will continue  
until you select Off for Multiple  
exposure mode.  
To take one multiple exposure, select On (single photo). Normal  
shooting will resume automatically after you have created a  
single multiple exposure.  
To exit without creating additional multiple exposures, select Off.  
If On (series) or On (single photo) is  
selected, a n icon will be displayed in  
the control panel.  
217  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3
4
Choose the number of shots.  
Highlight Number of shots and press  
2.  
Press 1or 3to choose the number of  
exposures that will be combined to  
form a single photograph and press  
J.  
Choose the amount of gain.  
Highlight Auto gain and press 2.  
The following options will be  
displayed. Highlight an option and  
press J.  
On: Gain is adjusted according to  
number of exposures actually  
recorded (gain for each exposure is  
set to 1  
/
2 for 2 exposures, 1  
3 for 3  
/
exposures, etc.).  
Off: Gain is not adjusted when recording multiple exposure.  
Note that photographs may be affected by noise (randomly-  
spaced bright pixels, fog, or lines).  
218  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
5
Frame a photograph, focus, and shoot.  
In continuous release modes (0103), the camera  
records all exposures in a single burst. If On  
(series) is selected, the camera will continue to  
record multiple exposures while the shutter-release button is  
pressed; if On (single photo) is selected, multiple exposure  
shooting will end after the first photograph. In self-timer  
mode, the camera will automatically record the number of  
exposures selected in Step 3 on page 218, regardless of the  
option selected for Custom Setting c3 (Self-timer) > Number  
of shots (0337); the interval between shots is however  
controlled by Custom Setting c3 (Self-timer) > Interval  
between shots. In other release modes, one photograph will  
be taken each time the shutter-release button is pressed;  
continue shooting until all exposures have been recorded (for  
information on interrupting a multiple exposure before all  
photographs are recorded, see page 220).  
The n icon will flash until shooting  
ends. If On (series) is selected,  
multiple exposure shooting will only  
end when Off is selected for multiple  
exposure mode; if On (single photo)  
is selected, multiple exposure shooting ends automatically  
when the multiple exposure is complete. The n icon clears  
from the display when multiple exposure shooting ends.  
219  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
❚❚ Interrupting Multiple Exposures  
To interrupt a multiple exposure before  
the specified number of exposures have  
been taken, select Off for multiple  
exposure mode. If shooting ends before  
the specified number of exposures have  
been taken, a multiple exposure will be  
created from the exposures that have  
been recorded to that point. If Auto gain is on, gain will be  
adjusted to reflect the number of exposures actually recorded.  
Note that shooting will end automatically if:  
A two-button reset is performed (0199)  
The camera is turned off  
The battery is exhausted  
Pictures are deleted  
220  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DMultiple Exposures  
Do not remove or replace the memory card while recording a multiple  
exposure.  
Multiple exposures can not be recorded in live view. Taking  
photographs in live view resets Multiple exposure mode to Off.  
The shooting information listed in the playback photo information  
display (including metering, exposure, shooting mode, focal length,  
date of recording and camera orientation) is for the first shot in the  
multiple exposure.  
AInterval Timer Photography  
If interval timer photography is activated before the first exposure is  
taken, the camera will record exposures at the selected interval until  
the number of exposures specified in the multiple exposure menu  
have been taken (the number of shots listed in the interval timer  
shooting menu is ignored). These exposures will then be recorded as a  
single photograph and interval timer shooting will end (if On (single  
photo) is selected for multiple exposure mode, multiple exposure  
shooting will also end automatically).  
AOther Settings  
While a multiple exposure is being shot, memory cards can not be  
formatted and some menu items are grayed out and can not be  
changed.  
221  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Interval Timer Photography  
The camera is equipped to take photographs automatically at  
preset intervals.  
DBefore Shooting  
Select a release mode other than self-timer (E) and V when using  
the interval timer. Before beginning interval timer photography, take a  
test shot at current settings and view the results in the monitor. Once  
settings have been adjusted to your satisfaction, remove the rubber  
eyecup and cover the viewfinder with the supplied eyepiece cap to  
prevent light entering via the viewfinder interfering with photographs  
and exposure (0107).  
Before choosing a starting time, select Time zone and date in the  
setup menu and make sure that the camera clock is set to the correct  
time and date (0381).  
Use of a tripod is recommended. Mount the camera on a tripod before  
shooting begins. To ensure that shooting is not interrupted, be sure  
the camera battery is fully charged. If in doubt, charge the battery  
before use or use an AC adapter and power connector (available  
separately).  
1
Select Interval timer shooting.  
Highlight Interval timer shooting in  
the photo shooting menu and  
press 2to display interval timer  
settings.  
222  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
2
Adjust interval timer settings.  
Choose a start option, interval, number of shots per interval,  
and exposure smoothing option.  
To choose a start option:  
Highlight Start options and  
Highlight an option and  
press 2.  
press J.  
To start shooting immediately, select Now. To start  
shooting at a chosen date and time, select Choose start  
day and start time, then choose the date and time and  
press J.  
To choose the interval between shots:  
Highlight Interval and  
Choose an interval (hours,  
minutes, and seconds) and  
press J.  
press 2.  
223  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
To choose the number of shots per interval:  
Highlight No. of intervals ×  
Choose the number of intervals  
shots/interval and press 2.  
and the number of shots per  
interval and press J.  
In S (single frame) mode, the photographs for each interval  
will be taken at the rate chosen for Custom Setting d2  
(Continuous low-speed, 0338).  
To enable or disable exposure smoothing:  
Highlight Exposure  
Highlight an option and  
smoothing and press 2.  
press J.  
Selecting On allows the camera to adjust exposure to match  
previous shot in modes other than M (note that exposure  
smoothing only takes effect in mode M if auto ISO sensitivity  
control is on).  
224  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
3
Start shooting.  
Highlight Start and press J. The first  
series of shots will be taken at the  
specified starting time, or after about  
3 s if Now was selected for Start  
options in Step 2. Shooting will  
continue at the selected interval until  
all shots have been taken.  
ADuring Shooting  
During interval timer photography, the  
memory card access lamp will flash.  
Immediately before the next shooting  
interval begins, the shutter speed display  
will show the number of intervals remaining,  
and the aperture display will show the  
number of shots remaining in the current  
interval. At other times, the number of  
intervals remaining and the number of shots  
in each interval can be viewed by pressing  
Memory card access  
lamp  
the shutter-release button halfway (once the button is released, the  
shutter speed and aperture will be displayed until the standby timer  
expires).  
Pictures can be played back while interval timer photography is in  
progress. The monitor will turn off automatically about four seconds  
before each interval. Note that changing camera settings while the  
interval timer is active may cause shooting to end.  
225  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
❚❚ Pausing Interval Timer Photography  
Interval timer photography can be paused between intervals by  
pressing J or selecting Pause in the interval timer menu.  
❚❚ Resuming Interval Timer Shooting  
To resume shooting:  
Starting Now  
Highlight Restart and  
press J.  
Starting at a Specified Time  
For Start options,  
Choose a starting date Highlight Restart and  
highlightChoosestart and time and press J.  
day and start time  
press J.  
and press 2.  
❚❚ Ending Interval Timer Shooting  
To end interval timer photography and resume normal shooting  
before all the photos are taken, select Off in the interval timer  
menu.  
226  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
❚❚ No Photograph  
The camera will skip the current interval if any of the following  
situations persist for eight seconds or more after the interval was  
due to start: the photograph or photographs for the previous  
interval have yet to be taken, the memory card is full, or the  
camera is unable to focus in AF-S or when single-servo AF is  
selected in AF-A (note that the camera focuses again before each  
shot). Shooting will resume with the next interval.  
DOut of Memory  
If the memory card is full, the interval timer will remain active but no  
pictures will be taken. Resume shooting (0226) after deleting some  
pictures or turning the camera off and inserting another memory card.  
AInterval Timer Photography  
Choose an interval longer than the time needed to take the selected  
number of shots. If the interval is too short, the number of photos  
taken may be less than the total listed in Step 2 (the number of  
intervals multiplied by the number of shots per interval). Interval timer  
photography can not be combined with long time-exposures (bulb or  
time photography, 095) or live view or time-lapse photography  
(054, 229) and is not available in movie live view (066) or when  
Record movies is selected for Custom Setting g4 (Assign shutter  
button, 0373). Note that because the shutter speed, frame rate, and  
time needed to record images may vary from one interval to the next,  
the time between the end of one interval and the beginning of the  
next may vary. If shooting can not proceed at current settings (for  
example, if a shutter speed of A or % is currently selected in  
manual exposure mode, the interval is zero, or the start time is in less  
than a minute), a warning will be displayed in the monitor.  
Interval timer shooting will pause when E (self-timer) or V mode is  
selected or if the camera is turned off and then on again (when the  
camera is off, batteries and memory cards can be replaced without  
ending interval timer photography). Pausing shooting does not affect  
interval timer settings.  
227  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ARelease Mode  
Regardless of the release mode selected, the camera will take the  
specified number of shots at each interval.  
ABracketing  
Adjust bracketing settings before starting interval timer photography.  
If exposure, flash, or ADL bracketing is active while interval timer  
photography is in effect, the camera will take the number of shots in  
the bracketing program at each interval, regardless of the number of  
shots specified in the interval timer menu. If white balance bracketing  
is active while interval timer photography is in effect, the camera will  
take one shot at each interval and process it to create the number of  
copies specified in the bracketing program.  
228  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Time-Lapse Photography  
(i, j, P, S, A, M, and h Modes Only)  
The camera automatically takes photos at selected intervals to  
create a silent time-lapse movie at the frame size and rate  
currently selected in the movie shooting menu (0318). For  
information on the image area used for time-lapse movies, see  
page 76.  
ABefore Shooting  
Before beginning time-lapse photography, take a test shot at current  
settings (framing the photo in the viewfinder for an accurate exposure  
preview) and view the results in the monitor. For consistent coloration,  
choose a white balance setting other than auto (0145). Once settings  
have been adjusted to your satisfaction, remove the rubber eyecup  
and cover the viewfinder with the supplied eyepiece cap to prevent  
light entering via the viewfinder interfering with photographs and  
exposure (0107).  
Use of a tripod is recommended. Mount the camera on a tripod before  
shooting begins. To ensure that shooting is not interrupted, use an  
optional AC adapter and power connector or a fully-charged battery.  
1
Select Time-lapse photography.  
Highlight Time-lapse photography  
in the movie shooting menu and  
press 2to display time-lapse  
photography settings.  
229  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
2
Adjust time-lapse photography settings.  
Choose an interval, total shooting time, and exposure  
smoothing option.  
To choose the interval between frames:  
Highlight Interval and  
Choose an interval longer than  
the slowest anticipated shutter  
speed (minutes and seconds)  
and press J.  
press 2.  
To choose the total shooting time:  
Highlight Shooting time and  
Choose shooting time (up to  
7 hours 59 minutes) and  
press J.  
press 2.  
230  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
To enable or disable exposure smoothing:  
Highlight Exposure  
Highlight an option and  
smoothing and press 2.  
press J.  
Selecting On smooths abrupt changes in exposure in  
modes other than M (note that exposure smoothing only  
takes effect in mode M if auto ISO sensitivity control is on).  
3
Start shooting.  
Highlight Start and press J. Time-  
lapse photography starts after about  
3 s. The camera takes photographs at  
the selected interval for the selected  
shooting time. When complete, time-  
lapse movies are recorded to the  
memory card selected for Destination in movie shooting  
menu (0319).  
231  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
❚❚ Ending Time-Lapse Photography  
To end time-lapse photography before all the photos are taken,  
highlight Off in the time-lapse photography menu and press J,  
or press J between frames or immediately after a frame is  
recorded. A movie will be created from the frames shot to the  
point where time-lapse photography ended. Note that time-  
lapse photography will end and no movie will be recorded if the  
power source is removed or disconnected or the destination  
memory card is ejected.  
❚❚ No Photograph  
The camera will skip the current frame if it is unable to focus  
using single-servo autofocus (AF-S or single-servo autofocus  
selected for AF-A; note that the camera focuses again before each  
shot). Shooting will resume with the next frame.  
DTime-Lapse Photography  
Time-lapse is not available in live view (054, 66), at a shutter speed of  
A or % (095), when bracketing (0202), High Dynamic Range  
(HDR, 0177), multiple exposure (0216), or interval timer  
photography (0222) is active. Note that because shutter speed and  
the time needed to record the image to the memory card may vary  
from shot to shot, the interval between a shot being recorded and the  
start of the next shot may vary. Shooting will not begin if a time-lapse  
movie can not be recorded at current settings (for example, if the  
memory card is full, the interval or shooting time is zero, or the interval  
is longer than the shooting time).  
Time-lapse photography may end if camera controls are used or  
settings are changed or HDMI cable is connected. A movie will be  
created from the frames shot to the point where time-lapse  
photography ended.  
232  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ACalculating the Length of the Final Movie  
The total number of frames in the final  
movie can be approximated by dividing the  
shooting time by the interval and rounding  
up. The length of the final movie can then  
be calculated by dividing the number of  
shots by the frame rate selected for Frame  
size/frame rate in movie shooting menu  
(0319). A 48 frame movie recorded at  
1920 × 1080; 24p, for example, will be  
about two seconds long. The maximum  
length for movies recorded using time-  
lapse photography is 20 minutes.  
Length recorded/  
maximum length  
Memory card  
indicator  
Frame size/  
frame rate  
ADuring Shooting  
During time-lapse photography, the  
memory card access lamp will flash and the  
time-lapse recording indicator will be  
displayed in the control panel. The time  
remaining (in hours and minutes) appears  
in the shutter-speed display immediately before each frame is  
recorded. At other times, the time remaining can be viewed by  
pressing the shutter-release button halfway. Regardless of the option  
selected for Custom Setting c2 (Standby timer, 0336), the standby  
timer will not expire during shooting.  
To view current time-lapse photography  
settings or end time-lapse photography,  
press the G button between shots.  
233  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
A Image Review  
The K button can not be used to view pictures while time-lapse  
photography is in progress, but the current frame will be displayed for  
a few seconds after each shot if On is selected for Image review in the  
playback menu (0 307). Other playback operations can not be  
performed while the frame is displayed.  
A Flash Photography  
To use the flash during time-lapse photography, select mode P, S, A, or  
M and press the M (Y) button to raise the flash before shooting begins.  
A Release Mode  
Regardless of the release mode selected, the camera will take one shot  
at each interval. The self-timer can not be used.  
A See Also  
For information on setting a beep to sound when time-lapse  
photography is complete, see Custom Setting d1 (Beep, 0 338).  
234  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Non-CPU Lenses  
Non-CPU lenses can be used in modes A and M, with aperture set  
using the lens aperture ring. By specifying lens data (lens focal  
length and maximum aperture), the user can gain access to the  
following CPU lens functions.  
If the focal length of the lens is known:  
Power zoom can be used with optional flash units (0433)  
Lens focal length is listed (with an asterisk) in the playback  
photo info display  
If the maximum aperture of the lens is known:  
The aperture value is displayed in the control panel and  
viewfinder  
Flash level is adjusted for changes in aperture if the flash unit  
supports AA (auto aperture) mode  
Aperture is listed (with an asterisk) in the playback photo info  
display  
Specifying both the focal length and maximum aperture of the lens:  
Enables color matrix metering (note that it may be necessary  
to use center-weighted or spot metering to achieve accurate  
results with some lenses, including Reflex-NIKKOR lenses)  
Improves the precision of center-weighted and spot metering  
and i-TTL balanced fill-flash for digital SLR  
235  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
The camera can store data for up to nine non-CPU lenses. To  
enter or edit data for a non-CPU lens:  
1
2
3
4
Select Non-CPU lens data.  
Highlight Non-CPU lens data in the  
setup menu and press 2.  
Choose a lens number.  
Highlight Lens number and press 4  
or 2to choose a lens number.  
Enter the focal length and aperture.  
Highlight Focal length (mm) or  
Maximum aperture and press 4or  
2to edit the highlighted item.  
Save settings and exit.  
Press J. The specified focal length and aperture will be  
stored under the chosen lens number.  
236  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
AFocal Length Not Listed  
If the correct focal length is not listed, choose the closest value greater  
than the actual focal length of the lens.  
ATeleconverters and Zoom Lenses  
The maximum aperture for teleconverters is the combined maximum  
aperture of the teleconverter and the lens. Note that lens data are not  
adjusted when non-CPU lenses are zoomed in or out. The data for  
different focal lengths can be entered as separate lens numbers, or the  
data for the lens can be edited to reflect the new values for lens focal  
length and maximum aperture each time zoom is adjusted.  
237  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
To recall lens data when using a non-CPU lens:  
1
Assign non-CPU lens number selection to a camera control.  
Select Choose non-CPU lens number as the “Press +  
command dials” option for a camera control in the Custom  
Settings menu (0323). Non-CPU lens number selection can  
be assigned to the Fn button (Custom Setting f2, Assign Fn  
button, 0356), the Pv button (Custom Setting f3, Assign  
preview button, 0361), or the A AE-L/AF-L button (Custom  
Setting f4, Assign AE-L/AF-L button, 0361).  
2
Use the selected control to choose the lens number.  
Press the selected button and rotate the main command dial  
until the desired lens number is displayed in the control  
panel.  
Maximum  
Focal length  
aperture  
Lens number  
Fn button Main command  
Control panel  
dial  
238  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Location Data  
The GP-1/GP-1A GPS unit (available separately) can be  
connected to the camera’s accessory terminal (0443) using the  
cable supplied with the GP-1/GP-1A, allowing information on  
the camera’s current position to be recorded when photographs  
are taken. Turn the camera off before connecting the GP-1/  
GP-1A; for more information, see the GP-1/GP-1A manual.  
❚❚ Setup Menu Options  
The Location data item in the setup menu contains the options  
listed below.  
Standby timer: Choose whether the exposure meters turn off  
automatically when the GP-1/GP-1A is attached.  
Option  
Description  
Exposure meters turn off automatically if no operations  
are performed for the period specified in Custom Setting  
c2 (Standby timer, 0336; to allow the camera time to  
Enable acquire location data, the delay is extended by up to one  
minute after the exposure meters are activated or the  
camera is turned on). This reduces the drain on the  
battery.  
Exposure meters do not turn off while the GP-1/GP-1A is  
connected.  
Disable  
Position: This item is only available if the GP-1/GP-1A is  
connected, when it displays the current latitude, longitude,  
altitude, and Coordinated Universal Time (UTC) as reported by  
the GP-1/GP-1A.  
Set clock from satellite: Select Yes to synchronize the camera  
clock with the time reported by the GPS device.  
239  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
ACoordinated Universal Time (UTC)  
UTC data is provided by the GPS device and is independent of the  
camera clock.  
AThe o Icon  
Connection status is shown by the o icon:  
o (static): The camera has established  
communication with GP-1/GP-1A. Photo  
information for pictures taken while this  
icon is displayed includes an additional  
page of location data (0253).  
o (flashing): The GP-1/GP-1A is searching  
for a signal. Pictures taken while the icon  
is flashing do not include location data.  
No icon: No new location data have been received from the GP-1/  
GP-1A for at least two seconds. Pictures taken when the o icon is not  
displayed do not include location data.  
240  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
More on Playback  
Viewing Pictures  
Full-Frame Playback  
To play photographs back, press the K  
button. The most recent photograph will  
be displayed in the monitor.  
K button  
To  
Use  
Description  
Press 2to view photographs in order  
recorded, 4to view photographs in  
reverse order.  
View additional  
photographs  
View photo  
information  
Press 1or 3to view information  
about current photograph (0246).  
Press the shutter-release button  
halfway or press the K button to exit  
to shooting mode.  
Return to  
shooting mode  
/
K
If current picture is marked with 1  
icon to show that it is a movie,  
pressing J starts movie playback  
(079).  
Play movie  
J
241  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
ARotate Tall  
To display “tall” (portrait-orientation)  
photographs in tall orientation, select On for  
the Rotate tall option in the playback menu  
AImage Review  
When On is selected for Image review in the playback menu (0307),  
photographs are automatically displayed in the monitor after shooting  
(because the camera is already in the correct orientation, images are  
not rotated automatically during image review). In continuous release  
modes, display begins when shooting ends, with the first photograph  
in the current series displayed.  
242  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Thumbnail Playback  
To display images in “contact sheets” of four, nine, or 72 images,  
press the W (S) button.  
W (S)  
W (S)  
X (T)  
X (T)  
Full-frame  
playback  
Thumbnail playback  
Calendar  
playback  
To  
Use  
Description  
Use multi selector to highlight  
images for full-frame playback,  
playback zoom (0255), deletion  
(0258), or protection (0257).  
Press J to display the highlighted  
image full frame.  
Highlight images  
View highlighted  
image  
J
Press the shutter-release button  
halfway or press the K button to  
exit to shooting mode.  
Return to shooting  
mode  
/
K
243  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Calendar Playback  
To view images taken on a selected date, press the W (S)  
button when 72 images are displayed.  
Date list  
W (S)  
W (S)  
X (T)  
X (T)  
Thumbnail list  
Full-frame  
playback  
Thumbnail playback  
Calendar  
playback  
The operations that can be performed depend on whether the  
cursor is in the date list or the thumbnail list:  
To  
Use  
Description  
Press W (S) or J button in  
date list to place cursor in  
thumbnail list. Press W (S)  
again to return to date list.  
Date list: Exit to 72-frame  
playback.  
Thumbnail list: Press and hold  
X (T) button to zoom in on  
highlighted picture.  
Toggle between  
date list and  
thumbnail list  
W (S)/J  
Exit to thumbnail  
playback/Zoom in  
on highlighted  
photo  
X (T)  
Highlight dates/  
Highlight images  
Date list: Highlight date.  
Thumbnail list: Highlight picture.  
Toggle full frame  
playback  
Thumbnail list: View highlighted  
picture.  
J
Press the shutter-release button  
halfway or press the K button to  
exit to shooting mode.  
Return to shooting  
mode  
/
K
244  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
The P Button  
Pressing the P button during full-frame  
or thumbnail playback displays the  
options listed below.  
Playback slot and folder: Choose a folder  
for playback. Highlight a slot and press  
2to list the folders on the selected  
card, then highlight a folder and press  
J to view the pictures in the  
P button  
highlighted folder.  
Retouch (photographs only): Use the  
options in the retouch menu (0393)  
to create a retouched copy of the  
current photograph.  
Edit movie (movies only): Edit movies  
using the options in the edit movie menu (081). Movies can  
also be edited by pressing the P button when movie playback  
is paused.  
Select to send to smart device/deselect: Select photos for upload to  
a smart device (0289).  
To exit the P-button menu and return to playback, press the  
P button again.  
245  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Photo Information  
Photo information is superimposed on images displayed in full-  
frame playback. Press 1or 3to cycle through photo  
information as shown below. Note that “image only, shooting  
data, RGB histograms, highlights, and overview data are only  
displayed if corresponding option is selected for Playback  
display options (0302). Location data are only displayed if a  
GP-1/GP-1A was used when the photo was taken (0239).  
1
/
12  
1/  
12  
NIKON D750  
.
i 0  
1
4000 F2. 8  
H
3
85mm  
+
.
1
1. 3  
0
SLOW  
0,  
C_0001. JP  
0
_
.
N
OR  
M
AL  
100ND750  
D
S
G
MAL  
601N6Ox4R016  
100ND750  
04  
D
S
C
:
0001 JP  
G
:
:
:
15  
/
/
2014 10 02 28  
6016x4016  
15  
/
04 2014 10 02 28  
/
File information  
None (image only)  
Overview data  
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
L
L
A
T I T  
U
D
U
E
N
E
.
35  
º
º
35 971  
ONG I T  
D
E
)
.
139  
35  
43 696  
ALMT I TUD  
E
C
T I  
E
(
U
T
15  
/
m04  
/
2014  
:
:
10 02 28  
-
100 1  
N
I
KO  
N
D750  
Highlights  
Location data  
.
:
:
.
4000, F2  
M
TR SP  
D
D
.
,
A
P
,
1
.
/
8
.
EXP  
,
M
O
E, I S  
O
,
.
H
i
0
3
+
:
+
EXP  
T
UN  
I
NG  
H
1mm3,  
5
/
/
6
.
:
F
O
CA  
L
LENG  
T
85  
85  
S
:
LE  
N
S
/
1
4
:
-
A
F
VR  
/
VR  
O
n
:
-
FL  
SY  
,
A
N
S
C
HMTYPE  
Bu i  
l
t
i n,WCM  
D
0
:
O
:
D
E
SL  
O
+
:
+
.
:
:
.
3
M
B
TTL,  
3
0
A
TTL,  
---  
:
---  
C
-
100 1  
N
I
KO  
N
D750  
RGB histogram  
Shooting data  
246  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
❚❚ File Information  
1 2 3 4  
5
6
1
/12  
14  
13  
12  
_
.
N
ORMAL  
100ND750  
04  
D
S
C
:
0001 JP  
G
7
:
6016x4016  
15  
/
/
2014 10 02 28  
11 10  
9
8
1 Protect status...............................257 8 Image size..................................... 118  
2 Retouch indicator .......................393 9 Image area ................................... 110  
3 Upload marking ..........................290 10 Time of recording ................ 28, 381  
4 Focus point 1, 2 ..............................127 11 Date of recording................. 28, 381  
5 AF area brackets 1.......................... 35 12 Current card slot ......................... 119  
6 Frame number/total number of  
13 Folder name................................. 311  
frames  
14 File name ...................................... 313  
7 Image quality...............................115  
1
2
Displayed only if Focus point is selected for Playback display options (0302).  
If photograph was taken using AF-S or with single-servo autofocus selected during AF-A,  
display shows point where focus first locked. If photograph was taken using AF-C or with  
continuous-servo autofocus selected during AF-A, focus point is only displayed if option other  
than auto-area AF was selected for AF-area mode and camera was able to focus.  
247  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
❚❚ Highlights  
1
2
3
1 Image highlights *  
3 Current channel *  
2 Folder number—frame  
number ........................................ 311  
*Flashing areas indicate highlights (areas that may be  
overexposed) for the current channel. Hold W (S)  
button and press 4or 2to cycle through channels as  
follows:  
W (S) button  
RGB  
R
G
B
(all channels)  
(red)  
(green)  
(blue)  
248  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
❚❚ RGB Histogram  
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
1 Image highlights *  
5 Histogram (RGB channel). In all  
histograms, horizontal axis gives  
pixel brightness, vertical axis  
number of pixels.  
2 Folder number—frame  
number ........................................311  
3 White balance..............................145  
Color temperature................152  
White balance  
6 Histogram (red channel)  
7 Histogram (green channel)  
8 Histogram (blue channel)  
fine-tuning..........................149  
Preset manual........................155  
4 Current channel *  
*Flashing areas indicate highlights (areas that may be  
overexposed) for the current channel. Hold W (S)  
button and press 4or 2to cycle through channels as  
follows:  
W (S) button  
RGB  
R
G
B
(all channels)  
(red)  
(green)  
(blue)  
Highlight display off  
249  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
APlayback Zoom  
To zoom in on the photograph when the  
histogram is displayed, press X (T). Use  
the X (T) and W (S) buttons to zoom  
in and out and scroll the image with the  
multi selector. The histogram will be  
updated to show only the data for the  
portion of the image visible in the monitor.  
AHistograms  
Camera histograms are intended as a guide only and may differ from  
those displayed in imaging applications. Some sample histograms are  
shown below:  
If the image contains objects  
with a wide range of  
brightnesses, the distribution of  
tones will be relatively even.  
If the image is dark, tone  
distribution will be shifted to the  
left.  
If the image is bright, tone  
distribution will be shifted to the  
right.  
Increasing exposure compensation shifts the distribution of tones to  
the right, while decreasing exposure compensation shifts the  
distribution to the left. Histograms can provide a rough idea of overall  
exposure when bright ambient lighting makes it difficult to see  
photographs in the monitor.  
250  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
❚❚ Shooting Data  
1
2
.
:
:
.
4000, F2  
M
TR SP  
.
D
D
.
,
A
P
,
1
.
/
8
3
EXP  
,
M
O
E, I S  
O
,
.
H
i
0
3
+
:
+
EXP  
T
UN  
I
NG  
H
1mm3,  
5
/
/
6
.
4
:
F
O
CA  
L
LENG  
T
85  
85  
S
:
LE  
N
S
/
1
4
5
:
-
A
F
VR  
/
VR  
O
n
:
-
FL  
SY  
,
A
N
S
C
HMTYPE  
Bu i l t i n,WCMD  
6
:
O
:
D
E
SL  
O
:
+
.
:
:
+
.
3
M
B
TTL,  
3
0
A
C
TTL,  
0
7
:
---  
---  
8
11  
12  
9
-
1
N
I
KO  
N
D750  
100  
10  
1 Metering .......................................139 7 Flash type ............................ 180, 433  
Shutter speed ..........................90, 93  
Aperture....................................91, 93  
Commander mode..................... 348  
8 Flash mode.......................... 181, 183  
2 Shooting mode ................................6  
ISO sensitivity 1 ............................134  
9 Flash control .............. 347, 435, 437  
Flash compensation................... 188  
3 Exposure compensation ...........143  
10 Camera name  
Optimal exposure tuning 2 .......336  
11 Image area ................................... 110  
4 Focal length.........................235, 432  
12 Folder number—frame  
5 Lens data.......................................235  
number ........................................ 311  
6 Focus mode.................. 57, 121, 132  
Lens VR (vibration reduction)3  
13  
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
H
I TE  
B
A
L
A
N
E
C
E
A
U
T
G
A
O
B
N
1
,
0
,
0
C
WO  
L
O
T
I
R
U
C
SPAC  
sR  
ST  
0
14  
P I  
C
RE  
K
C
TRL  
DA  
R
D
QU  
AD  
J
UST  
S
C
C
HARPE  
N
I
NG  
3
+
0
0
0
0
L
A
R I TY  
1
15  
ONTR  
A
T
ST  
ESS  
T I ON  
BR I  
G
U
H
R
N
S
A
U
T
E
A
H
-
100 1  
N
I
KON  
D750  
13 White balance..............................145 14 Color space................................... 314  
15 Picture Control 4 .......................... 165  
Color temperature................152  
White balance fine-tuning....149  
Preset manual........................155  
251  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
.
:
:
:
NO I SE RE  
D
U
G
C
H
H
I
I S  
A
O
L
,
NORM  
.
-
.
AC  
HD  
T
D
L I  
T
NO  
R
R
A
U
TMM  
O
,
H
L
I
GH  
:
V I GNETTE  
RETOUCH  
C
TRL NO  
R
A
:
-
A
D
LMI GHT I NG  
WYAMNOTYPE  
R
F I LTER  
C
TR I  
:
.
COME  
C
O
MM  
E
N
T
SPR I NG HA  
S
21  
-
100 1  
N
I
KON  
D750  
16 High ISO noise reduction.......... 317 19 Vignette control.......................... 315  
Long exposure noise  
reduction..................................... 317  
20 Retouch history........................... 393  
21 Image comment......................... 384  
17 Active D-Lighting ....................... 175  
18 HDR strength............................... 177  
:
:
A
C
RT I ST  
PYR I  
N
N
I KON  
I KON  
TARO  
22  
23  
O
GHT  
-
100 1  
N
I
KON  
D750  
22 Name of photographer5 ........... 385 23 Copyright holder 5 ...................... 385  
1
2
Displayed in red if photo was taken with auto ISO sensitivity control on.  
Displayed if Custom Setting b6 (Fine-tune optimal exposure, 0336) has been set  
to a value other than zero for any metering method.  
3
4
5
Displayed only if VR lens is attached.  
Items displayed vary with Picture Control selected.  
The fourth page of the shooting data is only displayed if copyright information was recorded  
with the photograph as described on page 385.  
252  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
❚❚ Location Data * (0239)  
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
L
L
A
T I T  
U
D
U
E
N
E
1
2
3
4
.
35  
º
º
35 971  
ONG I T  
D
E
)
.
139  
35  
43 696  
ALMT I TUD  
E
C
T I E (  
U
T
15  
/
m04  
/
2014  
:
:
10 02 28  
-
100 1  
N
I
KON  
D750  
1 Latitude  
3 Altitude  
4 Coordinated Universal Time (UTC)  
2 Longitude  
*
Data for movies are for start of recording.  
253  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
❚❚ Overview Data  
12 3 4 5  
NIKON D750  
1/  
12  
6
7
8
17 18 19 20 21  
22  
85mm  
.
i 0  
.
1
4000 F2  
8
H
3
29  
28  
+
.
1. 3  
1 0  
SLOW  
23  
.
H
i 0. 3  
SLOW  
85mm  
1
4000 F2  
8
0,  
0
+
.
1
1. 3  
0
0,  
0
27  
26 25 24  
_
.
100ND750  
D
S
C
0001 JP  
G
MAL  
601N6Ox4R016  
9
16  
:
:
15  
/
04 2014 10 02 28  
/
15 141312 1110  
1 Frame number/total number of  
images  
16 Current card slot ......................... 119  
17 Metering....................................... 139  
18 Shooting mode................................ 6  
19 Shutter speed.......................... 90, 93  
20 Aperture ................................... 91, 93  
21 ISO sensitivity* ............................ 134  
22 Focal length........................ 235, 432  
23 Active D-Lighting ....................... 175  
24 Picture Control ............................ 165  
25 Color space .................................. 314  
26 Flash mode ......................... 181, 183  
2 Upload marking.......................... 290  
3 Protect status............................... 257  
4 Retouch indicator....................... 393  
5 Camera name  
6 Image comment indicator ....... 384  
7 Location data indicator............. 239  
8 Histogram showing the  
distribution of tones in the image  
9 Image quality .............................. 115  
10 Image size..................................... 118  
11 Image area ................................... 110  
12 File name ...................................... 313  
13 Time of recording .................28, 381  
14 Folder name................................. 311  
15 Date of recording..................28, 381  
27 White balance ............................. 145  
Color temperature ............... 152  
White balance fine-tuning ... 149  
Preset manual....................... 155  
28 Flash compensation .................. 188  
Commander mode..................... 348  
29 Exposure compensation........... 143  
* Displayed in red if photo was taken with auto ISO sensitivity control on.  
254  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Taking a Closer Look: Playback Zoom  
Press the X (T) button to zoom in on  
the image displayed in full-frame  
playback. The following operations can  
be performed while zoom is in effect:  
X (T) button  
To  
Use  
Description  
Press X (T) to  
zoom 36 × 24  
(3 : 2) format  
images in to  
maximum of  
approximately  
38 × (large  
Zoom in or X (T)/  
out  
W (S)  
images), 28 × (medium images) or 19 ×  
(small images). Press W (S) to zoom out.  
While photo is zoomed in, use multi selector  
to view areas of image not visible in  
monitor. Keep multi selector pressed to  
scroll rapidly to other areas of frame.  
Navigation window is displayed when zoom  
ratio is altered; area currently visible in  
monitor is indicated by yellow border. Bar  
under navigation window shows zoom  
ratio; turns green at ratio of 1 : 1.  
View other  
areas of  
image  
255  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
To  
Use  
Description  
Faces detected  
during zoom are  
indicated by  
white borders in  
navigation  
Select faces  
window. Rotate  
sub-command  
dial to view other faces.  
Rotate main command dial to view same  
location in other photos at current zoom  
ratio. Playback zoom is cancelled when a  
movie is displayed.  
View other  
images  
Return to  
shooting  
mode  
Press the shutter-release button halfway or  
press the K button to exit to shooting  
mode.  
/
K
256  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Protecting Photographs from Deletion  
In full-frame, zoom, thumbnail, and calendar playback, press the  
L (U) button to protect the current picture from accidental  
deletion. Protected files are marked with a P icon and can not  
be deleted using the O (Q) button or the Delete option in the  
playback menu. Note that protected images will be deleted  
when the memory card is formatted (0375). To remove  
protection from a picture so that it can be deleted, display or  
highlight it and press the L (U) button.  
L (U) button  
ARemoving Protection from All Images  
To remove protection from all images in the folder or folders currently  
selected in the Playback folder menu, press the L (U) and O (Q)  
buttons together for about two seconds during playback.  
257  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Deleting Photographs  
To delete the photograph displayed in full-frame playback or  
highlighted in the thumbnail list, press the O (Q) button. To  
delete multiple selected photographs, all photographs taken on  
a selected date, or all photographs in the current playback  
folder, use the Delete option in the playback menu. Once  
deleted, photographs can not be recovered. Note that pictures  
that are protected or hidden can not be deleted.  
Full-Frame, Thumbnail, and Calendar Playback  
Press the O (Q) button to delete the current photograph.  
1
Press the O (Q) button.  
A confirmation dialog will be  
displayed.  
O (Q) button  
2
Press the O (Q) button again.  
To delete the photograph, press the  
O (Q) button. To exit without  
deleting the photograph, press the K  
button.  
O (Q) button  
258  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ACalendar Playback  
During calendar playback, you can delete all photographs taken on a  
selected date by highlighting the date in the date list and pressing the  
O (Q) button (0244).  
ASee Also  
The After delete option in the playback menu determines whether  
the next image or the previous image is displayed after an image is  
deleted (0307).  
259  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Playback Menu  
The Delete option in the playback menu contains the following  
options. Note that depending on the number of images, some  
time may be required for deletion.  
Option  
Description  
Delete selected pictures.  
Selected  
Q
Select date Delete all pictures taken on a selected date (0261).  
n
Delete all pictures in the  
folder currently selected  
for playback (0300). If  
All  
two cards are inserted, you  
can select the card from  
which pictures will be  
deleted.  
R
❚❚ Selected: Deleting Selected Photographs  
1
Select pictures.  
Use the multi selector to highlight a  
picture and press the W (S) button  
to select or deselect. Selected pictures  
are marked by a O icon. Repeat as  
desired to select additional pictures.  
W (S) button  
260  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
2
Delete the selected pictures.  
Press J. A confirmation dialog will be  
displayed; highlight Yes and press J.  
❚❚ Select Date: Deleting Photographs Taken on a Selected Date  
1
Select dates.  
Highlight a date and press 2to select  
all pictures taken on the highlighted  
date. Selected dates are marked with  
a M icon. Repeat as desired to select  
additional dates; to deselect a date,  
highlight it and press 2.  
2
Delete the selected pictures.  
Press J. A confirmation dialog will be  
displayed; highlight Yes and press J.  
261  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Connections  
Installing ViewNX 2  
Install the supplied software to display and edit photographs  
and movies that have been copied to your computer. Before  
installing ViewNX 2, confirm that your computer meets the  
system requirements on page 264. Be sure to use the latest  
version of ViewNX 2, which is available for download from the  
websites listed on page xxiii, as earlier versions that do not  
support the D750 may fail to transfer NEF (RAW) images  
correctly.  
1
Launch the installer.  
Start the computer, insert the installer CD, and launch the  
installer. A language selection dialog will be displayed. If the  
desired language is not available, click Region Selection to  
choose a different region (region selection is not available in  
the European release).  
q Select region (if required)  
w Select language  
e Click Next  
262  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
2
Start the installer.  
Click Install and follow the on-screen instructions.  
Click Install  
3
4
Exit the installer.  
Windows  
Mac  
Click Yes  
Click OK  
Remove the installer CD from the CD-ROM drive.  
AViewing the Nikon Website  
To visit the Nikon website after installing ViewNX 2, select All  
Programs > Link to Nikon from the Windows start menu (Internet  
connection required).  
263  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ASystem Requirements  
Windows  
Photos: Intel Celeron, Pentium 4, or Core series, 1.6 GHz  
or better  
Movies (playback): Pentium D 3.0 GHz or better; Intel Core  
i5 or better recommended when viewing movies with  
a frame size of 1280 × 720 or more at a frame rate of 30  
fps or above or movies with a frame size of 1920 × 1080  
or more  
Movies (editing): Intel Core i5 or better  
Pre-installed versions of Windows 8.1, Windows 7, and  
Windows Vista  
CPU  
OS *  
32-bit Windows 8.1, Windows 7, or Windows Vista: 1 GB or more  
(2 GB or more recommended)  
64-bit Windows 8.1, Windows 7, or Windows Vista: 2 GB or more  
(4 GB or more recommended)  
Memory  
(RAM)  
Hard disk A minimum of 1 GB available on the startup disk (3 GB or  
space  
more recommended)  
Resolution: 1024 × 768 pixels (XGA) or more (1280 × 1024  
pixels or more recommended)  
Graphics  
Color: 24-bit color (True Color) or more  
Built-in USB port required. Software may not function as  
expected if camera is connected via USB hub.  
Interface  
* See the websites listed on page xxiii for the latest information on supported operating  
systems.  
264  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Mac  
Photos: Intel Core or Xeon series  
Movies (playback): Core Duo 2 GHz or better; Intel Core i5  
or better recommended when viewing movies with a  
frame size of 1280 × 720 or more at a frame rate of  
30 fps or above or movies with a frame size of  
1920 × 1080 or more  
CPU  
Movies (editing): Intel Core i5 or better  
OS X 10.9, 10.8, or 10.7  
OS *  
Memory  
(RAM)  
2 GB or more (4 GB or more recommended)  
Hard disk A minimum of 1 GB available on the startup disk (3 GB or  
space  
more recommended)  
Resolution: 1024 × 768 pixels (XGA) or more (1280 × 1024  
pixels or more recommended)  
Graphics  
Color: 24-bit color (millions of colors) or more  
Built-in USB port required. Software may not function as  
expected if camera is connected via USB hub.  
Interface  
* See the websites listed on page xxiii for the latest information on supported operating  
systems.  
265  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using ViewNX 2  
Copy Pictures to the Computer  
Before proceeding, be sure you have installed the software on  
the supplied ViewNX 2 CD (0262).  
1
Connect the USB cable.  
After turning the camera off and ensuring that a memory  
card is inserted, connect the supplied USB cable as shown  
and then turn the camera on.  
AUse a Reliable Power Source  
To ensure that data transfer is not interrupted, be sure the camera  
battery is fully charged.  
AConnecting Cables  
Be sure the camera is off when connecting or disconnecting  
interface cables. Do not use force or attempt to insert the  
connectors at an angle.  
DDuring Transfer  
Do not turn the camera off or disconnect the USB cable while  
transfer is in progress.  
DUSB Hubs  
Connect the camera directly to the computer; do not connect the  
cable via a USB hub or keyboard.  
266  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
2
Start Nikon Transfer 2 component of ViewNX 2.  
If a message is displayed prompting you to choose a  
program, select Nikon Transfer 2.  
AWindows 7  
If the following dialog is displayed, select Nikon Transfer 2 as  
described below.  
1 Under Import pictures and videos,  
click Change program. A program  
selection dialog will be displayed;  
select Import File using  
Nikon Transfer 2 and click OK.  
2 Double-click Import File.  
AWindows 8.1  
Windows 8.1 may display an AutoPlay  
prompt when the camera is connected.  
Tap or click the dialog and then tap or  
click Import File/Nikon Transfer 2 to  
select Nikon Transfer 2.  
267  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3
4
Click Start Transfer.  
At default settings, pictures on the memory card will be  
copied to the computer.  
Start Transfer  
Terminate the connection.  
When transfer is complete, turn the camera off and  
disconnect the USB cable.  
AStarting ViewNX 2 Manually  
Windows: Double-click the ViewNX 2 shortcut on the desktop.  
Mac: Click the ViewNX 2 icon in the Dock.  
AFor More Information  
Consult online help for more information on using ViewNX 2.  
ACapture NX-D  
Use Nikon’s Capture NX-D software to retouch photos or to change  
settings for NEF (RAW) pictures and save them in other formats.  
Capture NX-D also offers an Image Dust Off feature that removes  
image artifacts caused by dust inside the camera. Capture NX-D is  
available for download from a link in the ViewNX 2 installer (0262).  
268  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Ethernet and Wireless Networks  
The optional UT-1 communication unit (0442) can be used to  
upload photographs to a computer or ftp server. The camera  
connects to the UT-1 using the USB cable supplied with the  
camera, while the UT-1 in turn connects to the network via an  
Ethernet cable or an optional WT-5 wireless transmitter (0442).  
The optional communication units and wireless transmitters  
support the following modes:  
Mode  
Function  
FTP upload  
Image transfer  
Upload existing photos and movies to a computer or  
ftp server, or upload new photos as they are taken.  
Control the camera using optional  
Camera control Camera Control Pro 2 software and save new photos  
and movies directly to the computer.  
View and take pictures remotely using a browser  
equipped computer or iPhone.  
HTTP server  
For information on using optional communication units or  
wireless transmitters, refer to the manuals provided with the  
device. Be sure to update to the latest versions of the device  
firmware and related software.  
269  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
D Image Upload  
Once a connection has been established to the UT-1, the P button  
functions during playback to select pictures for upload in ftp and  
image transfer modes (upload only takes place when the UT-1 is  
connected). Other playback operations that use the P button, such as  
Side-by-side comparison (0 419), can not be performed. To restore  
normal operation, delete the network profile as described in the UT-1  
manual.  
D During Transfer  
Movies can not be recorded or played back when the UT-1 is  
connected and there are either images remaining to be sent or images  
currently being transferred via an Ethernet or wireless network.  
A Movies  
Movies can be uploaded over Ethernet and wireless networks in  
transfer mode. Note, however, that movies can not be uploaded using  
the Auto send or Send folder features in the Options menu.  
D HTTP Server Mode  
The camera can not be used to record or view movies in HTTP server  
mode.  
A WT-5 Wireless Transmitters  
The principal differences between the WT-5 and WT-5A/B/C/D/E is in  
the number of channels supported; unless otherwise stated, all  
references to the the WT-5 also apply to the WT-5A/B/C/D/E.  
270  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Printing Photographs  
Selected JPEG images can be printed on a PictBridge printer  
(0488) connected directly to the camera.  
Connecting the Printer  
Connect the camera using the supplied USB cable. Do not use  
force or attempt to insert the connectors at an angle.  
When the camera and printer are turned on, a welcome screen  
will be displayed in the monitor, followed by a PictBridge  
playback display.  
DUSB Hubs  
Connect the camera directly to the printer; do not connect the cable  
via a USB hub.  
DSelecting Photographs for Printing  
NEF (RAW) photographs (0115) can not be selected for printing. JPEG  
copies of NEF (RAW) images can be created using the NEF (RAW)  
processing option in the retouch menu (0406).  
APrinting Via Direct USB Connection  
Be sure the battery is fully charged or use an optional AC adapter and  
power connector. When taking photographs to be printed via direct  
USB connection, set Color space to sRGB (0314).  
271  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Printing Pictures One at a Time  
1
Display the desired picture.  
Press 4or 2to view additional pictures. Press the X (T)  
button to zoom in on the current frame (press K to exit  
zoom). To view thumbnails, press the W (S) button. Use  
the multi selector to highlight pictures, or press W (S)  
again to display the highlighted picture full frame.  
2
Adjust printing options.  
Press J to display the following items, then press 1or 3to  
highlight an item and press 2to view options (only options  
supported by the current printer are listed; to use the default  
option, select Printer default). After selecting an option,  
press J to return to the printer settings menu.  
Option  
Description  
Page size Choose a page size.  
This option is listed only when pictures are printed one  
No. of copies at a time. Press 1or 3to choose number of copies  
(maximum 99).  
Border  
Choose whether to frame photos in white borders.  
Choose whether to print the times and dates of  
recordings on photos.  
Time stamp  
This option is listed only when pictures are printed one  
at a time. To exit without cropping, highlight No  
cropping and press J. To crop the current picture,  
highlight Crop and press 2. A crop selection dialog  
will be displayed; press X (T) to increase the size of  
the crop, W (S) to decrease, and use the multi  
selector to position the crop. Note that print quality  
may drop if small crops are printed at large sizes.  
Cropping  
272  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
3
Start printing.  
Select Start printing and press J to start printing. To cancel  
before all copies have been printed, press J.  
ASee Also  
See page 476 for information on what to do if an error occurs during  
printing.  
273  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Printing Multiple Pictures  
1
2
Display the PictBridge menu.  
Press the G button in the PictBridge playback display.  
Choose an option.  
Highlight one of the following options and press 2.  
Print select: Select pictures for printing. Use the multi  
selector to highlight pictures (to display the current picture  
full screen, press and hold the X/T button) and, keeping  
the W (S) button pressed, press 1or 3to choose the  
number of prints (maximum 99). To deselect a picture, set  
the number of prints to zero.  
Select date: Print one copy of all the pictures taken on  
selected dates. Press 1or 3to highlight dates and press 2  
to select or deselect. To view the pictures taken on the  
selected date, press W (S). Use the multi selector to scroll  
through the pictures, or press and hold X (T) to view the  
current picture full screen. Press W (S) again to return to  
the date selection dialog.  
Print (DPOF): Print the current DPOF print order (0275). The  
order can be viewed and modified before printing as  
described in the description for Print select, above.  
Index print: To create an index print of all JPEG pictures on the  
memory card, proceed to Step 3. Note that if the memory  
card contains more than 256 pictures, only the first 256  
images will be printed. A warning will be displayed if the  
page size selected in Step 3 is too small for an index print.  
274  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
3
4
Adjust printing options.  
Adjust printer settings as described in Step 2 on page 272.  
Start printing.  
Select Start printing and press J to start printing. To cancel  
before all copies have been printed, press J.  
Creating a DPOF Print Order: Print Set  
The DPOF print order option in the playback menu is used to  
create digital “print orders” for PictBridge-compatible printers  
and devices that support DPOF (0488).  
1
Choose DPOF print order > Select/  
set.  
Select DPOF print order in the  
playback menu, then highlight  
Select/set and press 2(to remove all  
photographs from the print order,  
select Deselect all).  
2
Select pictures.  
Use the multi selector to scroll  
through the pictures on (to display  
the current picture full screen, press  
and hold the X/T button) and  
keeping the W (S) button pressed,  
press 1or 3to choose the number of  
prints (maximum 99). To deselect a picture, set the number of  
prints to zero. Press J when all the desired pictures have  
been selected.  
275  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
3
4
Select imprint options.  
Highlight the following options and  
press 2to toggle the highlighted  
option on or off.  
Print shooting data: Print shutter speed  
and aperture on all pictures in print  
order.  
Print date: Print date of recording on all pictures in print  
order.  
Complete the print order.  
Press J to complete the print order.  
DDPOF Print Order  
To print the current print order when the camera is connected to a  
PictBridge printer, select Print (DPOF) in the PictBridge menu and  
follow the steps in “Printing Multiple Pictures” to modify and print the  
current order (0274). DPOF print date and shooting data options are  
not supported when printing via direct USB connection; to print the  
date of recording on photographs in the current print order, use the  
PictBridge Time stamp option.  
The DPOF print order option can not be used if there is not enough  
space on the memory card to store the print order.  
NEF (RAW) photographs (0115) can not be selected using this option.  
JPEG copies of NEF (RAW) images can be created using the NEF (RAW)  
processing option in the retouch menu (0406).  
Print orders may not print correctly if images are deleted using a  
computer or other device after the print order is created.  
276  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Viewing Photographs on TV  
The optional High-Definition Multimedia Interface (HDMI) cable  
(0442) or a type C HDMI cable (available separately from third-  
party suppliers) can be used to connect the camera to high-  
definition video devices. Always turn the camera off before  
connecting or disconnecting an HDMI cable.  
Connect to high-definition  
device (choose cable with  
connector for HDMI device)  
Connect to camera  
Tune the device to the HDMI channel, then turn the camera on  
and press the K button. During playback, images will be  
displayed on the television screen. Volume can be adjusted  
using television controls; the camera controls can not be used.  
ATelevision Playback  
Use of an AC adapter and power connector (available separately) is  
recommended for extended playback. If the edges of photographs are  
not visible in the television display, select 95% for HDMI > Advanced  
> Output display size (0279).  
277  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
HDMI Options  
The HDMI option in the setup menu (0374) controls output  
resolution and other advanced HDMI options, and can also be  
used to enable the camera for remote control from devices that  
support HDMI-CEC (High-Definition Multimedia Interface–  
Consumer Electronics Control, a standard that allows HDMI  
devices to be used to control peripherals to which they are  
connected).  
❚❚ Output Resolution  
Choose the format for images output to  
the HDMI device. If Auto is selected, the  
camera will automatically select the  
appropriate format.  
❚❚ Device Control  
If On is selected for HDMI >Device control when the camera is  
connected to a television that supports HDMI-CEC and both the  
camera and television are on, the television remote can be used  
in place of the camera multi selector and J button during full-  
frame playback and slide shows. If Off is selected, the television  
remote can not be used to control the camera.  
278  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
❚❚ Advanced  
Option  
Description  
Auto is recommended in most situations. If the camera  
is unable to determine the correct RGB video signal  
output range for the HDMI device, you can choose from  
the following options:  
Limited range: For devices with an RGB video signal  
input range of 16 to 235. Choose this option if you  
notice loss of detail in shadows.  
Output range  
Full range: For devices with an RGB video signal input  
range of 0 to 255. Choose this option if shadows are  
“washed out” or too bright.  
Output display Choose horizontal and vertical frame coverage for  
size  
HDMI output from 95% or 100%.  
If Off is selected when the camera is connected to an  
HDMI device, shooting information will not be  
displayed in the monitor during live view photography.  
Choose On to mirror the HDMI display on the camera  
monitor, Off to turn the camera monitor off to save  
power. Dual monitor turns on automatically when  
Live view on-screen display is Off.  
Live view on-  
screen display  
Dual monitor  
279  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
AHDMI and Live View  
When the camera is connected via an HDMI cable, HDMI displays can  
be used for live view photography and movie live view (065, 78).  
Note that if 1920 × 1080; 60p is selected for the Frame size/frame  
rate in the movie shooting menu (0319), the selected setting will  
only be reflected in the HDMI output during movie recording if all the  
following conditions are met: Auto or 1080p (progressive) is selected  
for HDMI > Output resolution, 100% is selected for HDMI >  
Advanced > Output display size, and Off is selected for HDMI >  
Advanced > Live view on-screen display (0279). At other settings,  
the output resolution, display size, or frame rate may differ from that  
selected in the camera menus.  
AHDMI-CEC Devices  
When the camera is connected to an HDMI-CEC device, ) will  
appear in the control panel in place of the number of exposures  
remaining.  
ADevice Control  
See the television manual for details.  
280  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Wi-Fi  
What Wi-Fi Can Do for You  
The camera can connect via Wi-Fi wireless networks to a smart  
device running Nikon’s dedicated Wireless Mobile Utility app.  
The smart device can be used to control the camera and take  
pictures remotely, or pictures can be downloaded from the  
camera to the smart device and shared with others on the  
Internet. Pictures can also be uploaded from the camera to the  
smart device (0289).  
Download pictures  
Share pictures  
Remote control  
See the Wireless Mobile Utility manual for details (0283).  
AWi-Fi  
Wi-Fi is available with the D750 only. The D750 (K) does not support  
Wi-Fi.  
281  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Accessing the Camera  
Before connecting via Wi-Fi (wireless LAN), install the Wireless  
Mobile Utility on your Android or iOS smart device. Instructions  
for accessing the camera vary with the type of connection used  
by the smart device.  
Android  
Push-button WPS: If the smart device supports push-button WPS  
(i.e., has a WPS button connection option in its Wi-Fi settings  
menu), you can use this easy method to connect to the smart  
device (0284)  
PIN-entry WPS: If the smart device supports WPS, you can use the  
camera to establish a connection by entering the PIN displayed  
by the smart device (0285)  
View SSID: If the smart device does not support WPS, you can  
connect by selecting the camera SSID on the smart device  
(0286)  
iOS  
View SSID: Connect by selecting the camera SSID on the smart  
device (0286)  
AWPS  
WPS (Wi-Fi Protected Setup) is a standard designed to make it easy to  
establish a secure wireless network. For information on the steps  
involved and the length of time the smart device will wait for a  
connection, see the documentation supplied with the smart device.  
282  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
AInstalling the Wireless Mobile Utility App  
1 Find the app.  
On the smart device, connect to the Google Play service, the App  
Store, or another app marketplace and search for “Wireless Mobile  
Utility”. For more information, see the instructions provided with  
the smart device.  
2 Install the app.  
Read the app description and install the app. A pdf manual for the  
Wireless Mobile Utility is available for download at the following  
URLs:  
Android: http://nikonimglib.com/ManDL/WMAU/  
iOS: http://nikonimglib.com/ManDL/WMAU-ios/  
283  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
WPS (Android Only)  
1
Enable the camera’s built-in Wi-Fi.  
Highlight Wi-Fi in the setup menu and  
press 2. Highlight Network  
connection and press 2, then  
highlight Enable and press J. Wait a  
few seconds for Wi-Fi to activate.  
2
Connect.  
Enable WPS button connections on the camera and smart  
device:  
Camera: Highlight Network settings  
and press 2.  
Highlight Push-button WPS and  
press 2to ready the camera for a  
WPS connection. The camera will  
wait about two minutes for a WPS  
connection request from the smart  
device. To extend the wait time,  
press J.  
Smart device: Select Wi-Fi settings > WPS button  
connection.  
284  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
3
Launch the Wireless Mobile Utility.  
Launch the Wireless Mobile Utility on the smart device. The  
main dialog will be displayed.  
PIN Entry (Android Only)  
1
Enable the camera’s built-in Wi-Fi.  
Highlight Wi-Fi in the setup menu and  
press 2. Highlight Network  
connection and press 2, then  
highlight Enable and press J. Wait a  
few seconds for Wi-Fi to activate.  
2
Select Network settings > PIN-entry WPS.  
Highlight Network settings and  
press 2.  
Highlight PIN-entry WPS and press  
2.  
285  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
3
4
Enter the PIN.  
Enter the PIN displayed by the smart device. Press 4or 2to  
highlight digits and press 1or 3to change. Press J when  
entry is complete.  
Launch the Wireless Mobile Utility.  
Launch the Wireless Mobile Utility on the smart device. The  
main dialog will be displayed.  
SSID (Android and iOS)  
1
Enable the camera’s built-in Wi-Fi.  
Highlight Wi-Fi in the setup menu and  
press 2. Highlight Network  
connection and press 2, then  
highlight Enable and press J. Wait a  
few seconds for Wi-Fi to activate.  
286  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
2
Display the camera SSID.  
Highlight Network settings and  
press 2.  
Highlight View SSID and press 2.  
3
4
Select the camera SSID.  
Select the camera SSID in the list of networks displayed by  
the smart device.  
Launch the Wireless Mobile Utility.  
Launch the Wireless Mobile Utility on the smart device. The  
main dialog will be displayed.  
287  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
❚❚ Terminating the Connection  
Wi-Fi can be disabled by:  
Selecting Wi-Fi > Network connection > Disable in the  
camera setup menu  
Starting movie recording  
Connecting an optional UT-1 communication unit  
Turning the camera off  
❚❚ Restoring Default Settings  
To restore default network settings, select Wi-Fi > Network  
settings > Reset network settings. A confirmation dialog will  
be displayed; highlight Yes and press J to restore default  
network settings.  
AThe Wi-Fi Display  
While Wi-Fi is enabled, a g icon will flash in  
the control panel. The icon will stop  
flashing once a connection has been  
established and the camera is exchanging  
data with the smart device.  
DWi-Fi  
Read the warnings on pages xxiv to xxvi before using the Wi-Fi  
function. To disable Wi-Fi in settings in which its use is prohibited,  
select Wi-Fi > Network connection > Disable in the camera setup  
menu. Note that Eye-Fi cards can not be used while Wi-Fi is enabled  
and that the standby timer will not turn off while the Wireless Mobile  
Utility app on the smart device is communicating with the camera. If  
no data are exchanged for about 5 minutes, the standby timer will turn  
off. The camera Wi-Fi function is only available when a memory card is  
inserted and can not be used when a USB or HDMI cable is connected.  
To prevent loss of power while connected, charge the battery before  
enabling the network connection.  
288  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Selecting Pictures for Upload  
Follow the steps below to select photos for upload to the smart  
device. Movies can not be selected for upload.  
Selecting Individual Pictures for Upload  
1
Select an image.  
Display the image or highlight it in the thumbnail list in  
thumbnail or calendar playback.  
2
Display playback options.  
Press the P button.  
P button  
289  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
3
Choose Select to send to smart  
device/deselect.  
Highlight Select to send to smart  
device/deselect and press J.  
Pictures selected for upload are  
indicated by a & icon; to deselect,  
display or highlight the image and  
repeat Steps 2 and 3.  
290  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Selecting Multiple Pictures for Upload  
To change the upload status of multiple pictures, use the Wi-Fi >  
Select to send to smart device option in the setup menu.  
1
2
Choose Select to send to smart  
device.  
Select Wi-Fi in the setup menu, then  
highlight Select to send to smart  
device and press 2.  
Select pictures.  
Use the multi selector to highlight  
pictures and press W (S) to select  
or deselect (to view the highlighted  
picture full screen, press and hold the  
X/T button). Selected pictures  
are marked by a & icon.  
W (S) button  
3
Press J.  
Press J to complete the operation.  
291  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Menu Guide  
Defaults  
The default settings for the options in the camera menus are  
listed below. For information on two-button resets, see page  
❚❚ Playback Menu Defaults  
Option  
Playback folder (0300)  
Default  
ND750  
Off  
Show next  
On  
Image review (0307)  
After delete (0307)  
Rotate tall (0308)  
Slide show (0308)  
Image type (0308)  
Frame interval (0308)  
Still images and movies  
2 s  
❚❚ Photo Shooting Menu Defaults 1  
Option  
File naming (0313)  
Default  
DSC  
Role played by card in Slot 2 (0119)  
Image quality (0115)  
Image size (0118)  
Overflow  
JPEG normal  
Large  
Image area (0110)  
Choose image area (0111)  
Auto DX crop (0111)  
FX (36×24)  
On  
JPEG compression (0117)  
NEF (RAW) recording (0117)  
Type (0117)  
Size priority  
Lossless compressed  
14-bit  
NEF (RAW) bit depth (0117)  
292  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Option  
White balance (0145)  
Default  
Auto > Normal  
A-B: 0, G-M: 0  
5000 K  
d-1  
Standard  
sRGB  
Fine-tuning (0149)  
Choose color temp. (0152)  
Preset manual (0155)  
Set Picture Control (0165)  
Color space (0314)  
Active D-Lighting (0175)  
P, S, A, M, %, g, i, u, 1, 2, 3  
Other modes  
Off  
Auto  
HDR (high dynamic range) (0177)  
HDR mode (0178)  
HDR strength (0178)  
Vignette control (0315)  
Auto distortion control (0316)  
Long exposure NR (0317)  
High ISO NR (0317)  
Off  
Auto  
Normal  
Off  
Off  
Normal  
ISO sensitivity settings (0134)  
ISO sensitivity (0134)  
P, S, A, M  
Other modes  
100  
Auto  
Off  
Auto ISO sensitivity control (0136)  
Remote control mode (ML-L3) (0193)  
Multiple exposure 2 (0216)  
Multiple exposure mode (0217)  
Number of shots (0218)  
Auto gain (0218)  
Off  
Off  
2
On  
293  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Option  
Interval timer shooting (0222)  
Start options (0223)  
Interval (0223)  
No. of intervals×shots/interval (0224)  
Exposure smoothing (0224)  
Default  
Now  
1 min.  
0001×1  
Off  
1
2
Default settings restored with Reset photo shooting menu (0311).  
Reset photo shooting menu can not be selected while shooting is in progress.  
❚❚ Movie Shooting Menu Defaults *  
Option  
File naming (0313)  
Default  
DSC  
Destination (0319)  
Slot 1  
Frame size/frame rate (0319)  
Movie quality (0320)  
1920×1080; 60p  
Normal  
Microphone sensitivity (0320)  
Frequency response (0320)  
Wind noise reduction (0321)  
Image area (076)  
Auto sensitivity  
Wide range  
Off  
Choose image area (0111)  
Auto DX crop (0111)  
FX (36×24)  
On  
White balance (0321)  
Fine-tuning (0149)  
Choose color temp. (0152)  
Preset manual (0155)  
Same as photo settings  
A-B: 0, G-M: 0  
5000 K  
d-1  
Set Picture Control (0321)  
High ISO NR (0317)  
Same as photo settings  
Normal  
Movie ISO sensitivity settings (0322)  
ISO sensitivity (mode M) (0322)  
Auto ISO control (mode M) (0322)  
Maximum sensitivity (0322)  
100  
Off  
12800  
294  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Option  
Time-lapse photography (0229)  
Interval (0230)  
Shooting time (0230)  
Exposure smoothing (0231)  
Default  
5 s  
25 minutes  
On  
* Default settings restored with Reset movie shooting menu (0318).  
❚❚ Custom Settings Menu Defaults *  
Option  
Default  
Release  
Focus  
a1 AF-C priority selection (0326)  
a2 AF-S priority selection (0327)  
a3 Focus tracking with lock-on (0328)  
a4 Focus point illumination (0329)  
Manual focus mode  
3 (Normal)  
On  
Off  
Dynamic-area AF display  
Group-area AF illumination  
g (Squares)  
Auto  
No wrap  
51 points  
No  
a5 AF point illumination (0329)  
a6 Focus point wrap-around (0330)  
a7 Number of focus points (0330)  
a8 Store points by orientation (0331)  
a9 Built-in AF-assist illuminator (0332)  
b1 ISO sensitivity step value (0333)  
b2 EV steps for exposure cntrl (0333)  
b3 Easy exposure compensation (0334)  
b4 Matrix metering (0335)  
b5 Center-weighted area (0335)  
b6 Fine-tune optimal exposure (0336)  
Matrix metering  
On  
1/3 step  
1/3 step  
Off  
Face detection on  
ø 12 mm  
0
0
0
0
Center-weighted metering  
Spot metering  
Highlight-weighted metering  
295  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Option  
c1 Shutter-release button AE-L (0336)  
c2 Standby timer (0336)  
c3 Self-timer (0337)  
Self-timer delay  
Default  
Off  
6 s  
10 s  
1
Number of shots  
Interval between shots  
c4 Monitor off delay (0337)  
Playback  
0.5 s  
10 s  
1 min  
10 s  
Menus  
Information display  
Image review  
4 s  
Live view  
10 min  
1 min  
c5 Remote on duration (ML-L3) (0337)  
d1 Beep (0338)  
Volume  
Off  
Pitch  
Low  
d2 Continuous low-speed (0338)  
d3 Max. continuous release (0339)  
d4 Exposure delay mode (0339)  
d5 Flash warning (0339)  
d6 File number sequence (0340)  
d7 Viewfinder grid display (0341)  
d8 Easy ISO (0341)  
d9 Information display (0341)  
d10 LCD illumination (0342)  
d11 MB-D16 battery type (0343)  
d12 Battery order (0344)  
3 fps  
100  
Off  
On  
On  
Off  
Off  
Auto  
Off  
LR6 (AA alkaline)  
Use MB-D16 batteries first  
296  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Option  
e1 Flash sync speed (0345)  
e2 Flash shutter speed (0346)  
e3 Flash cntrl for built-in flash/Optional flash  
(0347)  
Default  
1/200 s  
1/60 s  
TTL  
e4 Exposure comp. for flash (0353)  
e5 Modeling flash (0353)  
e6 Auto bracketing set (0353)  
e7 Bracketing order (0354)  
f1 OK button (0354)  
Entire frame  
On  
AE & flash  
MTR > under > over  
Shooting mode (0354)  
Playback mode (0355)  
Select center focus point  
Thumbnail on/off  
Live view (0355)  
Select center focus point  
f2 Assign Fn button (0356)  
Press (0356)  
None  
Press + command dials (0360)  
f3 Assign preview button (0361)  
Press (0361)  
Press + command dials (0361)  
f4 Assign AE-L/AF-L button (0361)  
Press (0361)  
Press + command dials (0362)  
f5 Customize command dials (0363)  
Reverse rotation (0363)  
Choose image area  
Preview  
None  
AE/AF lock  
None  
Exposure compensation: U  
Shutter speed/aperture: U  
Exposure setting: Off  
Autofocus setting: Off  
Sub-command dial  
Off  
Change main/sub (0363)  
Aperture setting (0364)  
Menus and playback (0364)  
Sub-dial frame advance (0364)  
10 frames  
297  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Option  
f6 Release button to use dial (0365)  
f7 Slot empty release lock (0365)  
f8 Reverse indicators (0366)  
f9 Assign movie record button (0366)  
Press + command dials  
f10 Assign MB-D16 4 button (0367)  
f11 Assign remote (WR) Fn button (0368)  
g1 Assign Fn button (0370)  
Press  
Default  
No  
Enable release  
None  
AE/AF lock  
None  
None  
g2 Assign preview button (0372)  
Press  
Index marking  
g3 Assign AE-L/AF-L button (0373)  
Press  
AE/AF lock  
g4 Assign shutter button (0373)  
Take photos  
* Default settings restored with Reset custom settings (0326).  
298  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
❚❚ Setup Menu Defaults  
Option  
Save user settings (099)  
Save to U1  
Default  
Shooting mode defaults to P  
Save to U2  
Monitor brightness (0376)  
Monitor color balance (0377)  
Clean image sensor (0448)  
Clean at startup/shutdown (0449)  
Flicker reduction (0380)  
Time zone and date (0381)  
Daylight saving time  
Auto image rotation (0382)  
HDMI (0278)  
0
A-B: 0, G-M: 0  
Clean at startup & shutdown  
Auto  
Off  
On  
Output resolution (0278)  
Device control (0278)  
Advanced (0279)  
Auto  
On  
Output range  
Output display size  
Live view on-screen display  
Dual monitor  
Auto  
100%  
On  
On  
Location data (0239)  
Standby timer  
Set clock from satellite  
Wi-Fi (0282)  
Enable  
Yes  
Network connection  
Eye-Fi upload (0391)  
Disable  
Enable  
299  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
D The Playback Menu: Managing Images  
To display the playback menu, press G and select the D  
(playback menu) tab.  
G button  
Playback Menu Options  
The playback menu contains the following options:  
Option  
0
Option  
0
Delete  
Playback folder  
Hide image  
Playback display options  
Copy image (s)  
260 Image review  
300 After delete  
301 Rotate tall  
302 Slide show  
303 DPOF print order  
ASee Also  
Menu defaults are listed on page 292.  
Playback Folder  
G button D playback menu  
Choose a folder for playback (0241):  
Option  
ND750  
Description  
Pictures in all folders created with the D750 will be  
visible during playback.  
All  
Pictures in all folders will be visible during playback.  
Only pictures in the current folder will be visible during  
playback.  
Current  
300  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Hide Image  
G button D playback menu  
Hide or reveal pictures. Hidden pictures are visible only in the  
Hide image menu and can only be deleted by formatting the  
memory card.  
Option  
Select/set  
Description  
Hide or reveal selected pictures.  
Selecting this option displays  
a list of dates. To hide all  
pictures taken on a date,  
highlight the date and press  
2. Selected dates are marked  
by a L; to reveal all pictures  
taken on a selected date,  
Select date  
highlight it and press 2. Press J to complete the  
operation.  
Deselect all  
Reveal all pictures.  
DProtected and Hidden Images  
Revealing a protected image will also remove protection from the  
image.  
Follow the steps below to hide or reveal selected pictures.  
1
Choose Select/set.  
Highlight Select/set and press 2.  
301  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
2
3
Select pictures.  
Use the multi selector to scroll  
through the pictures on the memory  
card (to view the highlighted picture  
full screen, press and hold the X/T  
button) and press W (S) to select  
the current picture. Selected pictures  
are marked by a R icon; to deselect a  
picture, highlight it and press W (S)  
again. Continue until all the desired  
pictures have been selected.  
W (S) button  
Press J.  
Press J to complete the operation.  
Playback Display Options  
G button D playback menu  
Choose the information available in the playback photo  
information display (0246). Press 1or 3to highlight an  
option, then press 2to select the option for the photo  
information display. A L appears next to selected items; to  
deselect, highlight an item and press 2. To return to the  
playback menu, press J.  
302  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Copy Image(s)  
G button D playback menu  
Copy pictures from one memory card to another. This option is  
only available when two memory cards are inserted in the  
camera.  
Option  
Select source  
Description  
Choose card from which pictures will be  
copied.  
Select image(s)  
Select destination folder  
Select pictures to be copied.  
Select destination folder on remaining card.  
Copy selected pictures to specified  
destination.  
Copy image(s)?  
1
2
3
Choose Select source.  
Highlight Select source and press 2.  
Select the source card.  
Highlight the slot for the card  
containing the images to be copied  
and press J.  
Choose Select image(s).  
Highlight Select image(s) and press  
2.  
303  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4
5
Select the source folder.  
Highlight the folder containing the  
images to be copied and press 2.  
Make the initial selection.  
Before going on to select or deselect  
individual images, you can mark all or  
all protected images in the folder for  
copying by choosing Select all  
images or Select protected images.  
To mark only individually selected  
images for copying, choose Deselect all before proceeding.  
6
Select additional images.  
Highlight pictures and press W (S)  
to select or deselect (to view the  
highlighted picture full screen, press  
and hold the X/T button).  
Selected images are marked with a L.  
Press J to proceed to Step 7 when  
W (S) button  
your selection is complete.  
304  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7
8
Choose Select destination folder.  
Highlight Select destination folder  
and press 2.  
Select a destination folder.  
To enter a folder number, choose  
Select folder by number, enter the  
number (0311), and press J. If the  
folder with the selected number does  
not already exist, a new folder will be  
created.  
To choose from a list of existing  
folders, choose Select folder from  
list, highlight a folder, and press J.  
305  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9
Copy the images.  
Highlight Copy image(s)? and press  
J.  
A confirmation dialog will be  
displayed; highlight Yes and press J.  
Press J again to exit when copying is  
complete.  
DCopying Images  
Images will not be copied if there is insufficient space on the  
destination card. Be sure the battery is fully charged before copying  
movies.  
If the destination folder contains an image  
with the same name as one of the images to  
be copied, a confirmation dialog will be  
displayed. Select Replace existing image  
to replace the image with the image to be  
copied, or select Replace all to replace all  
existing images with the same names  
without further prompting. To continue without replacing the image,  
select Skip, or select Cancel to exit without copying any further  
images. Hidden or protected files in the destination folder will not be  
replaced.  
Protect status is copied with the images but print marking (0275) is  
not. Hidden images can not be copied.  
306  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Image Review  
G button D playback menu  
Choose whether pictures are automatically displayed in the  
monitor immediately after shooting. If Off is selected, pictures  
can only be displayed by pressing the K button.  
After Delete  
G button D playback menu  
Choose the picture displayed after an image is deleted.  
Option  
Description  
Display following picture. If deleted picture  
was last frame, previous picture will be  
displayed.  
Display previous picture. If deleted picture  
was first frame, following picture will be  
displayed.  
Show next  
S
T
Show previous  
If user was scrolling through pictures in order  
recorded, following picture will be displayed  
as described for Show next. If user was  
scrolling through pictures in reverse order,  
previous picture will be displayed as  
described for Show previous.  
Continue as before  
U
307  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Rotate Tall  
G button D playback menu  
Choose whether to rotate “tall” (portrait-orientation) pictures for  
display during playback. Note that because the camera itself is  
already in the appropriate orientation during shooting, images  
are not rotated automatically during image review.  
Option  
Description  
Tall” (portrait-orientation) pictures are automatically  
rotated for display in the camera monitor. Pictures taken  
with Off selected for Auto image rotation (0382) will be  
displayed in “wide” (landscape) orientation.  
Tall” (portrait-orientation) pictures are displayed in “wide”  
(landscape) orientation.  
On  
Off  
Slide Show  
G button D playback menu  
Create a slide show of the pictures in the current playback folder  
(0300). Hidden images (0301) are not displayed.  
Option  
Start  
Description  
Start slide show.  
Choose type of image displayed from Still images  
and movies, Still images only, and Movies only.  
Choose how long each picture will be displayed.  
Image type  
Frame interval  
308  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
To start the slide show, highlight Start  
and press J. The following operations  
can be performed while the slide show is  
in progress:  
To  
Press  
Description  
Skip back/skip  
ahead  
Press 4to return to previous frame, 2  
to skip to next frame.  
View additional  
photo info  
Change or hide photo info displayed  
(still images only; 0246).  
Pause slide show. Select Restart to  
resume.  
Pause  
J
Press (T) during movie playback  
to increase volume, W (S) to  
decrease.  
X
( T)/  
W (S)  
Raise/lower  
volume  
X
Exit to playback  
menu  
End slide show and return to playback  
menu.  
G
Exit to playback  
mode  
End show and exit to playback mode.  
K
Exit to shooting  
mode  
Press shutter-release button halfway  
to return to shooting mode.  
The dialog shown at right is displayed  
when the show ends. Select Restart to  
restart or Exit to return to the playback  
menu.  
309  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
C The Photo Shooting Menu:  
Photo Shooting Options  
To display the photo shooting menu, press G and select the  
C (photo shooting menu) tab.  
G button  
Photo Shooting Menu Options  
The photo shooting menu contains the following options:  
Option  
Reset photo shooting menu*  
Storage folder*  
File naming  
Role played by card in Slot 2  
Image quality  
0
Option  
0
311 Color space  
311 Active D-Lighting  
313 HDR (high dynamic range)  
119 Vignette control  
115 Auto distortion control  
118 Long exposure NR  
110 High ISO NR  
117 ISO sensitivity settings  
117 Remote control mode (ML-L3) *  
145 Multiple exposure *  
165 Interval timer shooting *  
Image size  
Image area*  
JPEG compression  
NEF (RAW) recording  
White balance  
Set Picture Control  
Manage Picture Control*  
* Not included in the settings saved to U1 or U2 (099).  
Note: Depending on camera settings, some items may be grayed out and  
unavailable.  
310  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Reset Photo Shooting Menu  
G button C photo shooting menu  
Select Yes to restore photo shooting menu options to their  
default values (0292).  
Storage Folder  
G button C photo shooting menu  
Select the folder in which subsequent images will be stored.  
❚❚ Selecting Folders by Folder Number  
1
2
Choose Select folder by number.  
Highlight Select folder by number  
and press 2. The dialog shown at  
right will be displayed.  
Choose a folder number.  
Press 4or 2to highlight a digit, press 1or 3to change. If a  
folder with the selected number already exists, a W, X, or Y  
icon will be displayed to the left of the folder number:  
W : Folder is empty.  
X : Folder is partially full.  
Y : Folder contains 999 pictures or a picture numbered  
9999. No further pictures can be stored in this folder.  
The card on which the folder is stored is shown by the card  
slot icon in the top right corner of the “select folder by  
number” dialog. The card used for new folders depends on  
the option currently selected for Role played by card in slot  
2 (0119).  
311  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
3
Save changes and exit.  
Press J to complete the operation and return to the main  
menu (to exit without choosing the storage folder, press the  
G button). If a folder with the specified number does not  
already exist, a new folder will be created. Subsequent  
photographs will be stored in the selected folder unless it is  
already full.  
❚❚ Selecting Folders from a List  
1
Choose Select folder from list.  
Highlight Select folder from list and  
press 2.  
2
3
Highlight a folder.  
Press 1or 3to highlight a folder.  
Select the highlighted folder.  
Press J to select the highlighted folder and return to the  
main menu. Subsequent photographs will be stored in the  
selected folder.  
312  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DFolder and File Numbers  
If the current folder is numbered 999 and contains 999 pictures or a  
picture numbered 9999, the shutter-release will be disabled and no  
further photographs can be taken. To continue shooting, create a  
folder with a number less than 999, or select an existing folder with a  
number less than 999 and less than 999 images.  
AStartup Time  
Additional time may be required for camera startup if the memory card  
contains a very large number of files or folders.  
File Naming  
G button C photo shooting menu/1 movie shooting menu  
Photographs are saved using file names consisting of “DSC_” or,  
in the case of images that use the Adobe RGB color space,  
“_DSC, followed by a four-digit number and a three-letter  
extension (e.g., “DSC_0001.JPG”). The File naming option is  
used to select three letters to replace the “DSC” portion of the  
file name. For information on editing file names, see page 171.  
AExtensions  
The following extensions are used: .NEF” for NEF (RAW) images, .JPG”  
for JPEG images, .MOV” for movies, and .NDF” for dust off reference  
data. In each pair of photographs recorded at image-quality settings of  
NEF (RAW)+JPEG, the NEF and JPEG images have the same file names  
but different extensions.  
313  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Color Space  
G button C photo shooting menu  
The color space determines the gamut of colors available for  
color reproduction. sRGB is recommended for general-purpose  
printing and display; Adobe RGB, with its broader gamut of  
colors, for professional publication and commercial printing.  
AAdobe RGB  
For accurate color reproduction, Adobe RGB images require  
applications, displays, and printers that support color management.  
AColor Space  
ViewNX 2 (supplied) and Nikon’s Capture NX-D software (0268)  
automatically select the correct color space when opening  
photographs created with this camera. Results can not be guaranteed  
with third-party software.  
314  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Vignette Control  
G button C photo shooting menu  
“Vignetting” is a drop in brightness at the edges of a  
photograph. Vignette control reduces vignetting for type G, E,  
and D lenses (PC lenses excluded). Its effects vary from lens to  
lens and are most noticeable at maximum aperture. Choose  
from High, Normal, Low, and Off.  
AVignette Control  
Depending on the scene, shooting conditions, and type of lens, JPEG  
images may exhibit noise (fog) or variations in peripheral brightness,  
while custom Picture Controls and preset Picture Controls that have  
been modified from default settings may not produce the desired  
effect. Take test shots and view the results in the monitor. Vignette  
control does not apply to movies (066), multiple exposures (0216),  
or pictures taken with an FX lens and DX (24 × 16) selected for Image  
area > Choose image area (0111) or with a DX lens, an option other  
than DX (24 × 16) selected for Choose image area, and Off selected  
for Image area > Auto DX crop (0111).  
315  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Auto Distortion Control  
G button C photo shooting menu  
Select On to reduce barrel distortion when shooting with wide-  
angle lenses and to reduce pin-cushion distortion when  
shooting with long lenses (note that the edges of the area visible  
in the viewfinder may be cropped out of the final photograph,  
and that the time needed to process photographs before  
recording begins may increase). This option does not apply to  
movies and is available only with type G, E, and D lenses (PC,  
fisheye, and certain other lenses excluded); results are not  
guaranteed with other lenses. Before using auto distortion  
control with DX lenses, select On for Auto DX crop or choose an  
image area of DX (24×16) as described on page 110; selecting  
other options may result in heavily cropped photographs or in  
photographs with severe peripheral distortion.  
ARetouch: Distortion Control  
For information on creating copies of existing photographs with  
reduced barrel and pin-cushion distortion, see page 412.  
316  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Long Exposure NR (Long Exposure Noise Reduction)  
G button C photo shooting menu  
If On is selected, photographs taken at  
shutter speeds slower than 1 s will be  
processed to reduce noise (bright spots,  
randomly-spaced bright pixels, or fog).  
The time required for processing  
roughly doubles; during processing,  
l m” will flash in the shutter  
speed/aperture displays and pictures  
can not be taken (if the camera is turned off before processing is  
complete, the picture will be saved but noise reduction will not  
be performed). In continuous release mode, frame rates will  
slow and while photographs are being processed, the capacity  
of the memory buffer will drop.  
High ISO NR  
G button C photo shooting menu/1 movie shooting menu  
Photographs and movies taken at high ISO sensitivities can be  
processed to reduce “noise.”  
Option  
High  
Description  
Reduce noise (randomly-spaced bright pixels), particularly  
in photographs and movies taken at high ISO sensitivities.  
Choose the amount of noise reduction performed from  
High, Normal, and Low.  
Noise reduction is performed only as required and never at  
an amount higher than when Low is selected.  
Normal  
Low  
Off  
317  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
1 The Movie Shooting Menu:  
Movie Shooting Options  
To display the movie shooting menu, press G and select the  
1 (movie shooting menu) tab.  
G button  
Movie Shooting Menu Options  
The movie shooting menu contains the following options:  
Option  
Reset movie shooting menu *  
File naming  
Destination  
Frame size/frame rate  
Movie quality  
Microphone sensitivity  
Frequency response  
Wind noise reduction  
0
318 Image area *  
313 White balance  
319 Set Picture Control  
319 Manage Picture Control *  
320 High ISO NR  
320 Movie ISO sensitivity settings  
320 Time-lapse photography*  
Option  
0
* Not included in the settings saved to U1 or U2 (099).  
Note: Depending on camera settings, some items may be grayed out and  
unavailable.  
Reset Movie Shooting Menu  
G button 1 movie shooting menu  
Select Yes to restore movie shooting menu options to their  
default values (0294).  
318  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Destination  
G button 1 movie shooting menu  
Choose the slot to which movies are  
recorded. The menu shows the time  
available on each card; recording ends  
automatically when no time remains.  
Frame Size/Frame Rate  
G button 1 movie shooting menu  
Choose from the following options:  
Maximum bit rate (Mbps)  
Maximum length  
(high quality/  
normal 2)  
Option 1  
1920 × 1080; 60p  
(high quality/  
normal 2)  
v/y  
w/z  
o/1  
p/2  
q/3  
r/4  
s/5  
42/24  
24/12  
10 min./20 min.  
1920 × 1080; 50p  
1920 × 1080; 30p  
1920 × 1080; 25p  
1920 × 1080; 24p  
1280 × 720; 60p  
1280 × 720; 50p  
20 min./29 min. 59 s  
1
Listed values. Actual frame rates for 60p, 50p, 30p, 25p, and 24p are 59.94, 50, 29.97, 25, and  
23.976 fps respectively.  
See page 320.  
2
AFrame Size and Rate  
Frame size and rate affect the distribution and amount of noise  
(randomly-spaced bright pixels, fog, or bright spots).  
319  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Movie Quality  
G button 1 movie shooting menu  
Together with Frame size/frame rate (0319), Movie quality  
determines the movie recording bit rate and maximum length.  
Choose from High quality and Normal.  
Microphone Sensitivity  
G button 1 movie shooting menu  
Turn the built-in or optional stereo microphones on or off or  
adjust microphone sensitivity. Choose Auto sensitivity to  
adjust sensitivity automatically, Microphone off to turn sound  
recording off; to select microphone sensitivity manually, select  
Manual sensitivity and choose a sensitivity.  
AThe 2 Icon  
2 is displayed during playback if the movie  
was recorded without sound.  
Frequency Response  
G button 1 movie shooting menu  
If K Wide range is selected, the built-in and optional stereo  
microphones (073) will respond to a wide range of frequencies,  
from music to the bustling hum of a city street. Choose  
LVocal range to bring out human voices.  
320  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Wind Noise Reduction  
G button 1 movie shooting menu  
Select On to enable the low-cut filter for the built-in microphone  
(optional stereo microphones are unaffected), reducing noise  
produced by wind blowing over the microphone (note that  
other sounds may also be affected). Wind-noise reduction for  
optional stereo microphones can be enabled or disabled using  
microphone controls.  
White Balance  
G button 1 movie shooting menu  
Choose the white balance for movies  
(0145). Select Same as photo settings  
to use the option currently selected for  
photos.  
Set Picture Control  
G button 1 movie shooting menu  
Choose a Picture Control for movies  
(0165). Select Same as photo settings  
to use the option currently selected for  
photos.  
321  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Movie ISO Sensitivity Settings  
G button 1 movie shooting menu  
Adjust the following ISO sensitivity settings:  
ISO sensitivity (mode M): Choose the ISO sensitivity for mode M  
from values between ISO 100 and Hi 2. Auto ISO sensitivity  
control is used in other shooting modes.  
Auto ISO control (mode M): Select On for auto ISO sensitivity  
control in mode M, Off to use the value selected for ISO  
sensitivity (mode M).  
Maximum sensitivity: Choose the upper limit for auto ISO  
sensitivity control from values between ISO 200 and Hi 2.  
Auto ISO sensitivity control is used in modes P, S, and A and  
when On is selected for Auto ISO control (mode M) in  
exposure mode M.  
AAuto ISO Sensitivity Control  
At high ISO sensitivities, the camera may have difficulty focusing and  
noise (randomly-spaced bright pixels, fog, or lines) may increase. This  
can be prevented by choosing a lower value for Movie ISO sensitivity  
settings > Maximum sensitivity.  
322  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings  
To display the Custom Settings menu, press G and select the  
A (Custom Settings menu) tab.  
G button  
Custom Settings are used to  
customize camera settings to suit  
Custom Setting groups  
individual preferences.  
Main menu  
Reset custom settings (0326)  
323  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Custom Settings  
The following Custom Settings are available:  
Custom Setting  
0
Reset custom settings  
a
Autofocus  
a1 AF-C priority selection  
a2 AF-S priority selection  
a3 Focus tracking with lock-on  
a4 Focus point illumination  
a5 AF point illumination  
a6 Focus point wrap-around  
a7 Number of focus points  
a8 Store points by orientation  
a9 Built-in AF-assist illuminator  
b
Metering/exposure  
b1 ISO sensitivity step value  
b2 EV steps for exposure cntrl  
b3 Easy exposure compensation  
b4 Matrix metering  
b5 Center-weighted area  
b6 Fine-tune optimal exposure  
c
Timers/AE lock  
c1 Shutter-release button AE-L  
c2 Standby timer  
c3 Self-timer  
c4 Monitor off delay  
c5 Remote on duration (ML-L3)  
d
Shooting/display  
d1 Beep  
d2 Continuous low-speed  
d3 Max. continuous release  
d4 Exposure delay mode  
d5 Flash warning  
d6 File number sequence  
d7 Viewfinder grid display  
d8 Easy ISO  
324  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Custom Setting  
0
d
Shooting/display  
d9 Information display  
d10 LCD illumination  
d11 MB-D16 battery type  
d12 Battery order  
e
Bracketing/flash  
e1 Flash sync speed  
e2 Flash shutter speed  
e3 Flash cntrl for built-in flash  
e4 Exposure comp. for flash  
e5 Modeling flash  
e6 Auto bracketing set  
e7 Bracketing order  
f
Controls  
f1 OK button  
f2 Assign Fn button  
f3 Assign preview button  
f4 Assign AE-L/AF-L button  
f5 Customize command dials  
f6 Release button to use dial  
f7 Slot empty release lock  
f8 Reverse indicators  
f9 Assign movie record button  
f10 Assign MB-D16 4 button  
f11 Assign remote (WR) Fn button  
g
Movie  
g1 Assign Fn button  
g2 Assign preview button  
g3 Assign AE-L/AF-L button  
g4 Assign shutter button  
Note: Depending on camera settings, some items may be grayed out and  
unavailable. If settings in the current bank have been modified from  
default values (0295), an asterisk will be displayed adjacent to the  
altered settings in the second level of the Custom Settings menu.  
325  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reset Custom Settings  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Select Yes to restore Custom Settings to their default values  
a: Autofocus  
a1: AF-C Priority Selection  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
When AF-C is selected for viewfinder photography (0121), this  
option controls whether photographs can be taken whenever  
the shutter-release button is pressed (release priority) or only  
when the camera is in focus (focus priority).  
Option  
Description  
Photos can be taken whenever the shutter-release  
button is pressed.  
Release  
G
Photos can only be taken when the in-focus indicator  
(I) is displayed.  
Focus  
F
Regardless of the option selected, focus will not lock when AF-C is  
selected for autofocus mode. The camera will continue to adjust  
focus until the shutter is released.  
326  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
a2: AF-S Priority Selection  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
When AF-S is selected for viewfinder photography (0121), this  
option controls whether photographs can be taken only when  
the camera is in focus (focus priority) or whenever the shutter-  
release button is pressed (release priority).  
Option  
Description  
Photos can be taken whenever the shutter-release  
button is pressed.  
Release  
G
Photos can only be taken when the in-focus indicator  
(I) is displayed.  
Focus  
F
Regardless of the option selected, if the in-focus indicator (I) is  
displayed when AF-S is selected for autofocus mode, focus will  
lock while the shutter-release button is pressed halfway. Focus  
lock continues until the shutter is released.  
327  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
a3: Focus Tracking with Lock-On  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
This option controls how autofocus adjusts to sudden large  
changes in the distance to the subject when AF-C is selected or  
continuous-servo autofocus is selected when the camera is in  
AF-A mode for viewfinder photography (0121).  
Option  
Description  
When the distance to the subject changes abruptly,  
the camera waits for the specified period before  
adjusting the distance to the subject. This prevents  
the camera from refocusing when the subject is  
briefly obscured by objects passing through the  
frame. Note that 2, 1 (Short), and Off are equivalent  
to 3 (Normal) when 3D-tracking or auto-area AF is  
selected for AF-area mode.  
5 (Long)  
C
(
D
)
4
3 (Normal)  
2
1 (Short)  
E
The camera immediately adjusts focus when the  
distance to the subject changes. Use when  
photographing a series of subjects at varying  
distances in quick succession.  
Off  
328  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
a4: Focus Point Illumination  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose from the following focus point display options.  
Option  
Description  
Choose On to display the active focus point in manual  
focus mode, Off to display the focus point only during  
focus point selection.  
Manual focus  
mode  
Choose On to display both the selected focus point and  
the surrounding focus points in dynamic-area AF mode  
(0123). When 3D-tracking is used, a dot will be displayed  
in the center of the focus point (N). Select Off to display  
only the selected focus point.  
Dynamic-area  
AF display  
Choose how the active  
focus points are displayed  
Option  
Focus point display  
in group-area AF (0124).  
Group-area  
AF  
g
illumination  
h
a5: AF Point Illumination  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose whether the active focus point is highlighted in red in  
the viewfinder.  
Option  
Auto  
Description  
The selected focus point is automatically highlighted as  
needed to establish contrast with the background.  
The selected focus point is always highlighted, regardless  
of the brightness of the background. Depending on the  
brightness of the background, the selected focus point  
may be difficult to see.  
On  
Off  
The selected focus point is not highlighted.  
329  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
a6: Focus Point Wrap-Around  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose whether focus-point selection “wraps around” from one  
edge of the viewfinder to another.  
Option  
Description  
Focus-point selection “wraps  
around” from top to bottom,  
bottom to top, right to left, and  
left to right, so that, for example,  
pressing 2when a focus point at  
Wrap  
the right edge of the display is highlighted (q) selects the  
corresponding focus point at the left edge of the display  
(w).  
The focus-point display is bounded by the outermost  
focus points so that, for example, pressing 2when a focus  
point at the right edge of the display is selected has no  
effect.  
No wrap  
a7: Number of Focus Points  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose the number of focus points available for manual focus-  
point selection.  
Option  
Description  
Choose from the 51 focus points shown  
51 points at right.  
B
A
Choose from the 11 focus points shown  
11 points at right. Use for quick focus-point  
selection.  
330  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
a8: Store Points by Orientation  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose whether separate focus points can be selected for  
“wide” (landscape) orientation, for “tall” (portrait) orientation  
with the camera rotated 90 ° clockwise, and for “tall” orientation  
with the camera rotated 90 ° counterclockwise.  
Select No to use the same focus point regardless of camera  
orientation.  
Camera rotated 90 °  
counter-clockwise  
Landscape (wide)  
orientation  
Camera rotated 90 °  
clockwise  
Choose Yes to enable separate focus-point selection.  
Camera rotated 90 °  
counter-clockwise  
Landscape (wide)  
orientation  
Camera rotated 90 °  
clockwise  
331  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
a9: Built-in AF-assist Illuminator  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose whether the built-in AF-assist  
illuminator lights to assist the focus  
operation when lighting is poor.  
Option  
Description  
The AF-assist illuminator lights when lighting is poor  
(viewfinder photography only). AF-assist illumination is  
only available when both of the following conditions are  
met:  
1. AF-S is selected for autofocus mode (0121) or single-  
servo autofocus is selected when the camera is in AF-A  
mode.  
On  
2. Auto-area AF is chosen for AF-area mode (0123), or an  
option other than auto-area AF is chosen and the center  
focus point is selected.  
The AF-assist illuminator does not light to assist the focus  
operation. The camera may not be able to focus using  
autofocus when lighting is poor.  
Off  
AThe AF-Assist Illuminator  
The AF-assist illuminator has a range of about 0.5–3.0 m (1 ft 8 in.–9 ft  
10 in.); when using the illuminator, remove the lens hood.  
332  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
b: Metering/Exposure  
b1: ISO Sensitivity Step Value  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Select the increments used when making adjustments to ISO  
sensitivity (0134). If possible, the current ISO sensitivity setting  
is maintained when the step value is changed. If the current  
setting is not available at the new step value, ISO sensitivity will  
be rounded to the nearest available setting.  
b2: EV Steps for Exposure Cntrl  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Select the increments used when making adjustments to shutter  
speed, aperture, exposure and flash compensation, and  
bracketing.  
333  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
b3: Easy Exposure Compensation  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
This option controls whether the E button is needed to set  
exposure compensation (0143). If On (Auto reset) or On is  
selected, the 0 at the center of the exposure display will flash  
even when exposure compensation is set to 0.  
Option  
Description  
Exposure compensation is set by rotating one of the  
command dials (see note below). The setting selected  
using the command dial is reset when the camera turns  
off or the standby timer expires (exposure  
compensation settings selected using the E button are  
not reset).  
On (Auto reset)  
As above, except that the exposure compensation  
value selected using the command dial is not reset  
when the camera turns off or the standby timer expires.  
Exposure compensation is set by pressing the E button  
and rotating the main command dial.  
On  
Off  
AChange Main/Sub  
The dial used to set exposure compensation when On (Auto reset) or  
On is selected for Custom Setting b3 (Easy exposure compensation)  
depends on the option selected for Custom Setting f5 (Customize  
command dials) > Change main/sub (0363).  
Customize command dials > Change main/sub  
Off  
On  
P
S
A
Sub-command dial  
Sub-command dial  
Main command dial  
Sub-command dial  
Main command dial  
Sub-command dial  
M
N/A  
334  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
AEasy ISO  
Custom Setting b3 (Easy exposure compensation) can not be used  
with Custom Setting d8 (Easy ISO, 0341). Adjustments to either of  
these items reset the remaining item; a message is displayed when the  
item is reset.  
b4: Matrix Metering  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose M Face detection on to enable face detection when  
shooting portraits with matrix metering during viewfinder  
photography (0139).  
b5: Center-Weighted Area  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
When calculating exposure, center-weighted metering assigns  
the greatest weight to a circle in the center of the frame. The  
diameter (φ) of this circle can be set to 8, 12, 15, or 20 mm or to  
the average of the entire frame.  
Note that when a non-CPU lens is used, the area assigned the  
greatest weight for center-weighted metering is equivalent to a  
circle with a diameter of 12 mm, regardless of the setting  
selected for Non-CPU lens data in the setup menu (0235).  
335  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
b6: Fine-tune Optimal Exposure  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Use this option to fine-tune the exposure value selected by the  
camera. Exposure can be fine-tuned separately for each  
metering method by from +1 to –1 EV in steps of 1  
6 EV.  
/
DFine-Tuning Exposure  
Exposure fine-tuning is not affected by two-button resets. Note that as  
the exposure compensation (E) icon is not displayed, the only way to  
determine how much exposure has been altered is to view the amount  
in the fine-tuning menu. Exposure compensation (0143) is preferred  
in most situations.  
c: Timers/AE Lock  
c1: Shutter-Release Button AE-L  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
If On is selected, exposure will lock when the shutter-release  
button is pressed halfway.  
c2: Standby timer  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose how long the camera continues to meter exposure  
when no operations are performed. The shutter-speed and  
aperture displays in the control panel and viewfinder turn off  
automatically when the standby timer expires.  
Choose a shorter standby timer delay for longer battery life.  
336  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
c3: Self-Timer  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose the length of the shutter release delay, the number of  
shots taken, and the interval between shots in self-timer mode  
(0106).  
Self-timer delay: Choose the length of the shutter-release delay.  
Number of shots: Press 1and 3to choose the number of shots  
taken each time the shutter-release button is pressed.  
Interval between shots: Choose the interval between shots when  
the Number of shots is more than 1.  
c4: Monitor off Delay  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose how long the monitor remains on when no operations  
are performed during playback (Playback; defaults to 10 s) and  
image review (Image review; defaults to 4 s), when menus  
(Menus; defaults to 1 minute) or information (Information  
display; defaults to 10 s) are displayed, or during live view and  
movie recording (Live view; defaults to 10 minutes). Choose a  
shorter monitor-off delay for longer battery life.  
c5: Remote on Duration (ML-L3)  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose how long the camera will remain on stand-by in remote  
release mode (0193). If no operations are performed for the  
selected period, remote shooting will end and Off will  
automatically be selected for Remote control mode (ML-L3) in  
the photo shooting menu. Choose shorter times for longer  
battery life.  
337  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
d: Shooting/Display  
d1: Beep  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose the pitch and volume of the beep that sounds when the  
camera focuses using single-servo AF (AF-S or when single-servo  
AF is selected for AF-A; 0121), when focus locks during live view  
photography, while the release timer is counting down in self-  
timer and delayed remote release modes (0193), when a  
photograph is taken in quick-response remote or remote mirror-  
up mode (0193), when time-lapse photography ends (0229),  
or if you attempt to take a photograph when the memory card is  
locked (033).  
Volume: Choose 3 (high), 2 (medium), 1  
(low) or Off (mute). When an option  
other than Off is selected, c appears  
in the information display.  
Pitch: Choose High or Low.  
DBeep  
Note that regardless of the option selected, a beep will not sound  
when the camera focuses in movie live view (066) or quiet-shutter  
release modes (modes J and M; 0103).  
d2: Continuous Low-Speed  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose the maximum frame advance rate in T (continuous low  
speed) mode (0103).  
338  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
d3: Max. Continuous Release  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
The maximum number of shots that can be taken in a single  
burst in continuous mode can be set to any value between 1 and  
100. Note that this setting has no effect at shutter speeds of 4 s  
or slower.  
AThe Memory Buffer  
Regardless of the option selected for Custom Setting d3, shooting will  
slow when the memory buffer fills (tAA). See page 492 for more  
information on the capacity of the memory buffer.  
d4: Exposure Delay Mode  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
In situations where the slightest camera movement can blur  
pictures, select 1 s, 2 s, or 3 s to delay shutter release until one,  
two, or three seconds after the mirror is raised.  
d5: Flash Warning  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
If On is selected, the flash-ready indicator (c) will flash in the  
viewfinder if the flash is required to ensure optimal exposure.  
339  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
d6: File Number Sequence  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
When a photograph is taken, the camera names the file by  
adding one to the last file number used. This option controls  
whether file numbering continues from the last number used  
when a new folder is created, the memory card is formatted, or a  
new memory card is inserted in the camera.  
Option  
Description  
When a new folder is created, the memory card formatted, or a  
new memory card inserted in the camera, file numbering  
continues from the last number used or from the largest file  
number in the current folder, whichever is higher. If a  
photograph is taken when the current folder contains a  
photograph numbered 9999, a new folder will be created  
automatically and file numbering will begin again from 0001.  
File numbering is reset to 0001 when a new folder is created,  
the memory card is formatted, or a new memory card is  
On  
Off inserted in the camera. Note that a new folder is created  
automatically if a photograph is taken when the current folder  
contains 999 photographs.  
As for On, except that the next photograph taken is assigned a  
file number by adding one to the largest file number in the  
current folder. If the folder is empty, file numbering is reset to  
Reset  
0001.  
DFile Number Sequence  
If the current folder is numbered 999 and contains either 999  
photographs or a photograph numbered 9999, the shutter-release  
button will be disabled and no further photographs can be taken.  
Choose Reset for Custom Setting d6 (File number sequence) and  
then either format the current memory card or insert a new memory  
card.  
340  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
d7: Viewfinder Grid Display  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose On to display on-demand grid lines in the viewfinder for  
reference when composing photographs (010).  
d8: Easy ISO  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
If On is selected, ISO sensitivity can be set in modes P and S by  
rotating the sub-command dial or in mode A by rotating the  
main command dial. Select Off to set ISO sensitivity by pressing  
the W (S) button and rotating the main command dial.  
d9: Information Display  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
If Auto (v) is selected, the color of the lettering in the  
information display (012) will automatically change from black  
to white or white to black to maintain contrast with the  
background. To always use the same color lettering, select  
Manual and choose Dark on light (w; black lettering) or Light  
on dark (x; white lettering).  
Dark on light  
Light on dark  
341  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
d10: LCD Illumination  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
If Off is selected, the control panel backlight (LCD illuminator)  
will only light while the power switch is rotated toward D. If On  
is selected, the control panel will be illuminated whenever the  
standby timer is active (039). Select Off for increased battery  
life.  
342  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
d11: MB-D16 Battery Type  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
To ensure that the camera functions as expected when the  
optional MB-D16 battery pack is used with AA batteries, match  
the option selected in this menu to the type of batteries inserted  
in the battery pack. There is no need to adjust this option when  
using EN-EL15 batteries.  
Option  
Description  
LR6 (AA alkaline) Select when using LR6 alkaline AA batteries.  
1
2
3
HR6 (AA Ni-MH)  
Select when using HR6 Ni-MH AA batteries.  
FR6 (AA lithium) Select when using FR6 lithium AA batteries.  
AUsing AA Batteries  
The capacity of AA batteries drops sharply at temperatures below 20 °C  
(68 °F) and varies with make and storage conditions; in some cases,  
batteries may cease to function before their expiry date. Some AA  
batteries can not be used; due to their performance characteristics and  
limited capacity, alkaline batteries have less capacity than some other  
types and should only be used if no alternative is available and then  
only at warmer temperatures. The camera shows the level of AA  
batteries as follows:  
Control panel  
L
Viewfinder  
Description  
Batteries fully charged.  
Low battery. Ready fresh batteries.  
H
H
(flashes)  
d
d
(flashes)  
Shutter release disabled. Change  
batteries.  
343  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
d12: Battery Order  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose whether the battery in the camera or the batteries in the  
battery pack are used first when an optional MB-D16 battery  
pack is attached. Note that if the MB-D16 is powered by an  
optional AC adapter and power connector, the AC adapter will  
be used regardless of the option selected.  
AThe MB-D16 Battery Pack  
The MB-D16 takes one EN-EL15 rechargeable Li-ion battery or six AA  
alkaline, Ni-MH, or lithium batteries (an EN-EL15 is supplied with the  
camera; AA batteries are available separately).  
The information display shows the type of  
battery inserted in the MB-D16 as follows:  
MB-D16 battery  
Battery type  
type display  
EN-EL15 rechargeable  
Li-ion battery  
$
LR6 alkaline AA batteries  
HR6 Ni-MH AA batteries  
FR6 lithium AA batteries  
w
o
p
344  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
e: Bracketing/Flash  
e1: Flash Sync Speed  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
This option controls flash sync speed.  
Option  
Description  
Auto FP high-speed sync is used when a compatible flash  
unit is attached (0435). If the built-in flash or other flash  
1/250 s  
(Auto FP)  
units are used, shutter speed is set to 1  
/
250 s. When the  
250 s in mode P or A,  
auto FP high-speed sync will be activated if the actual  
shutter speed is faster than 1  
camera shows a shutter speed of 1  
/
/250 s.  
Auto FP high-speed sync is used when a compatible flash  
unit is attached (0435). If the built-in flash or other flash  
1/200 s  
(Auto FP)  
units are used, shutter speed is set to 1  
/
200 s. When the  
200 s in mode P or A,  
auto FP high-speed sync will be activated if the actual  
shutter speed is faster than 1  
camera shows a shutter speed of 1  
/
/200 s.  
1/200 s–1/60 s Flash sync speed set to selected value.  
AFixing Shutter Speed at the Flash Sync Speed Limit  
To fix shutter speed at the sync speed limit in mode S or M, select the  
next shutter speed after the slowest possible shutter speed (30 s or  
%). An X (flash sync indicator) will be displayed in the viewfinder and  
control panel.  
AAuto FP High-Speed Sync  
Allows the flash to be used at the highest shutter speed supported by  
the camera, making it possible to choose the maximum aperture for  
reduced depth of field even when the subject is backlit in bright  
sunlight. The information display flash mode indicator shows “FP”  
when auto FP high-speed sync is active (0440).  
345  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
❚❚ Auto FP High-Speed Sync  
When 1/250 s (Auto FP) or 1/200 s (Auto FP) is selected for  
Custom Setting e1 (Flash sync speed, 0345), the built-in flash  
can be used at shutter speeds as fast as 1  
/
250 s or 1  
200 s, while  
/
compatible optional flash units (0435) can be used at any  
shutter speed (Auto FP High-Speed Sync).  
Flash sync speed 1/250 s (Auto FP) 1/200 s (Auto FP)  
1/200 s  
Optional  
flash  
unit  
Optional  
flash  
unit  
Optional  
flash  
unit  
Built-in  
flash  
Built-in  
flash  
Built-in  
flash  
Shutter speed  
From 1  
4000 to but not  
including 1  
From 1  
250 to but not  
including 1  
/
Auto FP  
Auto FP  
Auto FP  
/
250 s  
/
Flash sync*  
/200 s  
1
/200–30 s  
Flash sync  
* Flash range drops as shutter speed increases. Flash range will nevertheless be greater than that  
obtained at the same speeds with Auto FP.  
e2: Flash Shutter Speed  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
This option determines the slowest shutter speed available  
when using front- or rear-curtain sync or red-eye reduction in  
mode P or A (regardless of the setting chosen, shutter speeds can  
be as slow as 30 s in S and M modes or at flash settings of slow  
sync, slow rear-curtain sync, or red-eye reduction with slow  
sync).  
346  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
e3: Flash Cntrl for Built-in Flash  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose the flash mode for the built-in flash.  
Option  
Description  
Flash output is adjusted automatically in  
response to shooting conditions.  
Choose the flash level (0347). The camera  
does not emit monitor pre-flashes.  
TTL  
1
2
Manual  
The flash fires repeatedly while the shutter is  
open, producing a strobe-light effect (0347).  
Use the built-in flash as a master flash  
Repeating flash  
3
Commander mode controlling remote optional flash units in one  
4
or more groups (0348).  
❚❚ Manual  
Choose a flash level. Flash level is stated in fractions of full  
power: at full power, the built-in flash has a Guide Number of 12/  
39 (m/ft, ISO 100, 20°C/68°F).  
❚❚ Repeating Flash  
The flash fires repeatedly while the  
shutter is open, producing a strobe-  
light effect. Press 4or 2to highlight  
the following options, 1or 3to  
change.  
Option  
Description  
Output Choose flash output (expressed as a fraction of full power).  
Choose the number of times the flash fires at the selected  
output. Note that depending on shutter speed and the  
option selected for Frequency, the actual number of flashes  
Times  
may be less than selected.  
Frequency Choose how often the flash fires per second.  
347  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
AFlash Control Mode  
The flash control mode for the built-in flash  
is shown in the information display (0185).  
A“Manual” and “Repeating Flash”  
Y icons flash in the control panel and viewfinder when these options  
are selected.  
AThe SB-500, SB-400, and SB-300  
When an optional SB-500, SB-400, or SB-300 flash unit is attached and  
turned on, Custom Setting e3 changes to Optional flash, allowing the  
flash control mode for the optional flash unit to be selected from TTL  
and Manual (the SB-500 also offers a Commander mode option).  
A“Times“  
The options available for Repeating Flash > Times are determined by  
flash output.  
Output Options available for “Times”  
Output Options available for “Times”  
1/4  
1/8  
1/16  
2
2–5  
2–10  
1/32  
1/64  
2–10, 15  
2–10, 15, 20, 25  
1/128 2–10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 35  
❚❚ Commander Mode  
Use the built-in flash as a master flash controlling one or more  
remote optional flash units in up to two groups (A and B) using  
advanced wireless lighting (0435).  
Selecting this option displays the menu  
shown at right. Press 4or 2to highlight  
the following options, 1or 3to change.  
348  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Option  
Description  
Choose a flash mode for the built-in flash (commander  
flash). When an optional SB-500 flash unit is attached, this  
option changes to Optional flash and is used to choose a  
flash mode for the SB-500. Otherwise this option is  
identical to Built-in flash.  
Built-in  
flash  
i-TTL mode. Choose flash compensation from values  
TTL  
M
between +3.0 and –3.0 EV in increments of 1  
3 EV.  
/
Choose the flash level.  
The built-in flash does not fire, although remote flash units  
do. The built-in flash must be raised so that it can emit  
monitor pre-flashes.  
– –  
Group A Choose a flash mode for all flash units in group A.  
i-TTL mode. Choose flash compensation from values  
TTL  
between +3.0 and –3.0 EV in increments of 1  
3 EV.  
/
Auto aperture (available only with compatible flash units;  
AA  
0435). Choose flash compensation from values between  
+3.0 and –3.0 EV in increments of 1  
3 EV.  
/
M
Choose the flash level.  
– –  
The flash units in this group do not fire.  
Choose a flash mode for all flash units in group B. The  
Group B options available are the same as those listed for Group A,  
above.  
Choose from channels 1–4. All flash units in both groups  
must be set to the same channel.  
Channel  
349  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Follow the steps below to take photographs in commander  
mode.  
1
Adjust settings for the built-in  
flash.  
Choose the flash control mode and  
output level for the built-in flash.  
Note that output level can not be  
adjusted in – – mode.  
2
3
4
5
Adjust settings for group A.  
Choose the flash control mode and  
output level for the flash units in  
group A.  
Adjust settings for group B.  
Choose the flash control mode and  
output level for the flash units in  
group B.  
Select the channel.  
Press J.  
350  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6
Compose the shot.  
Compose the shot and arrange the flash units as shown  
below. Note that the maximum distance at which the remote  
flash units can be placed may vary with shooting conditions.  
60 ° or less  
5 m/15 ft or less  
10 m/33 ft or less  
30 ° or less  
30 ° or less  
Camera  
(built-in flash)  
5 m/15 ft or less  
60 ° or less  
Wireless remote sensors on flash units should face  
camera.  
7
8
Configure the remote flash units.  
Turn all the remote flash units on, adjust group settings as  
desired, and set them to the channel selected in Step 4. See  
the flash unit instruction manuals for details.  
Raise the built-in flash.  
Press the M (Y) button to raise the built-in flash. Note that  
even if – – is selected for Built-in flash>Mode, the built-in  
flash must be raised so that monitor preflashes will be  
emitted.  
351  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9
Frame the photograph, focus, and shoot.  
After confirming that the camera flash-ready light and the  
flash-ready lights for all other flash units are lit, frame the  
photograph, focus, and shoot. FV lock (0 190) can be used if  
desired.  
A The Flash Sync Mode Display  
M does not appear in the information display when – – is selected for  
Built-in flash > Mode.  
A Flash Compensation  
The flash compensation value selected with the M (Y) button and  
sub-command dial is added to the flash compensation values selected  
for the built-in flash, group A, and group B in the Commander mode  
menu. A Y icon is displayed in the control panel and viewfinder when  
a flash compensation value other than 0 is selected for the built-in  
flash or remote flash units in TTL or AA mode. The Y icon flashes  
when the built-in flash is in mode M.  
D Commander Mode  
Position the sensor windows on the remote flash units to pick up the  
light from the built-in flash (particular care is required if the camera is  
not mounted on a tripod). Be sure that direct light or strong reflections  
from the remote flash units do not enter the camera lens (in TTL mode)  
or the photocells on the remote flash units (AA mode), as this may  
interfere with exposure. To prevent timing flashes emitted by the  
built-in flash from appearing in photographs taken at short range,  
choose low ISO sensitivities or small apertures (high f-numbers) or use  
an optional SG-3IR infrared panel for the built-in flash. An SG-3IR is  
required for best results with rear-curtain sync, which produces  
brighter timing flashes. After positioning the remote flash units, take a  
test shot and view the results in the camera monitor.  
Although there is no limit on the number of remote flash units that  
may be used, the practical maximum is three. With more than this  
number, the light emitted by the remote flash units will interfere with  
performance.  
352  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
e4: Exposure Comp. for Flash  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose how the camera adjusts flash level when exposure  
compensation is used.  
Option  
Description  
Both flash level and exposure compensation  
are adjusted to modify exposure over the  
entire frame.  
Entire frame  
YE  
E
Exposure compensation applies to  
background only.  
Background only  
e5: Modeling Flash  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
If On is selected when the camera is being used with the built-in  
flash or an optional flash unit that supports the Nikon Creative  
Lighting system (0435), a modeling flash will be emitted when  
the camera Pv button is pressed (092). No modeling flash is  
emitted if Off is selected.  
e6: Auto Bracketing Set  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose the setting or settings bracketed when auto bracketing  
(0202) is in effect. Choose AE & flash (j) to perform both  
exposure and flash-level bracketing, AE only (k) to bracket only  
exposure, Flash only (l) to perform only flash-level bracketing,  
WB bracketing (m) to perform white-balance bracketing  
(0208), or ADL bracketing (y) to perform bracketing using  
Active D-Lighting (0212). Note that white balance bracketing  
is not available at image quality settings of NEF (RAW) or  
NEF (RAW) + JPEG.  
353  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
e7: Bracketing Order  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
At the default setting of MTR > under > over (H), exposure,  
flash, and white balance bracketing are performed in the order  
described on pages 204 and 209. If Under > MTR > over (I) is  
selected, shooting will proceed in order from the lowest to the  
highest value. This setting has no effect on ADL bracketing.  
f: Controls  
f1: OK Button  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
This option determines the role assigned to the J button  
during viewfinder photography, playback, and live view  
(regardless of the option selected, pressing J when a movie is  
displayed full frame starts movie playback).  
❚❚ Shooting Mode  
Option  
Role assigned to J button  
Select the center focus point.  
Select center  
focus point  
Highlight active  
focus point  
J
K
Highlight the active focus point.  
Pressing the J button has no effect in viewfinder  
photography.  
None  
354  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
❚❚ Playback Mode  
Option  
Role assigned to J button  
Toggle between full-frame and thumbnail  
playback.  
Thumbnail on/off  
Q
R
In both full-frame and thumbnail playback,  
View histograms a histogram is displayed while the J button is  
pressed (0250).  
Toggle between full-frame or thumbnail playback  
and playback zoom. Choose the initial zoom  
Zoom on/off  
setting from Low magnification (50%), 1 : 1  
(100%), and High magnification (200%). The  
zoom display will center on the active focus point.  
p
Choose slot and Display the slot and folder selection dialog  
W
folder  
❚❚ Live View  
Option  
Role assigned to J button  
Select center  
Pressing the J button in live view selects the  
center focus point.  
J
focus point  
Zoom on/off  
None  
Press the J button to toggle zoom on and off.  
Choose the initial zoom setting from Low  
magnification (50%), 1 : 1 (100%), and High  
magnification (200%). The zoom display will  
center on the active focus point.  
p
Pressing the J button has no effect in live view.  
355  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
f2: Assign Fn Button  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose the role played by the Fn button,  
either by itself (Press) or when used in  
combination with the command dials  
(Press + command dials).  
❚❚ Press  
Selecting Press displays the following options:  
Option  
Description  
During viewfinder photography, you can preview  
depth of field while the Fn button is pressed  
(092). During live view photography, you can  
press the button once to open the lens to  
maximum aperture, making it easier to check  
focus; pressing the button again restores  
aperture to its original value (056).  
Preview  
q
Press the Fn button to lock flash value (built-in  
flash and compatible optional flash units only,  
0190, 435). Press again to cancel FV lock.  
Focus and exposure lock while the Fn button is  
pressed.  
FV lock  
r
AE/AF lock  
B
C
AE lock only  
Exposure locks while the Fn button is pressed.  
Exposure locks when the Fn button is pressed,  
and remains locked until the button is pressed a  
second time or the standby timer expires.  
AE lock (Hold)  
E
AF lock only  
AF-ON  
Focus locks while the Fn button is pressed.  
F
Pressing the Fn button initiates autofocus. The  
shutter-release button can not be used to focus.  
The flash will not fire in photos taken while the Fn  
button is pressed.  
A
Flash off  
s
356  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Option  
Description  
If the Fn button is pressed while exposure, flash, or  
ADL bracketing is active in single frame or quiet  
shutter-release mode, all shots in the current  
bracketing program will be taken each time the  
Bracketing burst shutter-release button is pressed. If white  
balance bracketing is active or continuous release  
mode (mode U, T or M) is selected, the camera  
will repeat the bracketing burst while the shutter-  
release button is held down.  
t
If image quality is set to JPEG fine, JPEG normal,  
or JPEG basic, e will be displayed in the  
viewfinder and an NEF (RAW) copy will be  
recorded with the next picture taken after the Fn  
+ NEF (RAW)  
button is pressed (the original image quality  
setting will be restored when you remove your  
finger from the shutter-release button). To exit  
without recording an NEF (RAW) copy, press the  
Fn button again.  
e
Matrix metering is activated while the Fn button is  
pressed.  
Center-weighted Center-weighted metering is activated while the  
Matrix metering  
L
M
N
metering  
Fn button is pressed.  
Spot metering is activated while the Fn button is  
pressed.  
Spot metering  
Highlight-  
weighted  
metering  
Highlight-weighted metering is activated while  
the Fn button is pressed.  
4
Viewfinder grid Press the Fn button to turn the framing grid  
9
m
n
display  
display in the viewfinder on or off (010).  
Viewfinder  
Press the Fn button to view a virtual horizon  
virtual horizon display in the viewfinder (0359).  
Pressing the Fn button displays “MY MENU”  
MY MENU  
357  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Option  
Description  
Press the Fn button to jump to the top item in “MY  
MENU.” Select this option for quick access to a  
frequently-used menu item.  
Access top item  
in MY MENU  
6
Fn button performs same function as K button.  
Select when using a telephoto lens or in other  
circumstances in which it is difficult to operate  
the K button with your left hand.  
Playback  
None  
K
Pressing the button has no effect.  
AIncompatible Options  
If the option selected for Press can not be used in combination with  
the option selected for Press + command dials, a message will be  
displayed and whichever of Press or Press + command dials was  
selected first will be set to None.  
358  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AViewfinder Virtual Horizon  
When Viewfinder virtual horizon is selected for Custom Setting f2  
(Assign Fn button) > Press, pressing the Fn button displays a roll  
indicator in the viewfinder. Press the button a second time to return to  
clear the indicators from display.  
Camera tilted right  
Camera level  
Camera tilted left  
Viewfinder  
(camera in  
landscape  
orientation)  
Viewfinder  
(camera in  
portrait  
orientation)  
Note that the display may not be accurate when the camera is tilted at  
a sharp angle forward or back. For a display that shows both pitch and  
roll, use the Virtual horizon option in the setup menu (0388).  
359  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
❚❚ Press + Command Dials  
Selecting Press + command dials displays the following  
options:  
Option  
Description  
Keeping the Fn button pressed, rotate a  
command dial to choose an image area (0114).  
Choose image  
area  
5
If the Fn button is pressed when the command  
dials are rotated, changes to shutter speed  
(modes S and M) and aperture (modes A and M)  
are made in increments of 1 EV, regardless of the  
option selected for Custom Setting b2 (EV steps  
for exposure cntrl, 0333).  
1 step spd/  
aperture  
v
Press the Fn button and rotate a command dial to  
choose a lens number specified using the Non-  
CPU lens data option (0238).  
Press the Fn button and rotate a command dial to  
adjust Active D-Lighting (0175).  
Choose non-CPU  
lens number  
w
y
Active  
D-Lighting  
Keeping the Fn button pressed, rotate the main  
command dial to choose an HDR mode, the sub-  
command dial to choose HDR strength (0178).  
HDR (high  
dynamic range)  
S
z
Exposure delay Press the Fn button and rotate a command dial to  
mode  
choose an exposure delay mode (0339).  
No operation is performed when the command  
dials are rotated while the Fn button is pressed.  
None  
360  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
f3: Assign Preview Button  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose the role played by the Pv button,  
either by itself (Press) or when used in  
combination with the command dials  
(Press + command dials). The options  
available are the same as for Assign Fn  
button (0356). The default options for  
Press and Press + command dials are  
Preview and None, respectively.  
f4: Assign AE-L/AF-L Button  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose the role played by the A AE-L/AF-L  
button, either by itself (Press) or when  
used in combination with the command  
dials (Press + command dials).  
❚❚ Press  
Selecting Press displays the following options:  
Option  
Description  
Focus and exposure lock while the A AE-L/AF-L  
button is pressed.  
Exposure locks while the A AE-L/AF-L button is  
pressed.  
AE/AF lock  
B
C
AE lock only  
Exposure locks when the A AE-L/AF-L button is  
pressed, and remains locked until the button is  
pressed a second time or the standby timer  
expires.  
AE lock (Hold)  
E
361  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Option  
Description  
Focus locks while the A AE-L/AF-L button is  
pressed.  
AF lock only  
F
The A AE-L/AF-L button initiates autofocus. The  
shutter-release button can not be used to focus.  
Press the A AE-L/AF-L button to lock flash value  
(built-in flash and compatible optional flash  
units only, 0190, 435). Press again to cancel FV  
lock.  
AF-ON  
A
FV lock  
None  
r
Pressing the button has no effect.  
❚❚ Press + Command Dials  
Selecting Press + command dials displays the following  
options:  
Option  
Description  
Choose image  
area  
Keeping the A AE-L/AF-L button pressed, rotate a  
command dial to choose an image area (0114).  
Press the A AE-L/AF-L button and rotate a  
5
Choose non-CPU command dial to choose a lens number  
w
lens number  
None  
specified using the Non-CPU lens data option  
No operation is performed when the command  
dials are rotated while the A AE-L/AF-L button is  
pressed.  
362  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
f5: Customize Command Dials  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
This option controls the operation of the main and sub-  
command dials.  
Option  
Description  
Reverse the direction of rotation  
of the command dials when they  
are used to make adjustments to  
Exposure compensation and/or  
Shutter speed/aperture.  
Highlight options and press 2to  
Reverse  
rotation  
select or deselect, then press J.  
This setting also applies to the command dials for optional  
MB-D16 multi-power battery packs.  
Exposure setting: If Off is selected, the main command dial  
controls shutter speed and the sub-command dial controls  
aperture. If On is selected, the main command dial will  
control aperture and the sub-command dial shutter speed.  
If On (Mode A) is selected, the main command dial will be  
used to set aperture in shooting mode A only.  
Autofocus setting: If On is selected, autofocus mode can be  
selected by keeping the AF-mode button pressed and  
rotating the sub-command dial, AF-area mode by keeping  
the AF-mode button pressed and rotating the main  
command dial.  
Change  
main/sub  
These settings also apply to the command dials for the  
MB-D16.  
363  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Option  
Description  
If Sub-command dial is selected, aperture can only be  
adjusted with the sub-command dial (or with the main  
command dial if On is selected for Change main/sub >  
Exposure setting). If Aperture ring is selected, aperture  
Aperture can only be adjusted with the lens aperture ring and the  
setting camera aperture display will show aperture in increments of  
1 EV (aperture for type G and E lenses is still set using the  
sub-command dial). Note that regardless of the setting  
chosen, the aperture ring must be used to adjust aperture  
when a non-CPU lens is attached.  
If Off is selected, the multi selector is used to choose the  
picture displayed during full-frame playback, highlight  
thumbnails, and navigate menus. If On or On (image  
review excluded) is selected, the main command dial can  
be used to choose the picture displayed during full-frame  
playback, move the cursor left or right during thumbnail  
playback, and move the menu highlight bar up or down.  
Menus and The sub-command dial is used in full-frame playback to skip  
playback forward or back according to the option selected for Sub-  
dial frame advance and in thumbnail playback to page up  
or down. While menus are displayed, rotating the sub-  
command dial right displays the sub-menu for the selected  
option, while rotating it left displays the previous menu. To  
make a selection, press 2or J. Select On (image review  
excluded) to prevent the command dials from being used  
for playback during image review.  
When On or On (image review excluded) is selected for  
Menus and playback, the sub-command dial can be  
rotated during full-frame playback to select a folder or to  
skip forward or back 10 or 50 frames at a time.  
Sub-dial  
frame  
advance  
364  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
f6: Release Button to Use Dial  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Selecting Yes allows adjustments that are normally made by  
holding a button and rotating a command dial to be made by  
rotating the command dial after the button is released. Setting  
ends when the button is pressed again, the shutter-release  
button is pressed halfway, or the standby timer expires. This  
option is available with the following buttons:  
Button  
0
Button  
Z (Q)  
D
Fn 1  
Pv 2  
0
E
146, 150, 154, A AE-L/AF-L 3  
M (Y)  
W (S)  
X (T)  
L (U)  
Movie-record  
button 4  
AF mode button  
1
2
When assigned non-CPU lens number selection, Active D-Lighting, HDR, or exposure delay  
mode using Custom Setting f2.  
When assigned non-CPU lens number selection, Active D-Lighting, HDR, or exposure delay  
mode using Custom Setting f3.  
3
4
When assigned non-CPU lens number selection using Custom Setting f4.  
When assigned white balance or ISO sensitivity using Custom Setting f9.  
f7: Slot Empty Release Lock  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Selecting Enable release allows the shutter to be released when  
no memory card is inserted, although no pictures will be  
recorded (they will however be displayed in the monitor in  
demo mode). If Release locked is selected, the shutter-release  
button is only enabled when a memory card is inserted in the  
camera.  
365  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
f8: Reverse Indicators  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
If  
(W) is selected, the exposure indicators in  
the control panel, viewfinder, and information display are  
displayed with negative values on the left and positive values on  
the right. Select  
(V) to display positive  
values on the left and negative values on the right.  
f9: Assign Movie Record Button  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose the role played by the movie-  
record button during viewfinder and  
live view photography.  
Movie-record button  
❚❚ Press + Command Dials  
Option  
Description  
Press the button and rotate a command dial to  
choose a white balance option (0145).  
Press the button and rotate a command dial to  
choose an ISO sensitivity (0134).  
Press the button and rotate a command dial to  
choose an image area (0114).  
White balance  
ISO sensitivity  
m
8
5
Choose image  
area  
No operation is performed if the command dials  
are rotated while the button is pressed.  
None  
366  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
f10: Assign MB-D16 4 Button  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose the function assigned  
to the A AE-L/AF-L button on  
the optional MB-D16 battery  
pack.  
Option  
Description  
Focus and exposure lock while the MB-D16  
A AE-L/AF-L button is pressed.  
Exposure locks while the MB-D16 A AE-L/AF-L  
button is pressed.  
AE/AF lock  
B
C
AE lock only  
Exposure locks when the MB-D16 A AE-L/AF-L  
button is pressed, and remains locked until the  
button is pressed a second time or the standby  
timer expires.  
AE lock (Hold)  
E
Focus locks while the MB-D16 A AE-L/AF-L button  
is pressed.  
Pressing the MB-D16 A AE-L/AF-L button initiates  
autofocus. The shutter-release button can not  
be used to focus.  
AF lock only  
AF-ON  
F
A
Press the MB-D16 A AE-L/AF-L button to lock flash  
value (built-in flash and compatible optional  
flash units only, 0190, 435). Press again to  
cancel FV lock.  
The MB-D16 A AE-L/AF-L button performs the  
same function as the camera Fn button (0356).  
FV lock  
r
G
Same as Fn  
button  
367  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
f11: Assign Remote (WR) Fn Button  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose the role played by the Fn button on the  
wireless remote controller.  
Option  
Description  
During viewfinder photography, you can  
preview depth of field while the Fn button is  
pressed (092). During live view photography,  
you can press the button once to open the lens  
to maximum aperture, making it easier to check  
focus; pressing the button again restores  
aperture to its original value (056).  
Preview  
q
Press the Fn button to lock flash value (built-in  
flash and compatible optional flash units only,  
0190, 435). Press again to cancel FV lock.  
Focus and exposure lock while the Fn button is  
pressed.  
FV lock  
r
AE/AF lock  
B
C
AE lock only  
Exposure locks while the Fn button is pressed.  
Exposure locks when the Fn button is pressed,  
and remains locked until the button is pressed a  
second time or the standby timer expires.  
AE lock (Hold)  
E
AF lock only  
Flash off  
Focus locks while the Fn button is pressed.  
F
s
The flash will not fire in photos taken while the Fn  
button is pressed.  
368  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Option  
Description  
If image quality is set to JPEG fine, JPEG normal,  
or JPEG basic, e will be displayed in the  
viewfinder and an NEF (RAW) copy will be  
recorded with the next picture taken after the Fn  
button is pressed (the original image quality  
setting will be restored when you remove your  
finger from the shutter-release button). To exit  
without recording an NEF (RAW) copy, press the  
Fn button again.  
+ NEF (RAW)  
Live view  
e
Pressing the Fn button starts and ends live view.  
a
The wireless remote controller Fn button  
performs the same function as the camera Fn  
button (0356).  
Same as camera  
Fn button  
x
The wireless remote controller Fn button  
performs the same function as the camera Pv  
button (0361).  
The wireless remote controller Fn button  
performs the same function as the camera  
A AE-L/AF-L button (0361).  
Same as camera  
Pv button  
y
z
Same as camera  
4 button  
None  
Pressing the button has no effect.  
369  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
g: Movie  
g1: Assign Fn Button  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose the role played by the Fn button during movie live view  
(the default option is None).  
❚❚ Press  
Option  
Description  
Aperture widens while the button is pressed.  
Use in combination with Custom Setting g2  
(Assign preview button) > Power aperture  
(close) for button-controlled aperture  
adjustment (0372).  
Power aperture  
(open)  
q
r
Press the button during movie recording to add  
Index marking an index at the current position (070). Indices  
can be used when viewing and editing movies.  
Press the button to display information on  
shutter speed, aperture, and other photo  
View photo  
settings in place of movie recording information.  
shooting info  
s
Press again to return to the movie recording  
display.  
Focus and exposure lock while the button is  
pressed.  
AE/AF lock  
B
C
AE lock only  
Exposure locks while the button is pressed.  
Exposure locks when the button is pressed, and  
remains locked until the button is pressed a  
second time.  
AE lock (Hold)  
E
AF lock only  
AF-ON  
Focus locks while the button is pressed.  
F
Pressing the button initiates autofocus. The  
shutter-release button can not be used to focus.  
A
None  
Pressing the button has no effect.  
370  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
APower Aperture  
Power aperture is not available with some lenses. Power aperture is  
available only in modes A and M and can not be used while photo  
shooting info is displayed (a 6 icon indicates that power aperture can  
not be used).  
371  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
g2: Assign Preview Button  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose the role played by the Pv button during movie live view  
(the default option is Index marking).  
❚❚ Press  
Option  
Description  
Aperture narrows while the button is pressed.  
Use in combination with Custom Setting g1  
(Assign Fn button) > Power aperture (open)  
for button-controlled aperture adjustment  
Power aperture  
(close)  
q
r
Press the button during movie recording to add  
Index marking an index at the current position (070). Indices  
can be used when viewing and editing movies.  
Press the button to display information on  
shutter speed, aperture, and other photo  
View photo  
settings in place of movie recording information.  
shooting info  
s
Press again to return to the movie recording  
display.  
Focus and exposure lock while the button is  
pressed.  
AE/AF lock  
B
C
AE lock only  
Exposure locks while the button is pressed.  
Exposure locks when the button is pressed, and  
remains locked until the button is pressed a  
second time.  
AE lock (Hold)  
E
AF lock only  
AF-ON  
Focus locks while the button is pressed.  
F
Pressing the button initiates autofocus. The  
shutter-release button can not be used to focus.  
A
None  
Pressing the button has no effect.  
372  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
g3: Assign AE-L/AF-L Button  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
❚❚ Press  
Choose the role played by the A AE-L/AF-L button during movie  
live view. The options available are the same as for Assign Fn  
button (0370), except that Power aperture (open) is not  
available and the default setting is AE/AF lock.  
g4: Assign Shutter Button  
G button A Custom Settings menu  
Choose the role played by pressing the shutter-release button  
when 1 is selected with the live view selector.  
Option  
Description  
Press the shutter-release button all the way  
down to end movie recording and take a  
photograph with an aspect ratio of 16 : 9 (for  
information on image size, see page 77).  
Press the shutter-release button halfway to start  
movie live view. You can then press the shutter-  
release button halfway to focus (autofocus mode  
only) and press it all the way down to start or end  
recording. The shutter-release button can not be  
used for other purposes during movie live view.  
To end movie live view, press the a button. The  
shutter-release button on an optional wireless  
remote controller or remote cord (0443, 444)  
functions in the same way as the camera shutter-  
release button; the optional ML-L3 remote  
control, however, can not be used to record  
movies; the shutter-release button on the ML-L3  
has no effect.  
Take photos  
C
Record movies  
1
373  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup  
To display the setup menu, press G and select the B (setup  
menu) tab.  
G button  
Setup Menu Options  
The setup menu contains the following options:  
Option  
Format memory card  
Save user settings  
Reset user settings  
Monitor brightness  
Monitor color balance  
Clean image sensor  
Lock mirror up for cleaning 1  
Image Dust Off ref photo  
Flicker reduction  
0
Option  
0
375 Image comment  
Copyright information  
101 Save/load settings  
376 Virtual horizon  
377 Non-CPU lens data  
448 AF fine-tune  
451 HDMI  
378 Location data  
380 Wi-Fi  
381 Network  
Time zone and date  
Language  
Auto image rotation  
Battery info  
381 Eye-Fi upload 2  
382 Conformity marking  
383 Firmware version  
1
Not available when battery is low.  
2
Only displayed when compatible Eye-Fi memory card is inserted.  
ASee Also  
Menu defaults are listed on page 299.  
374  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Format Memory Card  
G button B setup menu  
Memory cards must be formatted before first use or after being  
used or formatted in other devices. Note that formatting  
permanently deletes all pictures and other data on the card. Before  
formatting, be sure to make backup copies as required (0266).  
DDuring Formatting  
Do not turn the camera off or remove memory cards during formatting.  
Selecting Format memory card in the  
setup menu displays the options shown  
at right; choose a memory card slot and  
select Yes to format the selected card.  
Memory cards can also be formatted by  
holding the O (Q) and Z (Q) buttons  
down simultaneously until a flashing C appears in the  
shutter-speed displays in the control panel and viewfinder.  
O (Q) button Z (Q) button  
375  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Press the buttons together again a second time to format the  
card (to exit without formatting the card, press any other button  
or wait for about six seconds until C stops flashing). When  
formatting is complete, the control panel and viewfinder will  
show the number of photographs that can be recorded at  
current settings.  
ATwo Memory Cards  
If two memory cards are inserted when the O (Q) and Z (Q) buttons  
are pressed, the card to be formatted will be shown by a flashing icon.  
Rotate the main command dial to choose a different slot.  
Monitor Brightness  
G button B setup menu  
Press 1or 3to choose monitor brightness for playback, menus,  
and the information display. Choose higher values for increased  
brightness, lower values for reduced brightness.  
AMonitor Brightness  
Values of +4 or higher make the monitor easier to read in bright light  
but also result in yellow colors taking on a greenish cast. Choose lower  
values for accurate color reproduction.  
ASee Also  
The option selected for Monitor brightness has no effect on the  
brightness of the display during live view photography or movie live  
view. For information on adjusting monitor brightness in live view, see  
page 62.  
376  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Monitor Color Balance  
G button B setup menu  
Use the multi selector as shown below to  
adjust monitor color balance with  
reference to a sample image. The sample  
image is the last photograph taken or, in  
playback mode, the last photograph  
displayed; to choose a different image,  
press the W (S) button and select an  
image from a thumbnail list (to view the  
highlighted image full frame, press and  
hold X/T). If the memory card  
contains no photographs, an empty  
frame with a gray border will be  
displayed in place of the sample image.  
Press J to exit when adjustments are complete. Monitor color  
balance applies only to menus, playback, and the view through  
the lens displayed during live view photography and movie live  
view; pictures taken with the camera are not affected.  
Increase amount of green  
Increase amount of blue  
Increase amount of amber  
Increase amount of magenta  
377  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Image Dust Off Ref Photo  
G button B setup menu  
Acquire reference data for the Image Dust Off option in  
Capture NX-D (available for download, 0268; for more  
information, refer to Capture NX-D on-line help).  
Image Dust Off ref photo is available only when a CPU lens is  
mounted on the camera. A non-DX lens with a focal length of at  
least 50 mm is recommended. When using a zoom lens, zoom all  
the way in.  
1
Choose a start option.  
Highlight one of the following options  
and press J. To exit without  
acquiring image dust off data, press  
G.  
Start: The message shown at right  
will be displayed and “rEF” will  
appear in the viewfinder and control  
panel displays.  
Clean sensor and then start: Select this  
option to clean the image sensor  
before starting. The message shown  
at right will be displayed and “rEF”  
will appear in the viewfinder and  
control panel displays when  
cleaning is complete.  
378  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
2
3
Frame a featureless white object in the viewfinder.  
With the lens about ten centimeters (four inches) from a well-  
lit, featureless white object, frame the object so that it fills the  
viewfinder and then press the shutter-release button  
halfway.  
In autofocus mode, focus will automatically be set to infinity;  
in manual focus mode, set focus to infinity manually.  
Acquire dust off reference data.  
Press the shutter-release button the rest of the way down to  
acquire Image Dust Off reference data. The monitor turns off  
when the shutter-release button is pressed.  
If the reference object is too bright or  
too dark, the camera may be unable  
to acquire Image Dust Off reference  
data and the message shown at right  
will be displayed. Choose another  
reference object and repeat the  
process from step 1.  
379  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DImage Sensor Cleaning  
Dust off reference data recorded before image sensor cleaning is  
performed can not be used with photographs taken after image  
sensor cleaning is performed. Select Clean sensor and then start  
only if the dust off reference data will not be used with existing  
photographs.  
DImage Dust Off Reference Data  
The same reference data can be used for  
photographs taken with different lenses or  
at different apertures. Reference images can  
not be viewed using computer imaging  
software. A grid pattern is displayed when  
reference images are viewed on the camera.  
Flicker Reduction  
G button B setup menu  
Reduce flicker and banding when shooting under fluorescent or  
mercury-vapor lighting during live view or movie recording.  
Choose Auto to allow the camera to automatically choose the  
correct frequency, or manually match the frequency to that of  
the local AC power supply.  
AFlicker Reduction  
If Auto fails to produce the desired results and you are unsure as to the  
frequency of the local power supply, test both the 50 and 60 Hz  
options and choose the one that produces the best results. Flicker  
reduction may not produce the desired results if the subject is very  
bright, in which case you should try choosing a smaller aperture  
(higher f-number).  
380  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Time Zone and Date  
G button B setup menu  
Change time zones, set the camera clock, choose the date  
display order, and turn daylight saving time on or off.  
Option  
Description  
Choose a time zone. The camera clock is  
automatically set to the time in the new time zone.  
Set the camera clock. If the clock is reset, a  
flashing Y icon will appear in the information  
display.  
Time zone  
Date and time  
Date format  
Choose the order in which the day, month, and  
year are displayed.  
Turn daylight saving time on or off. The camera  
Daylight saving time clock will automatically be advanced or set back  
one hour. The default setting is Off.  
Language  
G button B setup menu  
Choose a language for camera menus and messages.  
381  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
Auto Image Rotation  
G button B setup menu  
Photographs taken while On is selected contain information on  
camera orientation, allowing them to be rotated automatically  
during playback (0242) or when viewed in ViewNX 2 (supplied)  
or in Capture NX-D (available for download; 0268). The  
following orientations are recorded:  
Landscape (wide)  
orientation  
Camera rotated 90°  
clockwise  
Camera rotated 90°  
counter-clockwise  
Camera orientation is not recorded when Off is selected.  
Choose this option when panning or taking photographs with  
the lens pointing up or down.  
ARotate Tall  
To automatically rotate “tall” (portrait-orientation) photographs for  
display during playback, select On for the Rotate tall option in the  
playback menu (0308).  
382  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Battery Info  
G button B setup menu  
View information on the battery  
currently inserted in the camera.  
Item  
Description  
Charge  
The current battery level expressed as a percentage.  
The number of times the shutter has been released with  
the current battery since the battery was last charged.  
No. of shots Note that the camera may sometimes release the shutter  
without recording a photograph, for example when  
measuring preset manual white balance.  
A five-level display showing battery age. 0 (k) indicates  
that battery performance is unimpaired, 4 (l) that the  
battery has reached the end of its charging life and  
should be replaced. Note that fresh batteries charged at  
Battery age temperatures under about 5 °C (41 °F) may show a  
temporary drop in charging life; the battery age display  
will however return to normal once the battery has been  
recharged at a temperature of about 20 °C (68 °F) or  
higher.  
AThe MB-D16 Battery Pack  
The display for the MB-D16 battery pack is  
shown at right. If AA batteries are used, the  
battery level will be shown by a battery level  
icon; other items will not be displayed.  
383  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Image Comment  
G button B setup menu  
Add a comment to new photographs as they are taken.  
Comments can be viewed as metadata in ViewNX 2 (supplied) or  
Capture NX-D (available for download; 0268). The comment is  
also visible on the shooting data page in the photo information  
display (0251). The following options are available:  
Input comment: Input a comment as described on page 171.  
Comments can be up to 36 characters long.  
Attach comment: Select this option to  
attach the comment to all subsequent  
photographs. Attach comment can  
be turned on and off by highlighting it  
and pressing 2. After choosing the  
desired setting, press J to exit.  
384  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Copyright Information  
G button B setup menu  
Add copyright information to new photographs as they are  
taken. Copyright information is included in the shooting data  
shown in the photo information display (0251) and can be  
viewed as metadata in ViewNX 2 (supplied) or in Capture NX-D  
(available for download; 0268). The following options are  
available:  
Photographer names can be up to 36 characters long.  
Copyright: Enter the name of the copyright holder as described  
on page 171. Copyright holder names can be up to 54  
characters long.  
Attach copyright information: Select this  
option to attach copyright information  
to all subsequent photographs.  
Attach copyright information can be  
turned on and off by highlighting it  
and pressing 2. After choosing the  
desired setting, press J to exit.  
DCopyright Information  
To prevent unauthorized use of the artist or copyright holder names,  
make sure that Attach copyright information is not selected and that  
the Artist and Copyright fields are blank before lending or  
transferring the camera to another person. Nikon does not accept  
liability for any damages or disputes arising from the use of the  
Copyright information option.  
385  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Save/Load Settings  
G button B setup menu  
Select Save settings to save the following settings to the  
memory card in Slot 1 (0119; if the card is full, an error will be  
displayed). Use this option to share settings among D750  
cameras.  
Menu  
Option  
Playback display options  
Image review  
After delete  
Playback  
Rotate tall  
File naming  
Role played by card in Slot 2  
Image quality  
Image size  
Image area  
JPEG compression  
NEF (RAW) recording  
White balance (with fine-tuning and presets d-1–d-6)  
Set Picture Control (Custom Picture Controls are saved  
as Standard)  
Photo shooting  
Color space  
Active D-Lighting  
Vignette control  
Auto distortion control  
Long exposure NR  
High ISO NR  
ISO sensitivity settings  
Remote control mode (ML-L3)  
Destination  
Movie shooting Frame size/frame rate  
Movie quality  
386  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Menu  
Option  
Microphone sensitivity  
Frequency response  
Wind noise reduction  
Image area  
Movie shooting  
White balance (with fine-tuning and presets d-1–d-6)  
Set Picture Control (Custom Picture Controls are saved  
as Standard)  
High ISO NR  
Movie ISO sensitivity settings  
Custom  
settings  
All Custom Settings except Reset custom settings  
Clean image sensor  
Flicker reduction  
Time zone and date (excepting date and time)  
Language  
Auto image rotation  
Image comment  
Copyright information  
Non-CPU lens data  
HDMI  
Setup  
Location data  
Wi-Fi  
Eye-Fi upload  
All My Menu items  
All recent settings  
Choose tab  
My Menu/  
Recent Settings  
Settings saved using this model of camera can be restored by  
selecting Load settings. Note that Save/load settings is only  
available when a memory card is inserted in the camera, and  
that the Load settings option is only available if the card  
contains saved settings.  
387  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ASaved Settings  
Settings are saved in a file named NCSETUPG. The camera will not be  
able to load settings if the file name is changed.  
Virtual Horizon  
G button B setup menu  
Display roll and pitch information based on information from  
the camera tilt sensor. If the camera is tilted neither left nor  
right, the roll reference line will turn green, while if the camera is  
tilted neither forward nor back, the dot in the center of the  
display will turn green. Each division is equivalent to about 5°.  
Camera level  
Camera tilted left or  
right  
Camera tilted forward  
or back  
DTilting the Camera  
The virtual horizon display is not accurate when the camera is tilted at  
a sharp angle forward or back. If the camera is unable to measure tilt,  
the amount of tilt will not be displayed.  
ASee Also  
For information on viewing a roll indicator in the viewfinder, see  
Custom Setting f2 (Assign Fn button > Press; 0356, 359). For  
information on displaying a virtual horizon in live view, see pages 64  
and 75.  
388  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
AF Fine-tune  
G button B setup menu  
Fine-tune focus for up to 12 lens types. AF tuning is not  
recommended in most situations and may interfere with normal  
focus; use only when required.  
Option  
Description  
AF fine-tune On: Turn AF tuning on.  
(On/Off)  
Off: Turn AF tuning off.  
Tune AF for the current  
lens (CPU lenses only).  
Press 1or 3to  
Move focal  
point away  
from camera.  
Current  
value  
choose a value  
between +20 and –20.  
Values for up to 12 lens  
types can be stored.  
Only one value can be  
stored for each type of  
lens.  
Saved value  
Choose the AF tuning  
value used when no  
previously saved value  
exists for the current  
lens (CPU lenses only).  
Move focal  
point toward  
camera.  
Previous  
value  
Default  
389  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Option  
Description  
List previously saved AF tuning values. To delete a lens  
from the list, highlight the desired lens and press O(Q).  
To change a lens identifier (for example, to choose an  
identifier that is the same as the last two digits of the  
lens serial number to distinguish it from other lenses of  
the same type in light of the fact that Saved value can  
be used with only one lens of each type), highlight the  
desired lens and press 2.  
List saved values  
The menu shown at right will  
be displayed; press 1or 3to  
choose an identifier and  
press J to save changes and  
exit.  
DAF Tuning  
The camera may be unable to focus at minimum range or at infinity  
when AF tuning is applied.  
DLive View  
Tuning is not applied to autofocus during in live view (054).  
ASaved Value  
Only one value can be stored for each type of lens. If a teleconverter is  
used, separate values can be stored for each combination of lens and  
teleconverter.  
390  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Eye-Fi Upload  
G button B setup menu  
This option is displayed only when an Eye-Fi memory card  
(available separately from third-party suppliers) is inserted in the  
camera. Choose Enable to upload photographs to a preselected  
destination. Note that pictures will not be uploaded if signal  
strength is insufficient.  
Observe all local laws concerning wireless devices and choose  
Disable where wireless devices are prohibited.  
DEye-Fi Cards  
Eye-Fi cards may emit wireless signals when Disable is selected. If a  
warning is displayed in the monitor (0473), turn the camera off and  
remove the card.  
Set Custom Setting c2 (Standby timer, 0336) to 30 s or more when  
using an Eye-Fi card.  
See the manual provided with the Eye-Fi card, and direct any inquiries  
to the manufacturer. The camera can be used to turn Eye-Fi cards on  
and off, but may not support other Eye-Fi functions.  
391  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
When an Eye-Fi card is inserted, its  
status is indicated by an icon in the  
information display:  
d: Eye-Fi upload disabled.  
e: Eye-Fi upload enabled but no  
pictures available for upload.  
f (static): Eye-Fi upload enabled;  
waiting to begin upload.  
f (animated): Eye-Fi upload enabled; uploading data.  
g: Error — camera can not control Eye-Fi card. If a flashing  
W appears in the control panel or viewfinder, refer to  
page 473; if this indicator is not flashing, pictures can be taken  
normally but you may be unable to change Eye-Fi settings.  
ASupported Eye-Fi Cards  
Some cards may not be available in some countries or regions; consult  
the manufacturer for more information. Eye-Fi cards are for use only in  
the country of purchase. Be sure the Eye-Fi card firmware has been  
updated to the latest version. Note that using Eye-Fi cards in both slots  
is not recommended, as it may result in an unreliable network  
connection.  
Conformity Marking  
G button B setup menu  
View the standards with which the camera complies.  
Firmware Version  
G button B setup menu  
View the current camera firmware version.  
392  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies  
To display the retouch menu, press G and select the N  
(retouch menu) tab.  
G button  
Retouch Menu Options  
The options in the retouch menu are used to create trimmed or  
retouched copies of existing pictures. The retouch menu is only  
displayed when a memory card containing photographs is  
inserted in the camera.  
Option  
D-Lighting  
0
Option  
Straighten  
0
i
j
k
e
(
)
Red-eye correction  
Trim  
Distortion control  
Fisheye  
Monochrome  
Filter effects  
Color balance  
Image overlay 1  
NEF (RAW) processing  
Resize  
Color outline  
Color sketch  
l
f
g
h
m
Perspective control  
Miniature effect  
Selective color  
Edit movie  
n
o
7
8
i
u
9
Quick retouch  
Side-by-side comparison 2 419  
&
p
1
2
Can only be selected by pressing G and selecting N tab.  
Available only if retouch menu is displayed by pressing P and selecting Retouch in full-  
frame playback when a retouched image or original is displayed.  
393  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
DRetouching Copies  
Most options can be applied to copies created using other retouch  
options, although with the exceptions of Image overlay and Edit  
movie > Choose start/end point each option can be applied only  
once (note that multiple edits may result in loss of detail). Options that  
can not be applied to the current image can not be selected.  
AImage Quality  
Except in the case of copies created with Trim, Image overlay, NEF  
(RAW) processing, and Resize, copies created from JPEG images are  
the same size and quality as the original, while copies created from NEF  
(RAW) photos are saved as large fine-quality JPEG images. Size-priority  
compression is used when copies are saved in JPEG format.  
394  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Creating Retouched Copies  
To create a retouched copy:  
1
Select an item in the retouch menu.  
Press 1or 3to highlight an item, 2  
to select.  
2
Select a picture.  
Highlight a picture and press J. To  
view the highlighted picture full  
screen, press and hold the X (T)  
button.  
ARetouch  
In the case of images recorded at image quality settings of NEF +  
JPEG, only the NEF (RAW) image will be retouched. The camera  
may not be able to display or retouch images created with other  
devices.  
3
Select retouch options.  
For more information, see the section for the selected item.  
To exit without creating a retouched copy, press G.  
AMonitor off Delay  
The monitor will turn off and the operation will be cancelled if no  
actions are performed for a brief period. Any unsaved changes will  
be lost. To increase the time the monitor remains on, choose a  
longer menu display time for Custom Setting c4 (Monitor off  
delay; 0337).  
395  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
4
Create a retouched copy.  
Press J to create a retouched copy.  
Retouched copies are indicated by a  
o icon.  
ACreating Retouched Copies During Playback  
To create a retouched copy of the picture currently displayed in full-  
frame playback (0245), press P, then highlight Retouch and press J  
and select a retouch option.  
396  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
D-Lighting  
G button N retouch menu  
D-Lighting brightens shadows, making it ideal for dark or backlit  
photographs.  
Before  
After  
Press 4or 2to choose the amount of  
correction performed. The effect can be  
previewed in the edit display. Press J to  
save the retouched copy.  
397  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Red-Eye Correction  
G button N retouch menu  
This option is used to correct “red-eye” caused by the flash, and  
is available only with photographs taken using the flash. The  
photograph selected for red-eye correction can be previewed in  
the edit display. Confirm the effects of red-eye correction and  
create a copy as described in the following table. Note that  
red-eye correction may not always produce the expected results  
and may in very rare circumstances be applied to portions of the  
image that are not affected by red-eye; check the preview  
thoroughly before proceeding.  
To  
Use  
Description  
Press X (T) to zoom in, W (S) to zoom  
out. While photo is zoomed in, use multi  
selector to view areas of image not visible in  
monitor. Keep multi selector pressed to scroll  
rapidly to other areas of frame. Navigation  
window is displayed when zoom buttons or  
multi selector is pressed; area currently visible  
in monitor is indicated by yellow border.  
Press J to cancel zoom.  
If the camera detects red-eye in the selected  
photograph, a copy will be created that has  
been processed to reduce its effects. No copy  
will be created if the camera is unable to  
detect red-eye.  
Zoom in  
X (T)  
Zoom out  
W (S)  
View other  
areas of  
image  
Cancel zoom  
J
J
Create copy  
398  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Trim  
G button N retouch menu  
Create a cropped copy of the selected  
photograph. The selected photograph is  
displayed with the selected crop shown  
in yellow; create a cropped copy as  
described in the following table.  
To  
Use  
Description  
Press W (S) to reduce the size of the  
crop.  
Reduce size of crop  
W (S)  
Press X (T) to increase the size of  
the crop.  
Increase size of crop  
X (T)  
Change crop aspect  
ratio  
Rotate the main command dial to  
choose the aspect ratio.  
Use multi selector to position the crop.  
Press and hold to move the crop rapidly  
to the desired position.  
Position crop  
Create copy  
Save the current crop as a separate file.  
J
ATrim: Image Quality and Size  
Copies created from NEF (RAW) or NEF  
(RAW) + JPEG photos have an image quality  
(0115) of JPEG fine; cropped copies  
created from JPEG photos have the same  
image quality as the original. The size of the  
copy varies with crop size and aspect ratio  
and appears at upper left in the crop  
display.  
AViewing Cropped Copies  
Playback zoom may not be available when cropped copies are  
displayed.  
399  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Monochrome  
G button N retouch menu  
Copy photographs in Black-and-white,  
Sepia, or Cyanotype (blue and white  
monochrome).  
Selecting Sepia or Cyanotype displays a  
preview of the selected image; press 1  
to increase color saturation, 3to  
decrease. Press J to create a  
monochrome copy.  
Increase saturation  
Decrease saturation  
400  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Filter Effects  
G button N retouch menu  
Choose from the following filter effects. After adjusting filter  
effects as described below, press J to save the retouched copy.  
Option  
Description  
Creates the effect of a skylight  
filter, making the picture less  
Skylight blue. The effect can be  
previewed in the monitor as  
shown at right.  
Creates a copy with warm tone  
filter effects, giving the copy a  
“warm” red cast. The effect can  
Warm filter  
be previewed in the monitor.  
Red  
intensifier  
Intensify reds (Red intensifier),  
greens (Green intensifier), or  
Green  
blues (Blue intensifier). Press  
intensifier  
1to increase the effect, 3to  
decrease.  
Blue  
intensifier  
Add starburst effects to light  
sources.  
Number of points: Choose from  
four, six, or eight.  
Filter amount: Choose the  
brightness of the light sources  
affected.  
Cross screen  
Filter angle: Choose the angle of the points.  
Length of points: Choose the length of points.  
Confirm: Preview the effects of the filter. Press X (T) to  
preview the copy full frame.  
Save: Create a retouched copy.  
401  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Option  
Soft  
Description  
Add a soft filter effect. Press 4  
or 2to choose the filter  
strength.  
Color Balance  
G button N retouch menu  
Use the multi selector to create a copy  
with modified color balance as shown  
below. The effect is displayed in the  
monitor together with red, green, and  
blue histograms (0250) giving the  
distribution of tones in the copy.  
Increase amount of green  
Create retouched copy  
Increase amount of blue  
Increase amount of amber  
Increase amount of magenta  
AZoom  
To zoom in on the image displayed in the  
monitor, press X (T). The histogram will  
be updated to show data only for the portion  
of the image displayed in the monitor. While  
the image is zoomed in, press L (U) to  
toggle back and forth between color balance  
and zoom. When zoom is selected, you can  
zoom in and out with the X (T) and W (S) and scroll the image  
with the multi selector.  
402  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Image Overlay  
G button N retouch menu  
Image overlay combines two existing NEF (RAW) photographs to  
create a single picture that is saved separately from the originals;  
the results, which make use of RAW data from the camera image  
sensor, are noticeably better than overlays created in an imaging  
application. The new picture is saved at current image quality  
and size settings; before creating an overlay, set image quality  
and size (0115, 118; all options are available). To create a NEF  
(RAW) copy, choose an image quality of NEF (RAW).  
+
1
Select Image overlay.  
Highlight Image overlay in the  
retouch menu and press 2. The  
dialog shown at right will be  
displayed, with Image 1 highlighted;  
press J to display a picture selection  
dialog listing only NEF (RAW) images  
created with this camera.  
403  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
2
Select the first image.  
Use the multi selector to highlight the  
first photograph in the overlay. To  
view the highlighted photograph full  
frame, press and hold the X (T)  
button. Press J to select the  
highlighted photograph and return to  
the preview display.  
3
4
Select the second image.  
The selected image will appear as Image 1. Highlight  
Image 2 and press J, then select the second photo as  
described in Step 2.  
Adjust gain.  
Highlight Image 1 or Image 2 and  
optimize exposure for the overlay by  
pressing 1or 3to select gain from  
values between 0.1 and 2.0. Repeat  
for the second image. The default  
value is 1.0; select 0.5 to halve gain or  
2.0 to double it. The effects are visible in the Preview  
column.  
404  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5
6
Preview the overlay.  
Press 4or 2to place the cursor in the  
Preview column and press 1or 3to  
highlight Overlay. Press J to preview  
the overlay as shown at right (to save  
the overlay without displaying a  
preview, select Save). To return to  
Step 4 and select new photos or adjust gain, press W (S).  
Save the overlay.  
Press J while the preview is  
displayed to save the overlay. After an  
overlay is created, the resulting image  
will be displayed full-frame in the  
monitor.  
DImage Overlay  
Only NEF (RAW) photographs with the same image area and bit depth  
can be combined.  
The overlay has the same photo info (including date of recording,  
metering, shutter speed, aperture, shooting mode, exposure  
compensation, focal length, and image orientation), and values for  
white balance and Picture Control as the photograph selected for  
Image 1. The current image comment is appended to the overlay  
when it is saved; copyright information, however, is not copied.  
Overlays saved in NEF (RAW) format use the compression selected for  
Type in the NEF (RAW) recording menu and have the same bit depth  
as the original images; JPEG overlays are saved using size-priority  
compression.  
405  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
NEF (RAW) Processing  
Create JPEG copies of NEF (RAW) photographs.  
G button N retouch menu  
1
Select NEF (RAW) processing.  
Highlight NEF (RAW) processing in  
the retouch menu and press 2to  
display a picture selection dialog  
listing only NEF (RAW) images created  
with this camera.  
2
Select a photograph.  
Use the multi selector to highlight a  
photograph (to view the highlighted  
photograph full frame, press and hold  
the X/Tbutton). Press J to select  
the highlighted photograph and  
proceed to the next step.  
406  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
3
Choose settings for the JPEG copy.  
Adjust the settings listed below. Note that white balance and  
vignette control are not available with multiple exposures or  
pictures created with image overlay and that exposure  
compensation can only be set to values between –2 and  
+2 EV.  
Image quality (0115)  
Image size (0118)  
White balance (0145)  
Exposure compensation (0143)  
Set Picture Control (0165)  
High ISO NR (0317)  
Color space (0314)  
Vignette control (0315)  
D-Lighting (0397)  
4
Copy the photograph.  
Highlight EXE and press J to create a  
JPEG copy of the selected photograph  
(to exit without copying the  
photograph, press the G button).  
407  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Resize  
Create small copies of selected photographs.  
G button N retouch menu  
1
Select Resize.  
To resize selected images, highlight  
Resize in the retouch menu and press  
2.  
2
Choose a destination.  
If two memory cards are inserted, you  
can choose a destination for the  
resized copies by highlighting  
Choose destination and pressing 2  
(if only one card is inserted, proceed  
to Step 3).  
The menu shown at right will be  
displayed; highlight a card slot and  
press J.  
408  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
3
4
Choose a size.  
Highlight Choose size and press 2.  
The options shown at right will be  
displayed; highlight an option and  
press J.  
Choose pictures.  
Highlight Select image and press 2.  
Highlight pictures using the multi  
selector and press the W (S) button  
to select or deselect (to view the  
highlighted picture full screen, press  
and hold the X/T button).  
Selected pictures are marked by a 8  
icon. Press J when the selection is  
complete.  
W (S) button  
409  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5
Save the resized copies.  
A confirmation dialog will be  
displayed. Highlight Yes and press J  
to save the resized copies.  
AViewing Resized Copies  
Playback zoom may not be available when resized copies are  
displayed.  
AImage Quality  
Copies created from NEF (RAW) or NEF (RAW) + JPEG photos have an  
image quality (0115) of JPEG fine; copies created from JPEG photos  
have the same image quality as the original.  
410  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Quick Retouch  
G button N retouch menu  
Create copies with enhanced saturation  
and contrast. D-Lighting is applied as  
required to brighten dark or backlit  
subjects.  
Press 4or 2to choose the amount of  
enhancement. The effect can be  
previewed in the edit display. Press J to save the retouched  
copy.  
Straighten  
G button N retouch menu  
Create a straightened copy of the  
selected image. Press 2to rotate the  
image clockwise by up to five degrees in  
increments of approximately 0.25  
degrees, 4to rotate it counterclockwise  
(the effect can be previewed in the edit  
display; note that edges of the image will  
be trimmed to create a square copy). Press J to save the  
retouched copy.  
411  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Distortion Control  
G button N retouch menu  
Create copies with reduced peripheral  
distortion. Select Auto to let the camera  
correct distortion automatically and then  
make fine adjustments using the multi  
selector, or select Manual to reduce  
distortion manually (note that Auto is  
not available with photos taken using  
auto distortion control; see page 316). Press 2to reduce barrel  
distortion, 4to reduce pin-cushion distortion (the effect can be  
previewed in the edit display; note that greater amounts of  
distortion control result in more of the edges being cropped  
out). Press J to save the retouched copy. Note that distortion  
control may heavily crop or distort the edges of copies created  
from photographs taken with DX lenses at image areas other  
than DX (24×16).  
AAuto  
Auto is for use only with pictures taken with type G, E, and D lenses  
(PC, fisheye, and certain other lenses excluded). Results are not  
guaranteed with other lenses.  
412  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Fisheye  
G button N retouch menu  
Create copies that appear to have been  
taken with a fisheye lens. Press 2to  
increase the effect (this also increases the  
amount of that will be cropped out at the  
edges of the image), 4to reduce it. The  
effect can be previewed in the edit  
display. Press J to save the retouched  
copy.  
Color Outline  
G button N retouch menu  
Create an outline copy of a photograph  
to use as a base for painting. The effect  
can be previewed in the edit display.  
Press J to save the retouched copy.  
Before  
After  
413  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Color Sketch  
G button N retouch menu  
Create a copy of a photograph that  
resembles a sketch made with colored  
pencils. Press 1or 3to highlight  
Vividness or Outlines and press 4or 2  
to change. Vividness can be increased to  
make colors more saturated, or  
decreased for a washed-out,  
monochromatic effect, while outlines can be made thicker or  
thinner. Thicker outlines makes colors more saturated. The  
results can be previewed in the edit display. Press J to save the  
retouched copy.  
414  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Perspective Control  
G button N retouch menu  
Create copies that reduce the effects of  
perspective taken from the base of a tall  
object. Use the multi selector to adjust  
perspective (note that greater amounts  
of perspective control result in more of  
the edges being cropped out). The  
results can be previewed in the edit  
display. Press J to save the retouched copy.  
Before  
After  
415  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Miniature Effect  
G button N retouch menu  
Create a copy that appears to be a photo of a diorama. Works  
best with photos taken from a high vantage point. The area that  
will be in focus in the copy is indicated by a yellow frame.  
To  
Choose  
orientation  
Press  
Description  
Press W (S) to choose orientation of area  
that is in focus.  
W (S)  
If area of effect is in  
wide orientation,  
press 1or 3to  
position frame  
showing area of  
copy that will be in  
focus.  
Choose  
position  
Area in focus  
If area of effect is in  
tall orientation,  
press 4or 2to  
position frame  
showing area of  
copy that will be in  
focus.  
If area of effect is in wide orientation, press 4  
or 2to choose height.  
Choose size  
If area of effect is in tall orientation, press 1or  
3to choose width.  
Preview copy  
Create copy  
Preview copy.  
Create copy.  
(T)  
J
X
416  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Selective Color  
Create a copy in which only selected hues appear in color.  
G button N retouch menu  
1
Select Selective color.  
Highlight Selective color in the  
retouch menu and press 2to display  
a picture selection dialog.  
2
Select a photograph.  
Use the multi selector to highlight a  
photograph (to view the highlighted  
photograph full frame, press and hold  
the X/Tbutton). Press Jto select  
the highlighted photograph and  
proceed to the next step.  
3
Select a color.  
A AE-L/AF-L button  
Use the multi selector to position the  
cursor over an object and press the  
A AE-L/AF-L button to select the color  
of the object as one that will remain in  
the final copy (the camera may have  
difficulty detecting unsaturated  
colors; choose a saturated color). To  
zoom in on the picture for precise  
color selection, press X (T). Press  
W (S) to zoom out.  
Selected color  
417  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4
5
Highlight the color range.  
Rotate the main command  
dial to highlight the color  
range for the selected  
color.  
Color range  
Choose the color range.  
Press 1or 3to increase or decrease  
the range of similar hues that will be  
included in the final photograph.  
Choose from values between 1 and 7;  
note that higher values may include  
hues from other colors. The effect can  
be previewed in the edit display.  
6
Select additional colors.  
To select additional colors,  
rotate the main command  
dial to highlight another of  
the three color boxes at the  
top of the display and  
repeat Steps 3–5 to select  
another color. Repeat for a third color if desired. To deselect  
the highlighted color, press O (Q); to remove all colors, press  
and hold O (Q). A confirmation dialog will be displayed;  
select Yes.  
418  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7
Save the edited copy.  
Press J to save the retouched copy.  
Side-by-side Comparison  
Compare retouched copies to the original photographs. This  
option is only available if the retouch menu is displayed by  
pressing the P button and selecting Retouch when a copy or  
original is played back full frame.  
1
Select a picture.  
Select a retouched copy (shown by a  
o icon) or a photograph that has  
been retouched in full-frame  
playback. Press P, then highlight  
Retouch and press J.  
P button  
419  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
2
3
Select Side-by-side comparison.  
Highlight Side-by-side comparison  
and press J.  
Compare the copy with the original.  
The source image is displayed on the  
left, the retouched copy on the right,  
with the options used to create the  
copy listed at the top of the display.  
Press 4or 2to switch between the  
sourceimage andtheretouchedcopy.  
To view the highlighted picture full  
frame, press and hold the X (T)  
button. If the copy was created from  
two source images using Image  
Options used to create  
copy  
Source  
image  
Retouched  
copy  
overlay, or if the source has been copied multiple times,  
press 1or 3to view the other source images or copies. To  
exit to playback mode, press the K button, or press J to exit  
to playback with the highlighted image selected.  
DSide-by-side Comparisons  
The source image will not be displayed if the copy was created from a  
photograph that was protected (0257), has since been deleted or  
hidden (0301), or is on a card in a different slot from that used when  
the image was created.  
420  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
O My Menu/m Recent Settings  
To display My Menu, press G and select the O (My Menu) tab.  
G button  
The MY MENU option can be used to create and edit a  
customized list of options from the playback, photo shooting,  
movie shooting, Custom Settings, setup, and retouch menus for  
quick access (up to 20 items). If desired, recent settings can be  
displayed in place of My Menu (0425).  
Options can be added, deleted, and reordered as described  
below.  
❚❚ Adding Options to My Menu  
1
2
Select Add items.  
In My Menu (O), highlight Add items  
and press 2.  
Select a menu.  
Highlight the name of the menu  
containing the option you wish to add  
and press 2.  
421  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
3
4
5
Select an item.  
Highlight the desired menu item and  
press J.  
Position the new item.  
Press 1or 3to move the new item up  
or down in My Menu. Press J to add  
the new item.  
Add more items.  
The items currently displayed in My  
Menu are indicated by a check mark.  
Items indicated by a V icon can not be  
selected. Repeat steps 1–4 to select  
additional items.  
422  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
❚❚ Deleting Options from My Menu  
1
2
Select Remove items.  
In My Menu (O), highlight Remove items and press 2.  
Select items.  
Highlight items and press 2to select  
or deselect. Selected items are  
indicated by a check mark.  
3
Delete the selected items.  
Press J. A confirmation dialog will be  
displayed; press J again to delete the  
selected items.  
ADeleting Items in My Menu  
To delete the item currently highlighted in My Menu, press the O (Q)  
button. A confirmation dialog will be displayed; press O (Q) again to  
remove the selected item from My Menu.  
423  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
❚❚ Reordering Options in My Menu  
1
2
Select Rank items.  
In My Menu (O), highlight Rank items and press 2.  
Select an item.  
Highlight the item you wish to move  
and press J.  
3
4
Position the item.  
Press 1or 3to move the item up or  
down in My Menu and press J.  
Repeat Steps 2–3 to reposition  
additional items.  
Exit to My Menu.  
Press the G button to return to My  
Menu.  
G button  
424  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Recent Settings  
To display the twenty most recently used settings, select  
m RECENT SETTINGS for O MY MENU > Choose tab.  
1
2
Select Choose tab.  
In My Menu (O), highlight Choose  
tab and press 2.  
Select m RECENT SETTINGS.  
Highlight m RECENT SETTINGS and  
press J. The name of the menu will  
change from “MY MENU” to “RECENT  
SETTINGS.”  
Menu items will be added to the top of the recent settings menu  
as they are used. To view My Menu again, select O MY MENU for  
m RECENT SETTINGS > Choose tab.  
ARemoving Items from the Recent Settings Menu  
To remove an item from the recent settings menu, highlight it and  
press the O (Q) button. A confirmation dialog will be displayed; press  
O (Q) again to delete the selected item.  
425  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Technical Notes  
Read this chapter for information on compatible accessories,  
cleaning and storing the camera, and what to do if an error  
message is displayed or you encounter problems using the  
camera.  
Compatible Lenses  
Camera setting  
Shooting  
mode  
Focus mode  
Metering system  
M (with  
electronic  
rangefinder)1  
L2  
P
S
A
M
M3  
AF  
45  
N4  
3D Color  
Lens/accessory  
Type G, E, or D AF  
NIKKOR 7  
8
AF-S, AF-I NIKKOR  
PC-E NIKKOR series9  
PC Micro 85mm  
f/2.8D 11  
10  
10  
10  
10  
8,10  
10  
12  
8,10  
AF-S / AF-I  
8
Teleconverter 13  
Other AF NIKKOR  
(except lenses for  
F3AF)  
14  
14  
8
8
15  
AI-P NIKKOR  
426  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Camera setting  
Shooting  
mode  
Focus mode  
Metering system  
M (with  
electronic  
rangefinder)1  
L2  
P
S
A
M
M3  
AF  
45  
N4  
3D Color  
Lens/accessory  
AI-, AI-modified  
NIKKOR or Nikon  
Series E lenses 17  
Medical-NIKKOR  
120mm f/4  
Reflex-NIKKOR  
PC-NIKKOR  
15  
18  
19  
20  
21  
18  
22  
20  
10  
AI-type  
24  
18  
26  
19  
20  
Teleconverter 23  
PB-6 Bellows  
Focusing  
24  
Attachment 25  
Autoextensionrings  
(PK-series 11A, 12,  
or 13; PN-11)  
24  
18  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Manual focus available with all lenses.  
Matrix.  
Center-weighted.  
Spot.  
Highlight-weighted.  
IX-NIKKOR lenses can not be used.  
Vibration Reduction (VR) supported with VR lenses.  
Spot metering meters selected focus point (0139).  
The tilt knob for the PC-E NIKKOR 24mm f/3.5D ED may contact the camera body when the  
lens is revolved. This can be prevented by installing a smaller tilt knob; contact a Nikon-  
authorized service representative for more information.  
10 Can not be used with shifting or tilting.  
11 The camera’s exposure metering and flash control systems do not work properly when  
shifting and/or tilting the lens, or when an aperture other than the maximum aperture is  
used.  
427  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
12 Manual shooting mode only.  
13 Can be used with AF-S and AF-I lenses only (0430). For information on the focus points  
available for autofocus and electronic rangefinding, see page 430.  
14 When focusing at minimum focus distance with AF 80–200mm f/2.8, AF 35–70mm f/2.8, AF  
28–85mm f/3.5–4.5 <New>, or AF 28–85mm f/3.5–4.5 lens at maximum zoom, in-focus  
indicator may be displayed when image on matte screen in viewfinder is not in focus. Adjust  
focus manually until image in viewfinder is in focus.  
15 With maximum aperture of f/5.6 or faster.  
16 Some lenses can not be used (see page 431).  
17 Range of rotation for AI 80–200mm f/2.8 ED tripod mount is limited by camera body. Filters  
can not be exchanged while AI 200–400mm f/4 ED is mounted on camera.  
18 If maximum aperture is specified using Non-CPU lens data (0235), aperture value  
will be displayed in viewfinder and control panel.  
19 Can be used only if lens focal length and maximum aperture are specified using Non-CPU  
lens data (0235). Use spot or center-weighted metering if desired results are not  
achieved.  
20 For improved precision, specify lens focal length and maximum aperture using Non-CPU  
lens data (0235).  
21 Can be used in manual mode M at shutter speeds slower than flash sync speed by one step or  
more.  
22 Exposure determined by presetting lens aperture. In mode A, preset aperture using lens  
aperture ring before performing AE lock and shifting lens. In mode M, preset aperture using  
lens aperture ring and determine exposure before shifting lens.  
23 Exposure compensation required when used with AI 28–85mm f/3.5–4.5, AI 35–105mm  
f/3.5–4.5, AI 35–135mm f/3.5–4.5, or AF-S 80–200mm f/2.8D.  
24 With maximum effective aperture of f/5.6 or faster.  
25 Requires PK-12 or PK-13 auto extension ring. PB-6D may be required depending on camera  
orientation.  
26 Use preset aperture. In mode A, set aperture using focusing attachment before determining  
exposure and taking photograph.  
PF-4 Reprocopy Outfit requires PA-4 Camera Holder.  
With some lenses, noise in the form of lines may appear during autofocus at high ISO  
sensitivities. Use manual focus or focus lock.  
428  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ARecognizing CPU and Type G, E, and D Lenses  
CPU lenses (particularly types G, E, and D) are recommended, but note  
that IX-NIKKOR lenses can not be used. CPU lenses can be identified by  
the presence of CPU contacts, type G, E, and D lenses by a letter on the  
lens barrel. Type G and E lenses are not equipped with a lens aperture  
ring.  
CPU contacts  
Aperture ring  
CPU lens  
Type G/E lens  
Type D lens  
429  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
AAF-S/AF-I Teleconverters  
The table below shows the focus points available for autofocus and  
electronic rangefinding when an AF-S/AF-I teleconverter is attached.  
Note that the camera may be unable to focus on dark or low-contrast  
subjects if the combined aperture is slower than f/5.6. Autofocus is not  
available when teleconverters are used with the AF-S VR Micro-Nikkor  
105mm f/2.8G IF-ED.  
Accessory  
Maximum aperture of lens  
Focus points  
f/4 or faster  
TC-14E, TC-14E II,  
TC-14E III  
1
1
f/5.6  
f/2.8 or faster  
TC-17E II  
f/4  
2
f/5.6  
f/2.8 or faster  
TC-20E, TC-20E II,  
TC-20E III  
3
f/4  
2
f/5.6  
f/5.6  
1
TC-800-1.25E ED  
1
Single-point AF is used when 3D-tracking or auto-area AF is selected forAF-area mode  
2
3
Autofocus not available.  
Focus data for focus points other than the center focus point are obtained from line sensors.  
430  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ALens f-number  
The f-number given in lens names is the maximum aperture of the  
lens.  
ACompatible Non-CPU Lenses  
Non-CPU lens data (0235) can be used to enable many of the  
features available with CPU lenses, including color matrix metering; if  
no data are provided, center-weighted metering will be used in place  
of color matrix metering, while if the maximum aperture is not  
provided, the camera aperture display will show the number of stops  
from maximum aperture and the actual aperture value must be read  
off the lens aperture ring.  
DIncompatible Accessories and Non-CPU Lenses  
The following can NOT be used with the D750:  
TC-16A AF teleconverter  
AF lenses for the F3AF (AF 80mm f/2.8, AF  
Non-AI lenses  
200mm f/3.5 ED, AF Teleconverter TC-16)  
Lenses that require the AU-1 focusing unit PC 28mm f/4 (serial number 180900 or  
(400mm f/4.5, 600mm f/5.6, 800mm f/8,  
1200mm f/11)  
Fisheye (6mm f/5.6, 7.5mm f/5.6, 8mm f/8,  
OP 10mm f/5.6)  
2.1cm f/4  
Extension Ring K2  
180–600mm f/8 ED (serial numbers  
174041–174180)  
360–1200mm f/11 ED (serial numbers  
174031–174127)  
earlier)  
PC 35mm f/2.8 (serial numbers 851001–  
906200)  
PC 35mm f/3.5 (old type)  
Reflex 1000mm f/6.3 (old type)  
Reflex 1000mm f/11 (serial numbers  
142361–143000)  
Reflex 2000mm f/11 (serial numbers  
200111–200310)  
200–600mm f/9.5 (serial numbers  
280001–300490)  
DRed-Eye Reduction  
Lenses that block the subject’s view of the red-eye reduction lamp may  
interfere with red-eye reduction.  
431  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ACalculating Angle of View  
The D750 can be used with Nikon lenses for 35mm (135) format  
cameras. If Auto DX crop is on (0111) and a 35mm format lens is  
attached, the angle of view will be the same as a frame of 35mm film  
(35.9 × 24.0 mm); if a DX lens is attached, the angle of view will  
automatically be adjusted to 23.5 × 15.7 mm (DX format).  
To choose an angle of view different from that of the current lens, turn  
Auto DX crop off and select from FX (36×24), 1.2× (30×20), and DX  
(24×16). If a 35mm format lens is attached, the angle of view could be  
reduced by 1.5 × by selecting DX (24×16) or by 1.2 × by selecting 1.2×  
(30×20) to expose a smaller area.  
FX (36×24) picture size (35.9 × 24.0 mm,  
equivalent to 35mm format)  
1.2× (30×20) picture size  
(29.9 × 19.9 mm)  
DX (24×16) picture size (23.5 × 15.7 mm,  
Lens  
equivalent to DX format camera)  
Picture diagonal  
Angle of view (FX (36×24); 35mm format)  
Angle of view (1.2× (30×20))  
Angle of view (DX (24×16); DX format)  
The DX (24×16) angle of view is about 1.5 times smaller than the  
35mm format angle of view, while the 1.2× (30×20) angle of view is  
about 1.2 times smaller. To calculate the focal length of lenses in  
35mm format when DX (24×16) is selected, multiply the focal length  
of the lens by about 1.5 or by about 1.2 when 1.2× (30×20) is selected  
(for example, the effective focal length of a 50mm lens in 35mm format  
would be 75 mm when DX (24×16) is selected or 60 mm when 1.2×  
(30×20) is selected).  
432  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Optional Flash Units (Speedlights)  
The camera supports the Nikon Creative Lighting System (CLS)  
and can be used with CLS-compatible flash units. The built-in  
flash will not fire when an optional flash unit is attached.  
The Nikon Creative Lighting System (CLS)  
Nikon’s advanced Creative Lighting System (CLS) offers  
improved communication between the camera and compatible  
flash units for improved flash photography.  
❚❚ CLS-Compatible Flash Units  
The camera can be used with the following CLS-compatible flash  
units:  
The SB-910, SB-900, SB-800, SB-700, SB-600, SB-500, SB-400, SB-300, and  
SB-R200:  
Flash unit  
Feature  
Guide No. (ISO 100) 5 34/111 38/125 28/92 30/98 24/78 21/69 18/59 10/33  
1
If a color filter is attached to the SB-910, SB-900, or SB-700 when v or N (flash) is selected  
for white balance, the camera will automatically detect the filter and adjust white balance  
appropriately.  
2
3
4
Users of the LED light can set camera white balance to v or N for optimal results.  
Wireless flash control is not available.  
Controlled remotely with built-in flash in commander mode or using optional SB-910, SB-900,  
SB-800, SB-700, or SB-500 flash unit or SU-800 wireless Speedlight commander.  
m/ft, 20 °C (68 °F), SB-910, SB-900, SB-800, SB-700, and SB-600 at 35 mm zoom head position;  
SB-910, SB-900, and SB-700 with standard illumination.  
5
433  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
SU-800 Wireless Speedlight Commander: When mounted on a CLS-  
compatible camera, the SU-800 can be used as a commander  
for remote SB-910, SB-900, SB-800, SB-700, SB-600, SB-500, or  
SB-R200 flash units in up to three groups. The SU-800 itself is  
not equipped with a flash.  
AGuide Number  
To calculate the range of the flash at full power, divide the Guide  
Number by the aperture. If, for example, the flash unit has a Guide  
Number of 34 m or 111 ft (ISO 100, 20 °C/68 °F); its range at an aperture  
of f/5.6 is 34÷5.6 or about 6.1 meters (or in feet,  
111÷5.6=approximately 19 ft 10 in.). For each twofold increase in ISO  
sensitivity, multiply the Guide Number by the square root of two  
(approximately 1.4).  
AThe AS-15 Sync Terminal Adapter  
When the AS-15 sync terminal adapter (available separately) is  
mounted on the camera accessory shoe, flash accessories can be  
connected via a sync terminal.  
434  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The following features are available with CLS-compatible flash  
units:  
i-TTL balanced fill-flash for  
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
digital SLR 1  
i-TTL  
Standard i-TTL flash for  
digital SLR  
z2  
z2  
AA Auto aperture  
Non-TTL auto  
GN Distance-priority manual  
Manual  
RPT Repeating flash  
Remote flash control  
i-TTL i-TTL  
z3  
z3  
z
z
z
z
z
z6  
z
z
z
z
z
z6  
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z4  
z
A
M
z4 z4  
z
z
z
z4  
z4  
[A:B] Quick wireless flash control  
AA Auto aperture  
z5  
A
M
Non-TTL auto  
Manual  
z4  
RPT Repeating flash  
i-TTL i-TTL  
[A:B] Quick wireless flash control  
AA Auto aperture  
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
A
M
Non-TTL auto  
Manual  
RPT Repeating flash  
435  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Color Information Communication (flash)  
Color Information Communication (LED light)  
Auto FP High-Speed Sync 7  
FV lock 8  
AF-assist for multi-area AF  
Red-eye reduction  
Camera modeling illumination  
Camera flash mode selection  
Camera flash unit firmware update  
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z9  
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z10  
1
2
3
Not available with spot metering.  
Can also be selected with flash unit.  
AA/A mode selection performed on flash unit using custom settings. Unless lens data have  
been provided using the Non-CPU lens data option in the setup menu, “A” will be  
selected when a non-CPU lens is used.  
4
5
6
Can only be selected with camera.  
Available only during close-up photography.  
Unless lens data have been provided using the Non-CPU lens data option in the setup  
menu, non-TTL auto (A) is used with non-CPU lenses, regardless of mode selected with flash  
unit.  
7
8
9
Available only in i-TTL, AA, A, GN, and M flash-control modes.  
Availalbe only in i-TTL, AA, and A flash-control modes.  
Available only in commander mode.  
10 Firmware updates for the SB-910 and SB-900 can be performed from the camera.  
436  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
❚❚ Other Flash Units  
The following flash units can be used in non-TTL auto and  
manual modes.  
Flash unit  
SB-80DX,  
SB-28DX,  
SB-28, SB-26,  
SB-25, SB-24 SB-50DX 1  
SB-30, SB-272, SB-23,  
SB-22S, SB-22, SB-293,  
SB-20, SB-16B, SB-21B 3,  
Flash mode  
A
M
SB-15  
SB-29S3  
Non-TTL auto  
Manual  
Repeating flash  
G
REAR Rear-curtain sync 4  
1
2
Select mode P, S, A, or M, lower built-in flash, and use optional flash unit only.  
Flash mode is automatically set to TTL and shutter-release is disabled. Set flash unit to A (non-  
TTL auto flash).  
3
4
Autofocus is available with AF-S VR Micro-Nikkor 105mm f/2.8G IF-ED and AF-S Micro NIKKOR  
60mm f/2.8G ED lenses only.  
Available when camera is used to select flash mode.  
437  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DNotes on Optional Flash Units  
Refer to the flash unit manual for detailed instructions. If the flash unit  
supports CLS, refer to the section on CLS-compatible digital SLR  
cameras. The D750 is not included in the “digital SLR” category in the  
SB-80DX, SB-28DX, and SB-50DX manuals.  
If an optional flash unit is attached in shooting modes other than j, %,  
and u, the flash will fire with every shot, even in modes in which the  
built-in flash can not be used.  
i-TTL flash control can be used at ISO sensitivities between 100 and  
12800. At values under 100 or over 12800, the desired results may not  
be achieved at some ranges or aperture settings. If the flash-ready  
indicator flashes for about three seconds after a photograph is taken in  
i-TTL or non-TTL auto mode, the flash has fired at full power and the  
photograph may be underexposed (CLS-compatible flash units only;  
for information on the exposure and flash charge indicators on other  
units, see the manual provided with the flash).  
When an SC-series 17, 28, or 29 sync cable is used for off-camera flash  
photography, correct exposure may not be achieved in i-TTL mode.  
We recommend that you select standard i-TTL flash control. Take a test  
shot and view the results in the monitor.  
In i-TTL, use the flash panel or bounce adapter provided with the flash  
unit. Do not use other panels such as diffusion panels, as this may  
produce incorrect exposure.  
438  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
The SB-910, SB-900, SB-800, SB-700, SB-600, SB-500, and SB-400  
provide red-eye reduction, while the SB-910, SB-900, SB-800, SB-700,  
SB-600, and SU-800 provide AF-assist illumination with the following  
restrictions:  
SB-910 and SB-900: AF-assist illumination is  
available with 17–135 mm AF lenses,  
17–19 mm  
however, autofocus is available only with  
the focus points shown at right.  
20–105 mm  
106–135 mm  
SB-800, SB-600, and SU-800: AF-assist  
illumination is available with 24–105 mm  
24–34 mm  
AF lenses, however, autofocus is available  
only with the focus points shown at right.  
35–49 mm  
50–105 mm  
SB-700: AF-assist illumination is available  
with 24–135 mm AF lenses, however,  
24–27 mm  
autofocus is available only with the focus  
points shown at right.  
28–135 mm  
Depending on the lens used and scene recorded, the in-focus indicator  
(I) may be displayed when the subject is not in focus, or the camera  
may be unable to focus and the shutter release will be disabled.  
In mode P, the maximum aperture (minimum f-number) is limited  
according to ISO sensitivity, as shown below:  
Maximum aperture at ISO equivalent of:  
100  
200  
400  
800  
1600  
3200  
6400  
12800  
4
4.8  
5.6  
6.7  
8
9.5  
11  
13  
If the maximum aperture of the lens is smaller than given above, the  
maximum value for aperture will be the maximum aperture of the lens.  
439  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
AFlash Control Mode  
The information display shows the flash control mode for optional  
flash units attached to the camera accessory shoe as follows:  
Flash sync  
Auto FP (0345)  
i-TTL  
Auto aperture (AA)  
Non-TTL auto flash (A)  
Distance-priority  
manual (GN)  
Manual  
Repeating flash  
Advanced wireless  
lighting  
DUse Only Nikon Flash Accessories  
Use only Nikon flash units. Negative voltages or voltages over 250 V  
applied to the accessory shoe could not only prevent normal  
operation, but damage the sync circuitry of the camera or flash. Before  
using a Nikon flash unit not listed in this section, contact a Nikon-  
authorized service representative for more information.  
440  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Other Accessories  
At the time of writing, the following accessories were available  
for the D750.  
Rechargeable Li-ion Battery EN-EL15 (025, 26): Additional  
EN-EL15 batteries are available from local retailers and  
Nikon-authorized service representatives.  
Battery Charger MH-25a (025): The MH-25a can be used  
to recharge EN-EL15 batteries. MH-25 battery chargers  
can also be used.  
Multi-Power Battery Pack MB-D16: The MB-D16 is equipped  
with a shutter-release button, A AE/AF lock button,  
multi selector, and main- and sub-command dials for  
improved operation when taking photographs in  
Power sources  
portrait (tall) orientation. When attaching the MB-D16,  
remove the camera MB-D16 contact cover.  
Power Connector EP-5B, AC Adapter EH-5b: These accessories  
can be used to power the camera for extended periods  
(EH-5a and EH-5 AC adapters can also be used). The  
EP-5B is required to connect the camera to the EH-5b;  
see page 445 for details. Note that when the camera is  
used with an MB-D16, the EP-5B must be inserted into  
the MB-D16, not the camera. Do not attempt to use the  
camera with power connectors inserted into both the  
camera and MB-D16.  
441  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Filters intended for special-effects photography may  
interfere with autofocus or the electronic rangefinder.  
The D750 can not be used with linear polarizing filters.  
Use C-PL or C-PL II circular polarizing filters instead.  
Use NC filters to protect the lens.  
To prevent ghosting, use of a filter is not recommended  
when the subject is framed against a bright light, or  
when a bright light source is in the frame.  
Filters  
Center-weighted metering is recommended with  
filters with exposure factors (filter factors) over 1 ×  
(Y44, Y48, Y52, O56, R60, X0, X1, C-PL, ND2S, ND4,  
ND4S, ND8, ND8S, ND400, A2, A12, B2, B8, B12). See the  
filter manual for details.  
Communication Unit UT-1: Use a USB cable to connect the  
UT-1 to the camera and an Ethernet cable to connect  
the UT-1 to an Ethernet network. Once connected, you  
can upload photos and movies to a computer or ftp  
server, control the camera remotely using optional  
Camera Control Pro 2 software, or browse pictures or  
control the camera remotely from an iPhone or  
computer web browser.  
LAN adapters  
(0269)  
Wireless Transmitter WT-5: Attach the WT-5 to the UT-1 to  
access wireless networks.  
Note: Use of LAN adapters requires an Ethernet or wireless network and  
some basic network knowledge. Be sure to upgrade any related software to  
the latest version.  
HDMI Cable HC-E1: An HDMI cable with a type C connector  
for connection to the camera and a type A connector for  
connection to HDMI devices.  
HDMI cables  
(0277)  
Accessory shoe Accessory Shoe Cover BS-1: A cover protecting the accessory  
covers  
shoe. The accessory shoe is used for optional flash units.  
Body Cap BF-1B/Body Cap BF-1A: The body cap keeps the  
mirror, viewfinder screen, and low-pass filter free of dust  
when a lens is not in place.  
Body cap  
442  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
DK-20C Eyepiece Correction Lenses: Lenses are available with  
diopters of –5, –4, –3, –2, 0, +0.5, +1, +2, and +3 m–1  
when the camera diopter adjustment control is in the  
neutral position (–1 m–1). Use eyepiece correction  
lenses only if the desired focus can not be achieved  
with the built in diopter adjustment control (–3 to  
+1 m–1). Test eyepiece correction lenses before  
purchase to ensure that the desired focus can be  
achieved. The rubber eyecup can not be used with  
eyepiece correction lenses.  
Magnifying Eyepiece DK-21M: The DK-21M magnifies the  
view through the viewfinder by approximately 1.17 ×  
(50 mm f/1.4 lens at infinity; –1.0 m–1) for greater  
precision when framing.  
Viewfinder  
eyepiece  
accessories  
Magnifier DG-2: The DG-2 magnifies the scene displayed  
in the center of the viewfinder for greater precision  
during focusing. Eyepiece adapter required (available  
separately).  
Eyepiece Adapter DK-22: The DK-22 is used when attaching  
the DG-2 magnifier.  
Right-Angle Viewing Attachment DR-6: The DR-6 attaches at a  
right angle to the viewfinder eyepiece, allowing the  
image in the viewfinder to be viewed at right angles to  
the lens (for example, from directly above when the  
camera is horizontal).  
The D750 is equipped with  
an accessory terminal for  
WR-1 and WR-R10 wireless  
remote controllers (0197,  
444), MC-DC2 remote cords  
(095), and GP-1 and GP-1A  
GPS units (0239), which  
Accessory  
terminal  
accessories  
connect with the Hmark on the connector aligned with  
the Fnext to the accessory terminal (close the camera  
connector cover when the terminal is not in use).  
Microphones  
Stereo Microphone ME-1 (073)  
443  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Camera Control Pro 2: Control the camera remotely from a  
computer to record movies and photographs and save  
photographs directly to the computer hard disk. When  
Camera Control Pro 2 is used to capture photographs  
directly to the computer, the PC connection indicator  
(c) will appear in the control panel.  
Software  
Note: Use the latest versions of Nikon software; see the websites listed on  
page xxiii for the latest information on supported operating systems. At  
default settings, Nikon Message Center 2 will periodically check for updates  
to Nikon software and firmware while you are logged in to an account on the  
computer and the computer is connected to the Internet. A message is  
automatically displayed when an update is found.  
Wireless Remote Control ML-L3: The ML-L3 uses a 3 V CR2025  
battery.  
Pressing the battery-chamber latch to the right (q),  
insert a fingernail into the gap and open the battery  
chamber (w). Ensure that the battery is inserted in the  
correct orientation (r).  
Wireless Remote Controller WR-R10/WR-T10: When a WR-R10  
wireless remote controller is attached, the camera can  
be controlled wirelessly using a WR-T10 wireless  
remote controller.  
Remote  
controls/  
wirelessremote  
controller  
(0193)  
Wireless Remote Controller WR-1: The WR-1 can function as  
either a transmitter or a receiver and is used in  
combination either with another WR-1 or a WR-R10 or  
WR-T10 wireless remote controller. For example, a  
WR-1 can be connected to the accessory terminal for  
use as a receiver, allowing camera settings to be  
changed or the shutter to be released remotely by  
another WR-1 acting as a transmitter.  
Availability may vary with country or region. See our website or brochures for the latest  
information.  
444  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Attaching a Power Connector and AC Adapter  
Turn the camera off before attaching an optional power  
connector and AC adapter.  
1
Ready the camera.  
Open the battery-chamber  
(q) and power connector  
(w) covers.  
2
Insert the EP-5B power connector.  
Be sure to insert the connector in the  
orientation shown, using the  
connector to keep the orange battery  
latch pressed to one side. The latch  
locks the connector in place when the  
connector is fully inserted.  
3
Close the battery-  
chamber cover.  
Position the power  
connector cable so that it  
passes through the power  
connector slot and close  
the battery-chamber cover.  
445  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
4
Connect the EH-5b AC adapter.  
Connect the AC adapter power cable to the AC socket on AC  
adapter (e) and the power cable to the DC socket (r). A V  
icon is displayed in the monitor when the camera is powered  
by the AC adapter and power connector.  
446  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Caring for the Camera  
Storage  
When the camera will not be used for an extended period,  
remove the battery and store it in a cool, dry area with the  
terminal cover in place. To prevent mold or mildew, store the  
camera in a dry, well-ventilated area. Do not store your camera  
with naphtha or camphor moth balls or in locations that:  
are poorly ventilated or subject to humidities of over 60%  
are next to equipment that produces strong electromagnetic  
fields, such as televisions or radios  
are exposed to temperatures above 50 °C (122 °F) or below  
–10 °C (14 °F)  
Cleaning  
Use a blower to remove dust and lint, then wipe gently with  
a soft, dry cloth. After using the camera at the beach or  
Camera  
body  
seaside, wipe off sand or salt with a cloth lightly dampened  
in distilled water and dry thoroughly. Important: Dust or  
other foreign matter inside the camera may cause damage  
not covered under warranty.  
These glass elements are easily damaged. Remove dust  
Lens, mirror, and lint with a blower. If using an aerosol blower, keep the  
and can vertical to prevent the discharge of liquid. To remove  
viewfinder fingerprints and other stains, apply a small amount of lens  
cleaner to a soft cloth and clean with care.  
Remove dust and lint with a blower. When removing  
fingerprints and other stains, wipe the surface lightly with a  
soft cloth or chamois leather. Do not apply pressure, as this  
Monitor  
could result in damage or malfunction.  
Do not use alcohol, thinner, or other volatile chemicals.  
447  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
The Low-Pass Filter  
The image sensor that acts as the camera’s picture element is  
fitted with a low-pass filter to prevent moiré. If you suspect that  
dirt or dust on the filter is appearing in photographs, you can  
clean the filter using the Clean image sensor option in the  
setup menu. The filter can be cleaned at any time using the  
Clean now option, or cleaning can be performed automatically  
when the camera is turned on or off.  
❚❚ “Clean Now”  
Holding the camera base down, select  
Clean image sensor in the setup menu,  
then highlight Clean now and press J.  
The camera will check the image sensor  
and then begin cleaning. Other  
operations can not be performed while  
cleaning is in progress. Do not remove or  
disconnect the power source until  
cleaning ends and the setup menu is  
displayed.  
448  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
❚❚ “Clean at Startup/Shutdown”  
Choose from the following options:  
Option  
Description  
The image sensor is automatically cleaned  
each time the camera is turned on.  
The image sensor is automatically cleaned  
Clean at startup  
5
6
7
Clean at shutdown during shutdown each time the camera is  
turned off.  
Clean at startup & The image sensor is cleaned automatically at  
shutdown  
startup and at shutdown.  
Cleaning off  
Automatic image sensor cleaning off.  
1
2
Select Clean at startup/shutdown.  
Display the Clean image sensor  
menu as described on page 448.  
Highlight Clean at startup/  
shutdown and press 2.  
Select an option.  
Highlight an option and press J.  
449  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
DImage Sensor Cleaning  
Using camera controls during startup interrupts image sensor  
cleaning. Image sensor cleaning may not be performed at startup if  
the flash is charging.  
Cleaning is performed by vibrating the low-pass filter. If dust can not  
be fully removed using the options in the Clean image sensor menu,  
clean the image sensor manually (0451) or consult a Nikon-  
authorized service representative.  
If image sensor cleaning is performed several times in succession,  
image sensor cleaning may be temporarily disabled to protect the  
camera’s internal circuitry. Cleaning can be performed again after a  
short wait.  
450  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
❚❚ Manual Cleaning  
If foreign matter can not be removed from the low-pass filter  
using the Clean image sensor option in the setup menu  
(0448), the filter can be cleaned manually as described below.  
Note, however, that the filter is extremely delicate and easily  
damaged. Nikon recommends that the filter be cleaned only by  
Nikon-authorized service personnel.  
1
Charge the battery or connect an AC adapter.  
A reliable power source is required when inspecting or  
cleaning the low-pass filter. Turn the camera off and insert a  
fully-charged battery or connect an optional AC adapter and  
power connector. The Lock mirror up for cleaning option is  
only available in the setup menu at battery levels over J.  
2
3
Remove the lens.  
Turn the camera off and remove the lens.  
Select Lock mirror up for cleaning.  
Highlight Lock mirror up for  
cleaning in the setup menu and press  
2.  
451  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
4
Press J.  
The message shown at right will be  
displayed in the monitor and a row of  
dashes will appear in the control  
panel and viewfinder. To restore  
normal operation without inspecting  
the low-pass filter, turn the camera off.  
5
6
Raise the mirror.  
Press the shutter-release button all  
the way down. The mirror will be  
raised and the shutter curtain will  
open, revealing the low-pass filter.  
The display in the viewfinder will  
turn off and the row of dashes in the  
control panel will flash.  
Examine the low-pass filter.  
Holding the camera so that light falls  
on the low-pass filter, examine the  
filter for dust or lint. If no foreign  
objects are present, proceed to Step 8.  
452  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7
8
Clean the filter.  
Remove any dust and lint from the  
filter with a blower. Do not use a  
blower-brush, as the bristles could  
damage the filter. Dirt that can not be  
removed with a blower can only be  
removed by Nikon-authorized service  
personnel. Under no circumstances should you touch or  
wipe the filter.  
Turn the camera off.  
The mirror will return to the down position and the shutter  
curtain will close. Replace the lens or body cap.  
AUse a Reliable Power Source  
The shutter curtain is delicate and easily damaged. If the camera  
powers off while the mirror is raised, the curtain will close  
automatically. To prevent damage to the curtain, observe the  
following precautions:  
Do not turn the camera off or remove or disconnect the power source  
while the mirror is raised.  
If the battery runs low while the mirror is raised, a beep will sound  
and the self-timer lamp will flash to warn that the shutter curtain will  
close and the mirror will be lowered after about two minutes. End  
cleaning or inspection immediately.  
453  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DForeign Matter on the Low-Pass Filter  
Nikon takes every possible precaution to prevent foreign matter from  
coming into contact with the low-pass filter during production and  
shipping. The D750, however, is designed to be used with  
interchangeable lenses, and foreign matter may enter the camera  
when lenses are removed or exchanged. Once inside the camera, this  
foreign matter may adhere to the low-pass filter, where it may appear  
in photographs taken under certain conditions. To protect the camera  
when no lens is in place, be sure to replace the body cap provided with  
the camera, being careful to first remove all dust and other foreign  
matter that may be adhering to the body cap. Avoid exchanging  
lenses in dusty environments.  
Should foreign matter find its way onto the low-pass filter, clean the  
filter as described above, or have the filter cleaned by authorized Nikon  
service personnel. Photographs affected by the presence of foreign  
matter on the filter can be retouched using the clean image options  
available in some imaging applications.  
DServicing the Camera and Accessories  
The camera is a precision device and requires regular servicing. Nikon  
recommends that the camera be inspected by the original retailer or  
Nikon-authorized service representative once every one to two years,  
and that it be serviced once every three to five years (note that fees  
apply to these services). Frequent inspection and servicing are  
particularly recommended if the camera is used professionally. Any  
accessories regularly used with the camera, such as lenses or optional  
flash units, should be included when the camera is inspected or  
serviced.  
454  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Caring for the Camera and Battery:  
Cautions  
Do not drop: The product may malfunction if subjected to strong shocks or  
vibration.  
Keep dry: This product is not waterproof, and may malfunction if  
immersed in water or exposed to high levels of humidity. Rusting of the  
internal mechanism can cause irreparable damage.  
Avoid sudden changes in temperature: Sudden changes in temperature, such  
as those that occur when entering or leaving a heated building on a cold  
day, can cause condensation inside the device. To prevent  
condensation, place the device in a carrying case or plastic bag before  
exposing it to sudden changes in temperature.  
Keep away from strong magnetic fields: Do not use or store this device in the  
vicinity of equipment that generates strong electromagnetic radiation  
or magnetic fields. Strong static charges or the magnetic fields  
produced by equipment such as radio transmitters could interfere with  
the monitor, damage data stored on the memory card, or affect the  
product’s internal circuitry.  
Do not leave the lens pointed at the sun: Do not leave the lens pointed at the  
sun or other strong light source for an extended period. Intense light  
may cause the image sensor to deteriorate or produce a white blur effect  
in photographs.  
Turn the product off before removing or disconnecting the power source: Do not  
unplug the product or remove the battery while the product is on or  
while images are being recorded or deleted. Forcibly cutting power in  
these circumstances could result in loss of data or in damage to product  
memory or internal circuitry. To prevent an accidental interruption of  
power, avoid carrying the product from one location to another while  
the AC adapter is connected.  
455  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning: When cleaning the camera body, use a blower to gently remove  
dust and lint, then wipe gently with a soft, dry cloth. After using the  
camera at the beach or seaside, wipe off any sand or salt using a cloth  
lightly dampened in pure water and then dry the camera thoroughly. In  
rare instances, static electricity may cause LCDs to light up or go dark.  
This does not indicate a malfunction, and the display will soon return to  
normal.  
The lens and mirror are easily damaged. Dust and lint should be gently  
removed with a blower. When using an aerosol blower, keep the can  
vertical to prevent discharge of liquid. To remove fingerprints and other  
stains from the lens, apply a small amount of lens cleaner to a soft cloth  
and wipe the lens carefully.  
See “The Low-Pass Filter” (0448, 451) for information on cleaning the  
low-pass filter.  
Lens contacts: Keep the lens contacts clean.  
Do not touch the shutter curtain: The shutter curtain is extremely thin and  
easily damaged. Under no circumstances should you exert pressure on  
the curtain, poke it with cleaning tools, or subject it to powerful air  
currents from a blower. These actions could scratch, deform, or tear the  
curtain.  
Storage: To prevent mold or mildew, store the camera in a dry, well-  
ventilated area. If you are using an AC adapter, unplug the adapter to  
prevent fire. If the product will not be used for an extended period,  
remove the battery to prevent leakage and store the camera in a plastic  
bag containing a desiccant. Do not, however, store the camera case in a  
plastic bag, as this may cause the material to deteriorate. Note that  
desiccant gradually loses its capacity to absorb moisture and should be  
replaced at regular intervals.  
To prevent mold or mildew, take the camera out of storage at least once  
a month. Turn the camera on and release the shutter a few times before  
putting it away.  
Store the battery in a cool, dry place. Replace the terminal cover before  
putting the battery away.  
456  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notes on the monitor: The monitor is constructed with extremely high  
precision; at least 99.99% of pixels are effective, with no more than 0.01%  
being missing or defective. Hence while these displays may contain  
pixels that are always lit (white, red, blue, or green) or always off (black),  
this is not a malfunction and has no effect on images recorded with the  
device.  
Images in the monitor may be difficult to see in a bright light.  
Do not apply pressure to the monitor, as this could cause damage or  
malfunction. Dust or lint on the monitor can be removed with a blower.  
Stains can be removed by wiping lightly with a soft cloth or chamois  
leather. Should the monitor break, care should be taken to avoid injury  
from broken glass and to prevent liquid crystal from the monitor  
touching the skin or entering the eyes and mouth.  
The battery and charger: Batteries may leak or explode if improperly  
handled. Read and follow the warnings and cautions on pages xiii–xvi of  
this manual. Observe the following precautions when handling  
batteries:  
Use only batteries approved for use in this equipment.  
Do not expose the battery to flame or excessive heat.  
Keep the battery terminals clean.  
Turn the product off before replacing the battery.  
Remove the battery from the camera or charger when not in use and  
replace the terminal cover. These devices draw minute amounts of  
charge even when off and could draw the battery down to the point  
that it will no longer function. If the battery will not be used for some  
time, insert it in the camera and run it flat before removing it from the  
camera for storage. The battery should be stored in a cool location with  
an ambient temperature of 15 °C to 25 °C (59 °F to 77 °F; avoid hot or  
extremely cold locations). Repeat this process at least once every six  
months.  
Turning the camera on or off repeatedly when the battery is fully  
discharged will shorten battery life. Batteries that have been fully  
discharged must be charged before use.  
457  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
The internal temperature of the battery may rise while the battery is in  
use. Attempting to charge the battery while the internal temperature  
is elevated will impair battery performance, and the battery may not  
charge or charge only partially. Wait for the battery to cool before  
charging.  
Charge the battery indoors at ambient temperatures of 5 °C–35 °C  
(41 °F–95 °F). Do not use the battery at ambient temperatures below  
0 °C (32 °F) or above 40 °C (104 °F); failure to observe this precaution  
could damage the battery or impair its performance. Capacity may be  
reduced and charging times increase at battery temperatures from 0 °C  
(32 °F) to 15 °C (59 °F) and from 45 °C (113 °F) to 60 °C (140 °F). The  
battery will not charge if its temperature is below 0 °C (32 °F) or above  
60 °C (140 °F).  
If the CHARGE lamp flashes quickly (about eight times a second) during  
charging, confirm that the temperature is in the correct range and then  
unplug the charger and remove and reinsert the battery. If the problem  
persists, cease use immediately and take battery and charger to your  
retailer or a Nikon-authorized service representative.  
Do not move the charger or touch the battery during charging. Failure  
to observe this precaution could in very rare instances result in the  
charger showing that charging is complete when the battery is only  
partially charged. Remove and reinsert the battery to begin charging  
again. Battery capacity may temporarily drop if the battery is charged  
at low temperatures or used at a temperature below the temperature  
at which it was charged. If the battery is charged at a temperature  
below 5 °C (41 °F), the battery life indicator in the Battery info (0383)  
display may show a temporary decrease.  
Continuing to charge the battery after it is fully charged can impair  
battery performance.  
A marked drop in the time a fully charged battery retains its charge  
when used at room temperature indicates that it requires replacement.  
Purchase a new EN-EL15 battery.  
The supplied power cable and AC wall adapter are for use with the  
MH-25a only. Use the charger with compatible batteries only. Unplug  
when not in use.  
458  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Charge the battery before use. When taking photographs on  
important occasions, ready a spare battery and keep it fully charged.  
Depending on your location, it may be difficult to purchase  
replacement batteries on short notice. Note that on cold days, the  
capacity of batteries tends to decrease. Be sure the battery is fully  
charged before taking photographs outside in cold weather. Keep a  
spare battery in a warm place and exchange the two as necessary.  
Once warmed, a cold battery may recover some of its charge.  
Used batteries are a valuable resource; recycle in accord with local  
regulations.  
459  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Available Settings  
The following table lists the settings that can be adjusted in each  
mode. Note that some settings may be unavailable depending  
on the options selected.  
l,  
m,  
k, r,  
p, t,  
n, u,  
o, v,  
s, x,  
P, S, w, y,  
1,  
2,  
3
i
j
A, M  
0
z
%
g
i
u
White balance  
Set Picture Control  
Active D-Lighting  
HDR (high dynamic range)  
Long exposure NR  
High ISO NR  
ISO sensitivity settings  
Multiple exposure  
Movie ISO sensitivity  
settings  
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Time-lapse photography  
Metering  
Exposure compensation  
Bracketing  
Flash mode  
Flash compensation  
FV lock  
460  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
l,  
m,  
k, r,  
p, t,  
n, u,  
o, v,  
s, x,  
1,  
2,  
3
P, S, w, y,  
i
j
A, M  
0
z
%
g
i
u
Autofocus mode  
(viewfinder)  
AF-area mode (viewfinder)  
AF mode (Live view/movie)  
AF-area mode (Live view/  
movie)  
a9: Built-in AF-assist  
illuminator  
3
3
3
4
5
b3: Easy exposure  
compensation  
b4: Matrix metering  
b5: Center-weighted area  
d5: Flash warning  
e2: Flash shutter speed  
e3: Flash cntrl for built-in  
flash/Optional flash  
e4: Exposure comp. for  
flash  
e5: Modeling flash  
e6: Auto bracketing set  
e7: Bracketing order  
1
2
3
4
5
Fixed at Auto.  
Auto ISO sensitivity control is not available.  
Subject-tracking AF is not available.  
Not available in w mode.  
Available only in x, y, and z modes.  
461  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Exposure Program (Mode P)  
The exposure program for mode P is shown in the following  
graph:  
ISO 100; lens with maximum aperture of f/1.4 and minimum  
aperture of f/16 (e.g., AF 50mm f/1.4D)  
f/1  
f/1.4  
f/2  
f/2.8  
f/4  
f/5.6  
f/8  
f/11  
f/16  
f/22  
f/32  
30" 15" 8" 4" 2" 1" 1/2 1/4 1/8 1/15 1/30 1/60 1/125 1/250 1/500 1/1000 1/2000 1/4000 1/8000  
Shutter speed (seconds)  
The maximum and minimum values for EV vary with ISO  
sensitivity; the above graph assumes an ISO sensitivity of  
ISO 100 equivalent. When matrix metering is used, values over  
161  
/
3 EV are reduced to 161  
3 EV.  
/
462  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
If the camera fails to function as expected, check the list of  
common problems below before consulting your retailer or  
Nikon-authorized service representative.  
Battery/Display  
The camera is on but does not respond: Wait for recording to end. If the  
problem persists, turn the camera off. If the camera does not turn off,  
remove and reinsert the battery or, if you are using an AC adapter,  
disconnect and reconnect the AC adapter. Note that although any data  
currently being recorded will be lost, data that have already been  
recorded will not be affected by removing or disconnecting the power  
source.  
Viewfinder is out of focus: Adjust viewfinder focus (029). If this does not  
correct the problem, select single-servo autofocus (AF-S; 0121), single-  
point AF (0123), and the center focus point (0127), and then frame a  
high-contrast subject in the center focus point and press the shutter-  
release button halfway to focus the camera. With the camera in focus,  
use the diopter adjustment control to bring the subject into clear focus  
in the viewfinder. If necessary, viewfinder focus can be further adjusted  
using optional corrective lenses (0443).  
Viewfinder is dark: Insert a fully-charged battery (025, 30).  
Displays turn off without warning: Choose longer delays for Custom Setting  
c2 (Standby timer) or c4 (Monitor off delay) (0336, 337).  
Control panel and viewfinder displays are unresponsive and dim: The response  
times and brightness of these displays vary with temperature.  
Fine lines are visible around active focus point or display turns red when focus point is  
highlighted: These phenomena are normal for this type of viewfinder and  
do not indicate a malfunction.  
463  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Shooting (All Modes)  
Camera takes time to turn on: Delete files or folders.  
Shutter-release disabled:  
Memory card is locked, full, or not inserted (026, 33).  
Release locked is selected for Custom Setting f7 (Slot empty release  
lock; 0365) and no memory card is inserted (033).  
Built-in flash is charging (040).  
Camera is not in focus (036).  
Aperture ring for CPU lens not locked at highest f-number (does not  
apply to type G and E lenses). If B is displayed in control panel,  
select Aperture ring for Custom Setting f5 (Customize command  
dials) > Aperture setting to use lens aperture ring to adjust aperture  
Non-CPU lens is attached but camera is not in mode A or M (088).  
Camera is slow to respond to shutter-release button: Select Off for Custom  
Setting d4 (Exposure delay mode; 0339).  
No photo taken when remote control shutter-release button is pressed:  
Replace battery in remote control (0444).  
Choose an option other than Off for Remote control mode (ML-L3)  
Flash is charging (0195).  
Time selected for Custom Setting c5 (Remote on duration (ML-L3),  
0337) has elapsed: press camera shutter-release button halfway.  
Bright light is interfering with remote.  
Photos are out of focus:  
Rotate focus-mode selector to AF (0120).  
Camera unable to focus using autofocus: use manual focus or focus  
Focus does not lock when shutter-release button is pressed halfway: Use A AE-L/AF-L  
button to lock focus when AF-C is selected for focus mode or when  
photographing moving subjects in AF-A mode.  
464  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Can not select focus point:  
Unlock focus selector lock (0127).  
Auto-area AF or face-priority AF selected for AF-area mode: choose  
another mode.  
Camera is in playback mode (0241) or menus are in use (0292).  
Press shutter-release button halfway to start standby timer (039).  
Can not select AF mode: Manual focus selected (060, 132).  
Can not select AF-area mode: Manual focus selected (060, 132).  
Only one shot taken each time shutter-release button is pressed in continuous release  
mode: Continuous shooting is not available if built-in flash fires (0184).  
Image size can not be changed: Image quality set to NEF (RAW) (0115).  
Camera is slow to record photos: Turn long exposure noise reduction off  
(0317).  
Noise (bright spots, randomly-spaced bright pixels, fog, or lines) appear in photos:  
Choose lower ISO sensitivity or use high ISO noise reduction (0134,  
317).  
Shutter speed is slower than 1 s: use long exposure noise reduction  
(0317).  
Turn Active D-Lighting off to avoid heightening the effects of noise  
(0175).  
AF-assist illuminator does not light:  
AF-assist illuminator does not light if AF-C is selected for autofocus  
mode (0121) or if continuous-servo autofocus is selected when the  
camera is in AF-A mode. Choose AF-S. If an option other than auto-area  
AF is selected for AF-area mode, select center focus point (0123, 127).  
The camera is currently in live view or a movie is being recorded.  
Off is selected for Custom Setting a9 (Built-in AF-assist illuminator)  
(0332).  
Illuminator has turned off automatically. Illuminator may become hot  
with continued use; wait for it to cool down.  
465  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Smudges appear in photographs: Clean front and rear lens elements. If  
problem persists, perform image sensor cleaning (0448).  
Sound is not recorded with movies: Microphone off is selected for  
Microphone sensitivity in the movie shooting menu (0320).  
Live view ends unexpectedly or does not start: Live view may end automatically  
to prevent damage to the camera’s internal circuits if:  
The ambient temperature is high  
The camera has been used for extended periods in live view or to  
record movies  
The camera has been used in continuous release modes for extended  
periods  
If live view does not start when you press the a button, wait for the  
internal circuits to cool and then try again. Note that the camera may  
feel warm to the touch, but this does not indicate a malfunction.  
Image artifacts appear during live view: The temperature of the camera’s  
internal circuits may rise during live view, causing image “noise” in the  
form of bright spots, randomly-spaced bright pixels, or fog. Exit live view  
when the camera is not in use.  
Flicker or banding appears during live view or movie recording: Choose an option  
for Flicker reduction that matches the frequency of the local AC power  
supply (0380).  
Bright bands appear during live view or movie recording: A flashing sign, flash, or  
other light source with brief duration was used during live view or movie  
recording.  
Menu item can not be selected: Some options are not available in all modes  
466  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Shooting (P, S, A, M)  
Shutter-release disabled:  
Non-CPU lens is attached: rotate camera mode dial to A or M (088).  
Mode dial rotated to S after shutter speed of A or % selected in  
mode M: choose new shutter speed (090).  
Full range of shutter speeds not available: Flash in use. Flash sync speed can be  
selected using Custom Setting e1 (Flash sync speed); when using  
compatible flash units, choose 1/250 s (Auto FP) or 1/200 s (Auto FP)  
for full range of shutter speeds (0345).  
Colors are unnatural:  
Adjust white balance to match light source (0145).  
Adjust Set Picture Control settings (0165).  
Can not measure white balance: Subject is too dark or too bright (0158).  
Image can not be selected as source for manual preset white balance: Image was not  
created with D750 (0162).  
White balance bracketing unavailable:  
NEF (RAW) or NEF+JPEG image quality option selected for image  
quality (0115).  
Multiple exposure mode is in effect (0221).  
Effects of Picture Control differ from image to image: A (auto) is selected for  
sharpening, clarity, contrast, or saturation. For consistent results over a  
series of photos, choose another setting (0168).  
Metering can not be changed: Autoexposure lock is in effect (0141).  
Exposure compensation can not be used: Camera is in mode M. Choose another  
mode.  
Noise (reddish areas or other artifacts) appears in long time-exposures: Enable long  
exposure noise reduction (0317).  
467  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Playback  
NEF (RAW) image is not played back: Photo was taken at image quality of NEF  
+ JPEG (0115).  
Can not view pictures recorded with other cameras: Pictures recorded with other  
makes of camera may not be displayed correctly.  
Message is displayed stating that no images are available for playback: Select All for  
Playback folder (0300).  
“Tall” (portrait) orientation photos are displayed in “wide” (landscape) orientation:  
Select On for Rotate tall (0308).  
Photo was taken with Off selected for Auto image rotation (0382).  
Camera was pointed up or down when photo was taken (0382).  
Photo is displayed in image review (0307).  
Can not delete picture:  
Picture is protected: remove protection (0257).  
Memory card is locked (033).  
Can not retouch picture: Photo can not be further edited with this camera  
Can not change print order:  
Memory card is full: delete pictures (038, 258).  
Memory card is locked (033).  
Can not select photo for printing: Photo is in NEF (RAW) format. Transfer  
photos to computer and print using ViewNX 2 (supplied) or  
Capture NX-D (available for download; 0268). NEF (RAW) photos can be  
saved in JPEG format using NEF (RAW) processing (0406).  
Photo is not displayed on high-definition video device: Confirm that HDMI cable is  
connected (0277).  
Camera does not respond to remote control for HDMI-CEC television:  
Select On for HDMI > Device control in the setup menu (0278).  
Adjust HDMI-CEC settings for the television as described in  
documentation provided with the device.  
468  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Can not transfer photos to computer: OS not compatible with camera or  
transfer software. Use card reader to copy photos to computer (0264).  
Image Dust Off option in Capture NX-D does not have desired effect: Image sensor  
cleaning changes the position of dust on the low-pass filter. Dust off  
reference data recorded before image sensor cleaning is performed can  
not be used with photographs taken after image sensor cleaning is  
performed. Dust off reference data recorded after image sensor  
cleaning is performed can not be used with photographs taken before  
image sensor cleaning is performed (0380).  
Computer displays NEF (RAW) images differently from camera: Third-party  
software does not display effects of Picture Controls, Active D-Lighting,  
or vignette control. Use ViewNX 2 (supplied) or Nikon software such as  
Capture NX-D (available for download; 0268).  
Wi-Fi (Wireless Networks)  
Smart devices do not display the camera SSID (network name):  
Confirm that Enable is selected for Wi-Fi > Network connection in  
the camera setup menu (0284).  
Try turning the smart device Wi-Fi off and then on again.  
Miscellaneous  
Date of recording is not correct: Set camera clock (028, 381).  
Menu item can not be selected: Some options are not available at certain  
combinations of settings or when no memory card is inserted. Note that  
Battery info option is not available when camera is powered by an  
optional power connector and AC adapter (0383).  
469  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Error Messages  
This section lists the indicators and error messages that appear  
in the viewfinder, control panel, and monitor.  
Indicator  
Control View-  
panel finder  
Problem  
Lens aperture ring is  
not set to minimum  
aperture.  
Solution  
Set ring to minimum  
aperture (highest  
f-number).  
0
B
(flashes)  
Ready a fully-charged  
spare battery.  
H
d
Low battery.  
Battery exhausted.  
Recharge or replace  
battery.  
Battery can not be  
used.  
Contact Nikon-  
authorized service  
representative.  
An extremely  
exhausted  
rechargeable Li-ion  
battery or a third-  
party battery is  
Replace the battery, or  
recharge the battery if  
the rechargeable Li-  
ion battery is  
H
d
(flashes) (flashes)  
exhausted.  
inserted either in the  
camera or in the  
optional MB-D16  
battery pack.  
No lens attached, or  
non-CPU lens attached  
without specifying  
maximum aperture.  
Aperture shown in  
stops from maximum  
aperture.  
Aperture value will be  
displayed if maximum  
aperture is specified.  
F
470  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Indicator  
Control View-  
panel finder  
Problem  
Solution  
0
No lens attached.  
Attach non-IX Nikkor 27, 426  
lens. If a CPU lens is  
attached, remove and  
reattach the lens.  
i
(flashes)  
Non-CPU lens  
Select mode A or M.  
attached.  
F H Camera unable to focus Change composition or 131,  
(flashes) using autofocus.  
focus manually.  
Use a lower ISO  
sensitivity  
In shooting mode:  
P Use optional ND  
filter  
Subject too bright;  
photo will be  
overexposed.  
S
Increase shutter  
speed  
A Choose a smaller  
aperture (higher  
f-number)  
(Exposure  
indicators and  
shutter speed or  
aperture display  
flash)  
% Choose another  
shooting mode  
Use a higher ISO  
sensitivity  
In shooting mode:  
P Use flash  
Subject too dark; photo  
will be underexposed.  
S
Lower shutter  
speed  
A Choose a larger  
aperture (lower  
f-number)  
471  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Indicator  
Control View-  
panel finder  
A
Problem  
Solution  
0
Aselected in mode Change shutter speed  
(flashes)  
%
S.  
or select mode M.  
Change shutter speed  
or select mode M.  
Wait until processing is  
complete.  
% selected in mode S.  
(flashes)  
P
k
Processing in progress.  
(flashes) (flashes)  
Check photo in  
monitor; if  
underexposed, adjust  
settings and try again.  
If indicator flashes for 3s  
after flash fires, photo  
may be underexposed.  
c
(flashes)  
Reduce quality or size. 115,  
Memory insufficient to Delete photographs  
record further photos at after copying  
n
j
current settings, or  
important images to  
computer or other  
device.  
(flashes) (flashes)  
camera has run out of  
file or folder numbers.  
Insert new memory  
card.  
Release shutter. If error  
persists or appears  
frequently, consult  
Nikon-authorized  
service representative.  
O
(flashes)  
Camera malfunction.  
472  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Indicator  
Control  
panel  
Monitor  
Problem  
Solution  
Turn camera off  
and confirm that  
card is correctly  
inserted.  
0
Camera cannot  
detect memory  
card.  
No memory card.  
S
Error accessing Use Nikon-  
memory card. approved card.  
Check that  
contacts are  
clean. If card is  
damaged,contact  
retailer or Nikon-  
authorized  
This memory card  
cannot be used.  
Card may be  
W,  
O
service  
damaged.  
(flashes)  
representative.  
Insert another card.  
Unable to create Delete files or  
new folder.  
insert new  
memory card  
after copying  
important images  
to computer or  
other device.  
Check that Eye-Fi 391  
card firmware is  
up to date.  
W, Camera can not  
control Eye-Fi  
(flashes) card.  
Copy files on Eye- 26,266,  
g
O
Fi card to a  
computer or  
other device and  
format card, or  
insert new card.  
473  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Indicator  
Control  
panel  
Monitor  
Problem  
Solution  
0
Memory card is  
locked. Slide lock to  
“write” position.  
W, Memory card is  
locked (write  
(flashes) protected).  
X
Slide card write-  
protect switch to  
“write” position.  
W, Eye-Fi card is  
Not available if  
Eye-Fi card is locked.  
O
locked (write  
(flashes) protected).  
Memory card has  
This card is not  
formatted.  
Format the card.  
Format memory  
card or insert new 26, 375  
memory card.  
[C] not been  
(flashes) formatted for use  
in camera.  
Clock has been  
reset.  
Camera clock is  
not set.  
Set camera clock. 28, 381  
Wait for the internal  
circuits to cool  
before resuming  
live view or movie  
recording.  
The internal  
temperature of  
the camera is  
high.  
Unable to start live  
view. Please wait.  
Select folder  
No images on  
containing images  
from Playback  
folder menu or  
insert memory card  
containing images.  
No images can be  
played back until  
another folder has  
been selected or  
Hide image used  
to allow at least  
one image to be  
displayed.  
memory card or  
Folder contains no  
images.  
in folder(s)  
selected for  
playback.  
All photos in  
current folder are  
hidden.  
All images are  
hidden.  
474  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Indicator  
Control  
panel  
Monitor  
Problem  
File has been  
created or  
Solution  
0
modified using a File can not be  
computer or played back on  
different make of camera.  
camera, or file is  
corrupt.  
Cannot display this  
file.  
Images created  
with other devices  
can not be  
Selected image  
can not be  
retouched.  
Cannot select this  
file.  
retouched.  
Movies created  
with other  
devices can not  
be edited.  
Movies must be at 85  
least two seconds  
long.  
The selected  
movie can not be  
edited.  
This movie cannot  
be edited.  
Multiple smart  
devices are  
attempting to  
connect to  
camera  
simultaneously.  
Could not connect;  
multiple devices  
detected. Try again  
later.  
Wait a few minutes  
before trying again.  
Select Disable for  
Wi-Fi > Network  
Error  
Wi-Fi error.  
connection, then  
select Enable  
again.  
475  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Indicator  
Control  
panel  
Monitor  
Problem  
The internal  
temperature of  
the camera is  
high.  
Solution  
Turn camera off  
and try again after  
waiting for camera  
to cool.  
Check printer. To  
resume, select  
Continue (if  
0
Network access not  
available until  
camera cools.  
Check printer.  
Printer error.  
271 *  
available).  
Paper in printer is Insert paper of  
Check paper.  
Paper jam.  
not of selected  
size.  
correct size and  
select Continue.  
271 *  
271 *  
271 *  
Paper is jammed Clear jam and  
in printer.  
select Continue.  
Insert paper of  
selected size and  
select Continue.  
Check ink. To  
resume, select  
Continue.  
Printer is out of  
paper.  
Out of paper.  
Check ink supply.  
Out of ink.  
Ink error.  
271 *  
271 *  
Printer is out of Replace ink and  
ink. select Continue.  
* See printer manual for more information.  
476  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Specifications  
❚❚ Nikon D750 Digital Camera  
Type  
Type  
Single-lens reflex digital camera  
Lens mount  
Nikon F mount (with AF coupling and AF  
contacts)  
Effective angle of view  
Nikon FX format  
Effective pixels  
Effective pixels  
24.3 million  
Image sensor  
Image sensor  
Total pixels  
35.9 × 24.0 mm CMOS sensor  
24.93 million  
Dust-reduction System  
Image sensor cleaning, Image Dust Off  
reference data (Capture NX-D software  
required)  
Storage  
Image size (pixels)  
FX (36×24) image area  
6016 × 4016 (#)  
3008 × 2008 (%)  
1.2× (30×20) image area  
5008 × 3336 (#)  
2504 × 1664 (%)  
DX (24×16) image area  
3936 × 2624 (#)  
1968 × 1312 (%)  
4512 × 3008 ($)  
3752 × 2504 ($)  
2944 × 1968 ($)  
FX-format photographs taken in movie live view  
6016 × 3376 (#)  
4512 × 2528 ($)  
3008 × 1688 (%)  
DX-format photographs taken in movie live view  
3936 × 2224 (#)  
2944 × 1664 ($)  
1968 × 1112 (%)  
Note: Photographs taken in movie live view have an aspect ratio  
of 16 : 9. The camera offers a choice of DX- and FX-based formats.  
477  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Storage  
File format  
NEF (RAW): 12 or 14 bit, lossless compressed or  
compressed  
JPEG: JPEG-Baseline compliant with fine  
(approx. 1 : 4), normal (approx. 1 : 8), or basic  
(approx. 1 : 16) compression (Size priority);  
Optimal quality compression available  
NEF (RAW)+JPEG: Single photograph recorded in  
both NEF (RAW) and JPEG formats  
Picture Control System  
Standard, Neutral, Vivid, Monochrome, Portrait,  
Landscape, Flat; selected Picture Control can be  
modified; storage for custom Picture Controls  
SD (Secure Digital) and UHS-I compliant SDHC  
and SDXC memory cards  
Media  
Double slot  
Slot 2 can be used for overflow or backup  
storage or for separate storage of copies  
created using NEF+JPEG; pictures can be  
copied between cards.  
File system  
DCF 2.0, DPOF, Exif 2.3, PictBridge  
Viewfinder  
Viewfinder  
Eye-level pentaprism single-lens reflex  
viewfinder  
Frame coverage  
FX (36×24): Approx. 100% horizontal and 100%  
vertical  
1.2× (30×20): Approx. 97% horizontal and 97%  
vertical  
DX (24×16): Approx. 97% horizontal and 97%  
vertical  
Magnification  
Eyepoint  
Approx. 0.7 × (50 mm f/1.4 lens at infinity,  
–1.0 m–1  
)
21 mm (–1.0 m–1; from center surface of  
viewfinder eyepiece lens)  
–3–+1 m–1  
Diopter adjustment  
478  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Viewfinder  
Focusing screen  
Type B BriteView Clear Matte Mark III screen  
with AF area brackets (framing grid can be  
displayed)  
Reflex mirror  
Quick return  
Depth-of-field preview  
Pressing Pv button stops lens aperture down to  
value selected by user (A and M modes) or by  
camera (other modes)  
Lens aperture  
Instant return, electronically controlled  
Lens  
Compatible lenses  
Compatible with AF NIKKOR lenses, including  
type G, E, and D lenses (some restrictions apply  
to PC lenses) and DX lenses (using DX 24 × 16  
1.5× image area), AI-P NIKKOR lenses, and non-  
CPU AI lenses (A and M modes only). IX NIKKOR  
lenses, lenses for the F3AF, and non-AI lenses  
can not be used.  
The electronic rangefinder can be used with  
lenses that have a maximum aperture of f/5.6 or  
faster (the electronic rangefinder supports the  
11 focus points with lenses that have a  
maximum aperture of f/8 or faster).  
Shutter  
Type  
Electronically-controlled vertical-travel focal-  
plane shutter  
/
1
Speed  
4000 – 30 s in steps of 1  
/
3 or 1  
2 EV, bulb, time,  
/
X200  
X=1 200 s; synchronizes with shutter at 1  
slower (flash range drops at speeds between  
Flash sync speed  
/
/250 s or  
1
/
200 and 1  
250 s)  
/
479  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Release  
Release mode  
S (single frame), T (continuous low speed),  
U (continuous high speed), J (quiet shutter-  
release), M (quiet continuous shutter-release),  
E (self-timer), V (mirror up)  
Frame advance rate  
Self-timer  
1–6 fps (T), 6.5 fps (U), or 3 fps (M)  
2 s, 5 s, 10 s, 20 s; 1–9 exposures at intervals of  
0.5, 1, 2, or 3 s  
Remote control modes  
(ML-L3)  
Delayed remote, quick-response remote,  
remote mirror-up  
Exposure  
Metering  
TTL exposure metering using RGB sensor with  
approximately 91K (91,000) pixels  
Metering method  
Matrix: 3D color matrix metering III (type G, E,  
and D lenses); color matrix metering III (other  
CPU lenses); color matrix metering available  
with non-CPU lenses if user provides lens data  
Center-weighted: Weight of approximately 75%  
given to 12 mm circle in center of frame.  
Diameter of circle can be changed to 8, 15, or  
20 mm, or weighting can be based on average  
of entire frame (non-CPU lenses use 12-mm  
circle)  
Spot: Meters 4 mm circle (about 1.5% of frame)  
centered on selected focus point (on center  
focus point when non-CPU lens is used)  
Highlight-weighted: Available with type G, E, and  
D lenses; equivalent to center-weighted when  
other lenses are used.  
Range (ISO 100, f/1.4 lens, Matrix, center-weighted, or highlight-weighted  
20 °C/68 °F)  
metering: 0–20 EV  
Spot metering: 2–20 EV  
Exposure meter coupling Combined CPU and AI  
480  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Exposure  
Mode  
Auto modes (i auto; j auto (flash off)); scene  
modes (k portrait; l landscape; p child; m sports;  
n close up; o night portrait; r night landscape; s party/  
indoor; t beach/snow; u sunset; vdusk/dawn; w pet  
portrait; xcandlelight; y blossom; z autumn colors; 0 food);  
special effects modes (% night vision; g color sketch;  
i miniature effect; u selective color; 1 silhouette; 2 high  
key; 3 low key); programmed auto with flexible  
program (P); shutter-priority auto (S); aperture-  
priority auto (A); manual (M); U1 (user settings 1); U2  
(user settings 2)  
Exposure compensation Can be adjusted by –5 – +5 EV in increments of  
1
/
3 or 1  
2–9 frames in steps of 1  
5 frames in steps of 2 or 3 EV  
2–9 frames in steps of 1  
5 frames in steps of 2 or 3 EV  
White balance bracketing 2–3 frames in steps of 1, 2, or 3  
/
2 EV in P, S, A, M, h, and % modes  
Exposure bracketing  
Flash bracketing  
/
3, 1  
/
2, 2  
/3, or 1 EV; 2–  
/
3, 1  
/
2, 2  
/
3, or 1 EV; 2–  
ADL bracketing  
Exposure lock  
ISO sensitivity  
2 frames using selected value for one frame or  
3–5 frames using preset values for all frames  
Luminosity locked at detected value with  
A AE-L/AF-L button  
ISO 100 – 12800 in steps of 1  
/
3 or 1  
2 EV. Can also  
/
(Recommended Exposure be set to approx. 0.3, 0.5, 0.7, or 1 EV (ISO 50  
Index)  
equivalent) below ISO 100 or to approx. 0.3, 0.5,  
0.7, 1, or 2 EV (ISO 51200 equivalent) above  
ISO 12800; auto ISO sensitivity control available  
Auto, Extra high, High, Normal, Low, Off  
Active D-Lighting  
481  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Focus  
Autofocus  
Nikon Advanced Multi-CAM 3500 II autofocus  
sensor module with TTL phase detection, fine-  
tuning, 51 focus points (including 15 cross-type  
sensors; f/8 supported by 11 sensors), and AF-  
assist illuminator (range approx. 0.5–3 m/1 ft  
8 in.–9 ft 10 in.)  
Detection range  
Lens servo  
–3 – +19 EV (ISO 100, 20 °C/68 °F)  
Autofocus (AF): Single-servo AF (AF-S);  
continuous-servo AF (AF-C); auto AF-S/AF-C  
selection (AF-A); predictive focus tracking  
activated automatically according to subject  
status  
Manual focus (M): Electronic rangefinder can be  
used  
Focus point  
AF-area mode  
Can be selected from 51 or 11 focus points  
Single-point AF; 9-, 21-, or 51-point dynamic-  
area AF, 3D-tracking, group-area AF, auto-area  
AF  
Focus lock  
Focus can be locked by pressing shutter-release  
button halfway (single-servo AF) or by pressing  
A AE-L/AF-L button  
Flash  
Built-in flash  
i, k, p, n, o, s, w, g: Auto flash with auto  
pop-up  
P, S, A, M, 0: Manual pop-up with button release  
Approx. 12/39, 12/39 with manual flash (m/ft,  
ISO 100, 20 °C/68 °F)  
Guide Number  
482  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Flash  
Flash control  
TTL: i-TTL flash control using RGB sensor with  
approximately 91K (91,000) pixels is available  
with built-in flash; i-TTL balanced fill-flash for  
digital SLR is used with matrix, center-weighted,  
and highlight-weighted metering, standard  
i-TTL flash for digital SLR with spot metering  
Auto, auto with red-eye reduction, auto slow  
sync, auto slow sync with red-eye reduction, fill-  
flash, red-eye reduction, slow sync, slow sync  
with red-eye reduction, rear-curtain with slow  
sync, rear-curtain sync, off; Auto FP High-Speed  
Sync supported  
Flash mode  
Flash compensation  
Flash-ready indicator  
–3 – +1 EV in increments of 1  
/
3 or 1  
2 EV  
/
Lights when built-in flash or optional flash unit  
is fully charged; blinks after flash is fired at full  
output  
Accessory shoe  
ISO 518 hot-shoe with sync and data contacts  
and safety lock  
Nikon Creative Lighting Nikon CLS supported; commander mode  
System (CLS)  
Sync terminal  
option available  
AS-15 sync terminal adapter (available  
separately)  
White balance  
White balance  
Auto (2 types), incandescent, fluorescent  
(7 types), direct sunlight, flash, cloudy, shade,  
preset manual (up to 6 values can be stored,  
spot white balance measurement available  
during live view), choose color temperature  
(2500 K–10000 K), all with fine-tuning  
483  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Live view  
Modes  
Live view photography (still images), movie live  
view (movies)  
Lens servo  
Autofocus (AF): Single-servo AF (AF-S); full-time  
servo AF (AF-F)  
Manual focus (M)  
AF-area mode  
Autofocus  
Face-priority AF, wide-area AF, normal-area AF,  
subject-tracking AF  
Contrast-detect AF anywhere in frame (camera  
selects focus point automatically when face-  
priority AF or subject-tracking AF is selected)  
Movie  
Metering  
TTL exposure metering using main image  
sensor  
Metering method  
Frame size (pixels) and  
frame rate  
Matrix, center-weighted, or highlight-weighted  
1920 × 1080; 60 p (progressive), 50 p, 30 p,  
25 p, 24 p  
1280 × 720; 60 p, 50 p  
Actual frame rates for 60 p, 50 p, 30 p, 25 p, and  
24 p are 59.94, 50, 29.97, 25, and 23.976 fps  
respectively; options support both high and  
normal image quality  
File format  
MOV  
Video compression  
Audio recording format  
Audio recording device  
H.264/MPEG-4 Advanced Video Coding  
Linear PCM  
Built-in or external stereo microphone;  
sensitivity adjustable  
Other options  
Index marking, time-lapse photography  
Monitor  
Monitor  
8-cm/3.2-in., approx. 1229 k-dot (VGA; 640 ×  
RGBW × 480 = 1,228,800 dots), low-  
temperature polysilicon tilting TFT LCD with  
approx. 170 ° viewing angle, approx. 100%  
frame coverage, and brightness and angle  
adjustment  
484  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Playback  
Playback  
Full-frame and thumbnail (4, 9, or 72 images or  
calendar) playback with playback zoom, movie  
playback, photo and/or movie slide shows,  
histogram display, highlights, photo  
information, location data display, and auto  
image rotation  
Interface  
USB  
Hi-Speed USB; connection to built-in USB port is  
recommended  
HDMI output  
Type C HDMI connector  
Accessory terminal  
Wireless remote controllers: WR-1, WR-R10  
(available separately)  
Remote cord: MC-DC2 (available separately)  
GPS unit: GP-1/GP-1A (available separately)  
Stereo mini-pin jack (3.5 mm diameter; plug-in  
power supported)  
Audio input  
Audio output  
Stereo mini-pin jack (3.5 mm diameter)  
Wireless (D750 only; not available with the D750 (K))  
Standards IEEE 802.11b, IEEE 802.11g  
Communications protocols IEEE 802.11b: DSSS/CCK  
IEEE 802.11g: OFDM  
Operating frequency  
Range (line of sight)  
2412–2462 MHz (channels 1–11)  
Approximately 30 m/98 ft (assumes no  
interference; range may vary with signal  
strength and presence or absence of obstacles)  
54 Mbps  
Maximum logical data rates according to IEEE  
standard. Actual rates may differ.  
Authentication: Open system, WPA2-PSK  
Encryption: AES  
Data rate  
Security  
Wireless setup  
Supports WPS  
Access protocols  
Infrastructure  
485  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Supported languages  
Supported languages  
Arabic, Bengali, Bulgarian, Chinese (Simplified  
and Traditional), Czech, Danish, Dutch, English,  
Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hindi,  
Hungarian, Indonesian, Italian, Japanese,  
Korean, Marathi, Norwegian, Persian, Polish,  
Portuguese (Portugal and Brazil), Romanian,  
Russian, Serbian, Spanish, Swedish, Tamil,  
Telugu, Thai, Turkish, Ukrainian, Vietnamese  
Power source  
Battery  
Battery pack  
One EN-EL15 rechargeable Li-ion battery  
Optional MB-D16 multi-power battery pack  
with one Nikon EN-EL15 rechargeable Li-ion  
battery or six AA alkaline, Ni-MH, or lithium  
batteries  
AC adapter  
EH-5b AC adapter; requires EP-5B power  
connector (available separately)  
Tripod socket  
Tripod socket  
1
/
4 in. (ISO 1222)  
Dimensions/weight  
Dimensions (W × H × D) Approx. 140.5 × 113 × 78 mm (5.6 × 4.5 × 3.1 in.)  
Weight  
Approx. 840 g (1 lb 13.7 oz) with battery and  
memory card but without body cap; approx.  
750 g (1 lb 10.5 oz; camera body only)  
Operating environment  
Temperature  
0 °C–40 °C (+32 °F–104 °F)  
Humidity  
85% or less (no condensation)  
Unless otherwise stated, all figures are for a camera with a fully-charged battery operating at  
the temperature specified by the Camera and Imaging Products Association (CIPA): 23 3 °C  
(73.4 5.4 °F).  
Nikon reserves the right to change the specifications of the hardware and software described in  
this manual at any time and without prior notice. Nikon will not be held liable for damages that  
may result from any mistakes that this manual may contain.  
486  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MH-25a Battery Charger  
Rated input  
AC 120 V, 60 Hz, 0.2 A  
(in North America)  
Rated input  
AC 100–240 V, 50/60 Hz, 0.23–0.12 A  
(in other regions)  
Rated output  
DC 8.4 V/1.2 A  
Supported batteries  
Charging time  
Nikon EN-EL15 rechargeable Li-ion batteries  
Approx. 2 hours and 35 minutes at an ambient  
temperature of 25 °C (77 °F) when no charge  
remains  
Operating temperature 0 °C–40 °C (+32 °F–104 °F)  
Dimensions (W × H × D) Approx. 95 × 33.5 × 71 mm (3.7 × 1.3 × 2.8 in.),  
excluding projections  
Length of power cable  
(if supplied)  
Approx. 1.5 m (4.9 ft)  
Weight  
Approx. 115 g (4.1 oz), excluding supplied  
power connector (power cable or AC wall  
adapter)  
EN-EL15 Rechargeable Li-ion Battery  
Type  
Rated capacity  
Rechargeable lithium-ion battery  
7.0 V/1900 mAh  
Operating temperature 0 °C–40 °C (+32 °F–104 °F)  
Dimensions (W × H × D) Approx. 40 × 56 × 20.5 mm (1.6 × 2.2 × 0.8 in.)  
Weight  
Approx. 88 g (3.1 oz), excluding terminal cover  
Nikon reserves the right to change the specifications of the hardware and software described in  
this manual at any time and without prior notice. Nikon will not be held liable for damages that  
may result from any mistakes that this manual may contain.  
487  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
❚❚ Supported Standards  
DCF Version 2.0: The Design Rule for Camera File Systems (DCF)  
is a standard widely used in the digital camera industry to  
ensure compatibility among different makes of camera.  
DPOF: Digital Print Order Format (DPOF) is an industry-wide  
standard that allows pictures to be printed from print orders  
stored on the memory card.  
Exif version 2.3: The camera supports Exif (Exchangeable Image  
File Format for Digital Still Cameras) version 2.3, a standard in  
which information stored with photographs is used for  
optimal color reproduction when the images are output on  
Exif-compliant printers.  
PictBridge: A standard developed through cooperation with  
the digital camera and printer industries, allowing  
photographs to be output directly to a printer without first  
transferring them to a computer.  
HDMI: High-Definition Multimedia Interface is a standard for  
multimedia interfaces used in consumer electronics and AV  
devices capable of transmitting audiovisual data and control  
signals to HDMI-compliant devices via a single cable  
connection.  
488  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Trademark Information  
IOS is a trademark or registered trademark of Cisco Systems, Inc., in the  
United States and/or other countries and is used under license. Mac and  
OS X are registered trademarks of Apple Inc. in the United States and/or  
other countries. Microsoft, Windows, and Windows Vista are either  
registered trademarks, or trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the  
United States and/or other countries. PictBridge is a trademark. The SD,  
SDHC, and SDXC logos are trademarks of the SD-3C, LLC. HDMI, the  
HDMI logo and High-Definition Multimedia Interface are trademarks or  
registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing, LLC.  
Wi-Fi and the Wi-Fi logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of the  
Wi-Fi Alliance. All other trade names mentioned in this manual or the  
other documentation provided with your Nikon product are trademarks  
or registered trademarks of their respective holders.  
AConformity Marking  
The standards with which the camera complies can be viewed using  
the Conformity marking option in the setup menu (0392).  
AFreeType License (FreeType2)  
Portions of this software are copyright © 2012 The FreeType Project  
(http://www.freetype.org). All rights reserved.  
AMIT License (HarfBuzz)  
Portions of this software are copyright © 2014 The HarfBuzz Project  
(http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/HarfBuzz). All rights  
reserved.  
489  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ACertificates  
490  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Approved Memory Cards  
The following SD memory cards have been tested and approved  
for use in the camera. Cards with class 6 or faster write speeds  
are recommended for movie recording. Recording may end  
unexpectedly when cards with slower write speeds are used.  
SD cards  
2 GB 1  
SDHC cards 2  
SDXC cards 3  
64 GB, 128 GB  
64 GB  
SanDisk  
Toshiba  
4 GB, 8 GB, 16 GB, 32 GB  
4 GB, 6 GB, 8 GB, 12 GB,  
16 GB, 24 GB, 32 GB  
Panasonic  
48 GB, 64 GB  
2 GB 1  
Lexar Media  
Platinum II  
Professional  
Full-HD Video  
4 GB, 8 GB, 16 GB, 32 GB  
64 GB  
8 GB, 16 GB, 32 GB  
4 GB, 8 GB, 16 GB  
64 GB, 128 GB, 256 GB  
1
2
3
Check that any card readers or other devices with which the card will be used support 2 GB  
cards.  
Check that any card readers or other devices with which the card will be used are SDHC-  
compliant. The camera supports UHS-1.  
Check that any card readers or other devices with which the card  
will be used are SDXC-compliant. The camera supports UHS-1.  
Other cards have not been tested. For more details on the above  
cards, please contact the manufacturer.  
491  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Memory Card Capacity  
The following table shows the approximate number of pictures  
that can be stored on a 16 GB SanDisk SDSDXPA-016G-J35 UHS-I  
SDHC card at different image quality (0115), image size  
❚❚ FX (36×24) Image Area *  
No. of  
Buffer  
File size 1  
21.0 MB  
26.9 MB  
Image quality  
Image size  
images1 capacity 2  
NEF (RAW), Lossless compressed,  
12-bit  
NEF (RAW), Lossless compressed,  
14-bit  
376  
292  
25  
15  
NEF (RAW), Compressed, 12-bit  
NEF (RAW), Compressed, 14-bit  
Large  
Medium  
Small  
Large  
Medium  
Small  
Large  
Medium  
Small  
19.2 MB  
23.9 MB  
12.6 MB  
7.7 MB  
4.1 MB  
6.7 MB  
3.9 MB  
2.1 MB  
2.2 MB  
1.6 MB  
1.1 MB  
507  
425  
923  
33  
21  
87  
JPEG fine3  
JPEG normal 3  
JPEG basic3  
1500  
2900  
1800  
2900  
5500  
3500  
5700  
10100  
100  
100  
100  
100  
100  
100  
100  
100  
* Includes images taken with non-DX lenses when On is selected for Auto DX crop.  
492  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
❚❚ DX (24×16) Image Area *  
No. of  
Buffer  
File size 1  
10.5 MB  
13.1 MB  
Image quality  
Image size  
images 1 capacity2  
NEF (RAW), Lossless compressed,  
12-bit  
NEF (RAW), Lossless compressed,  
14-bit  
579  
449  
100  
48  
NEF (RAW), Compressed, 12-bit  
NEF (RAW), Compressed, 14-bit  
Large  
Medium  
Small  
Large  
Medium  
Small  
Large  
9.8 MB  
11.9 MB  
6.2 MB  
3.9 MB  
2.3 MB  
3.1 MB  
2.0 MB  
1.2 MB  
1.6 MB  
1.2 MB  
0.8 MB  
785  
656  
100  
100  
100  
100  
100  
100  
100  
100  
100  
100  
100  
1900  
3000  
5000  
3700  
5700  
9300  
7000  
10300  
15600  
JPEG fine 3  
JPEG normal 3  
JPEG basic 3  
Medium  
Small  
* Includes images taken with DX lenses when On is selected for Auto DX crop.  
1
2
All figures are approximate. File size varies with scene recorded.  
Maximum number of exposures that can be stored in memory buffer at ISO 100. Drops if  
Optimal quality is selected for JPEG compression (0117), ISO sensitivity is set  
to Hi 0.3 or higher, or long exposure noise reduction or auto distortion control is on.  
Figures assume JPEG compression is set to Size priority. Selecting Optimal  
quality increases the file size of JPEG images; number of images and buffer capacity drop  
accordingly.  
3
Ad3—Max. Continuous Release (0339)  
The maximum number of photographs that can be taken in a single  
burst can be set to any amount between 1 and 100.  
493  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Battery Life  
The movie footage or number of shots that can be recorded with  
fully-charged batteries varies with the condition of the battery,  
temperature, interval between shots, and the length of time  
menus are displayed. In the case of AA batteries, capacity also  
varies with make and storage conditions; some batteries can not  
be used. Sample figures for the camera and optional MB-D16  
multi-power battery pack are given below.  
Photographs, single-frame release mode (CIPA standard 1)  
One EN-EL15 battery (camera): Approximately 1230 shots  
One EN-EL15 battery (MB-D16): Approximately 1230 shots  
Six AA alkaline batteries (MB-D16): Approximately 430 shots  
Photographs, continuous release mode (Nikon standard 2)  
One EN-EL15 battery (camera): Approximately 4420 shots  
One EN-EL15 battery (MB-D16): Approximately 4420 shots  
Six AA alkaline batteries (MB-D16): Approximately 780 shots  
Movies 3  
One EN-EL15 battery (camera): Approximately 55 minutes of HD  
footage  
One EN-EL15 battery (MB-D16): Approximately 55 minutes of HD  
footage  
Six AA alkaline batteries (MB-D16): Approximately 20 minutes of HD  
footage  
494  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
1
2
Measured at 23 °C/73.4 °F ( 2 °C/3.6 °F) with an AF-S NIKKOR 24–85mm f/3.5–4.5G ED VR  
lens under the following test conditions: lens cycled from infinity to minimum range and one  
photograph taken at default settings once every 30 s; flash fired once every other shot. Live  
view not used.  
Measured at 20 °C/68 °F with an AF-S NIKKOR 24–85mm f/3.5–4.5G ED VR lens under the  
following test conditions: image quality set to JPEG basic, image size set to M (medium),  
shutter speed 1  
250 s, shutter-release button pressed halfway for three seconds and focus cycled  
/
from infinity to minimum range three times; six shots are then taken in succession and monitor  
turned on for five seconds and then turned off; cycle repeated once standby timer expires.  
Measured at 23 °C/73.4 °F ( 3 °C/5.4 °F) with the camera at default settings and an AF-S  
NIKKOR 24–85mm f/3.5–4.5G ED VR lens under conditions specified by the Camera and  
Imaging Products Association (CIPA). Individual movies can be up to 20 minutes (1080/60p) in  
length or 4 GB in size; recording may end before these limits are reached if the camera  
temperature rises.  
3
The following can reduce battery life:  
Using the monitor  
Keeping the shutter-release button pressed halfway  
Repeated autofocus operations  
Taking NEF (RAW) photographs  
Slow shutter speeds  
Using an optional GP-1 or GP-1A GPS unit or WR-R10/WR-1  
wireless remote controller  
Using Wi-Fi or an optional UT-1 communication unit or WT-5  
wireless transmitter  
Using VR (vibration reduction) mode with VR lenses  
To ensure that you get the most from Nikon EN-EL15  
rechargeable Li-ion batteries:  
Keep the battery contacts clean. Soiled contacts can reduce  
battery performance.  
Use batteries immediately after charging. Batteries will lose  
their charge if left unused.  
495  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lenses That May Block the Built-in Flash  
and AF-Assist Illuminator  
The lenses listed in this section may block the built-in flash or  
AF-assist illuminator under some conditions.  
❚❚ AF-Assist Illumination  
Some lenses may block the illuminator at certain focus  
distances. Remove lens hoods when using the illuminator.  
AF-assist illumination is not available with the following lenses:  
AF-S NIKKOR 200mm f/2G ED VR II  
AF-S VR Zoom-Nikkor 200–400mm f/4G IF-ED  
AF-S NIKKOR 200–400mm f/4G ED VR II  
AF-S NIKKOR 300mm f/2.8G ED VR II  
At ranges under 0.7 m (2 ft 4 in.), the following lenses may block  
the AF-assist illuminator and interfere with autofocus when  
lighting is poor:  
AF-S NIKKOR 16–35mm f/4G ED VR  
AF-S Zoom-Nikkor 17–35mm f/2.8D IF-ED  
AF-S DX Zoom-Nikkor 17–55mm f/2.8G IF-ED  
AF-S DX VR Zoom-Nikkor 18–200mm f/3.5–5.6G IF-ED  
AF Zoom-Nikkor 20–35mm f/2.8D IF  
AF Zoom-Nikkor 24–85mm f/2.8–4D IF  
AF-S NIKKOR 24–85mm f/3.5–4.5G ED VR  
AF Zoom Nikkor 24–120mm f/3.5–5.6D (IF)  
AF-S NIKKOR 24–120mm f/4G ED VR  
AF-S NIKKOR 28–300mm f/3.5–5.6G ED VR  
AF-S NIKKOR 35mm f/1.4G  
AF Zoom Micro Nikkor ED 70–180mm f/4.5–5.6D  
AF-S VR Micro-Nikkor 105mm f/2.8G IF-ED  
496  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
At ranges under 1.0 m (3 ft 3 in.), the following lenses may block  
the AF-assist illuminator and interfere with autofocus when  
lighting is poor:  
AF-S DX NIKKOR 18–200mm f/3.5–5.6G ED VR II  
AF-S DX NIKKOR 18–300mm f/3.5–5.6G ED VR  
AF-S DX NIKKOR 18–300mm f/3.5–6.3G ED VR  
AF-S NIKKOR 24–70mm f/2.8G ED  
AF-S VR Zoom-Nikkor 24–120mm f/3.5–5.6G IF-ED  
AF-S Zoom-Nikkor 28–70mm f/2.8D IF-ED  
AF-S NIKKOR 28–300mm f/3.5–5.6G ED VR  
AF Micro-Nikkor 200mm f/4D IF-ED  
At ranges under 1.5 m (4 ft 11 in.), the following lenses may block  
the AF-assist illuminator and interfere with autofocus when  
lighting is poor:  
AF-S NIKKOR 14–24mm f/2.8G ED  
AF-S DX NIKKOR 18–300mm f/3.5–5.6G ED VR  
AF-S DX NIKKOR 55–300mm f/4.5–5.6G ED VR  
AF-S VR Zoom-Nikkor 70–200mm f/2.8G IF-ED  
AF-S NIKKOR 70–200mm f/2.8G ED VR II  
AF Zoom-Nikkor 80–200mm f/2.8D ED  
AF-S Zoom-Nikkor 80–200mm f/2.8D IF-ED  
497  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
❚❚ The Built-in Flash  
The built-in flash has a minimum range of 0.6 m (2 ft) and can not  
be used in the macro range of macro zoom lenses. It can be used  
with CPU lenses with focal lengths of 24 mm (16 mm in DX  
format) to 300 mm, although in some cases the flash may be  
unable to entirely light the subject at some ranges or focal  
lengths due to shadows cast by the lens. The following  
illustrations show the effect of vignetting caused by shadows  
cast by the lens when the flash is used.  
Shadow  
Vignetting  
Remove lens hoods to prevent shadows. The flash may be  
unable to light the entire subject with the following lenses at  
ranges less than those given below:  
Minimum distance  
without vignetting  
Lens  
Zoom position  
AF-S DX NIKKOR 10–24mm  
f/3.5–4.5G ED  
18–24 mm  
No vignetting  
18 mm  
20–24 mm  
20 mm  
1.0 m/3 ft 3 in.  
No vignetting  
2.0 m/6 ft 7 in.  
1.0 m/3 ft 3 in.  
AF-S DX Zoom-Nikkor  
12–24mm f/4G IF-ED  
AF-S DX Zoom-Nikkor  
17–55mm f/2.8G IF-ED  
24–55 mm  
AF-S DX NIKKOR 18–200mm  
f/3.5–5.6G ED VR II  
AF-S DX VR Zoom-Nikkor  
18–200mm f/3.5–5.6G IF-ED  
18 mm  
1.0 m/3 ft 3 in.  
No vignetting  
24–200 mm  
28 mm  
50–300 mm  
1.0 m/3 ft 3 in.  
No vignetting  
AF-S DX NIKKOR 18–300mm  
f/3.5–5.6G ED VR  
498  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Minimum distance  
without vignetting  
Lens  
Zoom position  
AF-S NIKKOR 16–35mm  
f/4G ED VR  
35 mm  
1.5 m/4 ft 11 in.  
28 mm  
35 mm  
24 mm  
28–35 mm  
28 mm  
35 mm  
24 mm  
28 mm  
35 mm  
20 mm  
24 mm  
35 mm  
50–70 mm  
24 mm  
35–120 mm  
24 mm  
28 mm  
50–120 mm  
28 mm  
50–70 mm  
28 mm  
35 mm  
1.5 m/4 ft 11 in.  
No vignetting  
1.0 m/3 ft 3 in.  
No vignetting  
1.5 m/4 ft 11 in.  
No vignetting  
1.5 m/4 ft 11 in.  
1.0 m/3 ft 3 in.  
No vignetting  
1.0 m/3 ft 3 in.  
1.0 m/3 ft 3 in.  
1.5 m/4 ft 11 in.  
No vignetting  
1.0 m/3 ft 3 in.  
No vignetting  
2.0 m/6 ft 7 in.  
1.0 m/3 ft 3 in.  
No vignetting  
1.0 m/3 ft 3 in.  
No vignetting  
1.5 m/4 ft 11 in.  
1.0 m/3 ft 3 in.  
No vignetting  
1.5 m/4 ft 11 in.  
AF-S Zoom-Nikkor 17–35mm  
f/2.8D IF-ED  
AF Zoom-Nikkor 18–35mm  
f/3.5–4.5D IF-ED  
AF-S NIKKOR 18–35mm  
f/3.5–4.5G ED  
AF Zoom-Nikkor 20–35mm  
f/2.8D IF  
AF-S NIKKOR 20mm f/1.8G  
AF-S NIKKOR 24mm f/1.4G ED  
AF-S NIKKOR 24–70mm  
f/2.8G ED  
AF-S VR Zoom-Nikkor  
24–120mm f/3.5–5.6G IF-ED  
AF-S NIKKOR 24–120mm  
f/4G ED VR  
AF-S Zoom-Nikkor 28–70mm  
f/2.8D IF-ED  
AF-S NIKKOR 28–300mm  
f/3.5–5.6G ED VR  
50–300 mm  
24 mm  
PC-E NIKKOR 24mm f/3.5D ED *  
* When not shifted or tilted.  
499  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When used with the AF-S NIKKOR 14–24mm f/2.8G ED, the flash  
will be unable to light the entire subject at all ranges.  
The built-in flash can also be used with the following non-CPU  
lenses: Nikon Series E and 24–300 mm NIKKOR (AI-S, AI-, and AI-  
modifed). AI 50–300mm f/4.5, modified AI 50–300mm f/4.5, AI-S  
50–300mm f/4.5 ED, and AI 50–300mm f/4.5 ED lenses must be  
used at a zoom position of 70 mm or above. With AI-S and  
AI 25–50mm f/4 ED lenses, the ranges above which vignetting  
will not occur are: 2.0 m (6 ft 7 in.) at a zoom position of 25 mm  
and 1.0 m (3 ft 3 in.) at a zoom position of 28 mm; vignetting will  
not occur at zoom positions of 35 mm or above.  
500  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
M (Qc shutter-release)...................103  
E (Self-timer)............................ 103, 106  
V (Mirror up)......................... 104, 109  
! (Face-priority AF) ........................... 58  
$ (Wide-area AF) ................................ 58  
% (Normal-area AF)............................ 58  
& (Subject-tracking AF) ................. 58  
a (Matrix) ................................. 139, 335  
Z (Center-weighted)............ 139, 335  
b (Spot)...............................................139  
h (Highlight-weighted) ...............139  
AUTO (Auto flash)................................181  
Y (Red-eye reduction)......... 181, 183  
SLOW (Slow sync)...................... 181, 183  
REAR (Rear-curtain sync)..................183  
E (Exposure compensation).........143  
Y (Flash compensation)...............188  
O (Flexible program).......................... 89  
a (Live view) button.................. 54, 66  
P button .......16, 61, 71, 198, 245, 396  
R (Info) button...................... 12, 64, 75  
D switch.......................................... 5, 342  
m (White balance) .................. 145, 321  
L (Preset manual)............... 145, 155  
D (Bracketing)................................202  
I (Focus indicator) ......... 36, 129, 133  
t (Memory buffer)............................105  
N (Flash-ready indicator).................. 40  
Symbols  
i (Auto mode).....................................34  
j (Auto (flash off) mode).................34  
h (Scene mode) ...........................41  
q (Special effects) .......................46  
k (Portrait).............................................42  
l (Landscape)......................................42  
p (Child).................................................42  
m (Sports)...............................................42  
n (Close up) ..........................................43  
o (Night portrait)................................43  
r (Night landscape)...........................43  
s (Party/indoor) ..................................43  
t (Beach/snow)...................................44  
u (Sunset)..............................................44  
v (Dusk/dawn).....................................44  
w (Pet portrait).....................................44  
x (Candlelight)......................................45  
y (Blossom)...........................................45  
z (Autumn colors) ..............................45  
0 (Food)..................................................45  
% (Night vision) ...................................47  
g (Color sketch)..........................47, 50  
i (Miniature effect)...................48, 51  
u (Selective color) .......................48, 52  
1 (Silhouette).......................................48  
2 (High key)..........................................49  
3 (Low key)...........................................49  
P (Programmed auto).........................89  
S (Shutter-priority auto) ....................90  
A (Aperture-priority auto).................91  
M (Manual)..............................................93  
U1/U2.........................................................99  
S (Single frame) ................................ 103  
T (Continuous low speed) .103, 338  
U (Continuous high speed) ........ 103  
J (Quiet shutter-release)............... 103  
Numerics  
1.2× (30×20) 1.2×.................... 110, 111  
12-bit.....................................................117  
14-bit.....................................................117  
3D-tracking ......................124, 125, 126  
A
AC adapter ................................ 441, 445  
Accessories..........................................441  
501  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Accessory terminal .......................... 443  
Active D-Lighting....................175, 212  
Add items (My Menu)..................... 421  
ADL bracketing ........................212, 353  
Adobe RGB ......................................... 314  
Advanced (HDMI)............................. 279  
AE & flash (Auto bracketing set) 202,  
Auto FP high-speed sync..... 345, 346  
Auto image rotation........................382  
Auto ISO sensitivity control 136, 322  
Auto-area AF ............................ 124, 126  
Autoexposure lock...........................141  
Autofocus ....................5759, 120130  
Autofocus mode ........................57, 121  
Auto-servo AF ....................................121  
Available settings .............................460  
AE lock.................................................. 141  
AE only (Auto bracketing set)..... 202,  
B
AE-L/AF-L button......129, 141, 361, 373  
AF................................... 5759, 120130  
AF area brackets ..................10, 29, 247  
AF fine-tune ....................................... 389  
AF point illumination...................... 329  
AF-A ...................................................... 121  
AF-area mode............................. 58, 123  
AF-assist......................................332, 439  
AF-C..............................................121, 326  
AF-F..........................................................57  
AF-mode button........57, 59, 121, 125  
AF-S.......................................57, 121, 327  
After delete......................................... 307  
Angle of view............................111, 432  
Aperture ..........................................9193  
Aperture-priority auto.......................91  
Aspect ratio................................. 76, 399  
Assign AE-L/AF-L button......361, 373  
Assign Fn button.....................356, 370  
Assign MB-D16 4 button.............. 367  
Assign movie record button ........ 366  
Assign preview button..........361, 372  
Assign remote (WR) Fn button.... 368  
Assign shutter button .................... 373  
Auto (White balance)...................... 145  
Auto bracketing.......................202, 353  
Auto bracketing set......................... 353  
Auto distortion control .................. 316  
Auto DX crop ..................................... 111  
Auto flash............................................ 181  
Backlight ......................................... 5, 342  
Backup (Role played by card in Slot  
2)...........................................................119  
Battery ................... 25, 26, 30, 383, 487  
Battery info .........................................383  
Battery life ...........................................494  
Battery order ......................................344  
Battery pack..343, 344, 367, 383, 441  
Beep.......................................................338  
Black-and-white (Monochrome).400  
Blue intensifier (Filter effects) ......401  
Body cap ......................................... 3, 442  
Border ...................................................272  
Bracketing ................................. 202, 353  
Bracketing order ...............................354  
Built-in AF-assist illuminator.........332  
Built-in flash.................................40, 180  
Bulb................................................... 93, 95  
Burst ...................................219, 339, 357  
C
Calendar playback............................244  
Camera Control Pro 2......................444  
Capture NX-D.........116, 268, 378, 384  
CEC............................................... 278, 280  
Center-weighted..................... 139, 335  
Charging the battery......................... 25  
Choose color temp. (White balance).  
502  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Choose image area71, 111, 113, 360,  
Daylight saving time........................381  
DCF.........................................................488  
Default settings ... 199, 292, 311, 318,  
Choose start/end point.....................81  
Clean image sensor ......................... 448  
Clock ..................................................... 381  
Clock battery.........................................15  
Cloudy (White balance).................. 145  
CLS......................................................... 433  
Color balance..................................... 402  
Color outline ...................................... 413  
Color sketch.......................... 47, 50, 414  
Color space......................................... 314  
Color temperature ........ 145, 147, 152  
Commander mode .......................... 348  
Communication unit..............269, 442  
Compatible lenses ........................... 426  
Compressed (Type).......................... 117  
Computer............................................ 262  
Conformity marking...............392, 489  
Connector for external microphone.  
Continuous high speed ................. 103  
Continuous low speed ..........103, 338  
Continuous release mode............. 103  
Continuous-servo AF .............121, 326  
Control panel.......................................... 8  
Copy image(s).................................... 303  
Copyright ...................................252, 385  
CPU contacts...................................... 429  
CPU lens........................................ 33, 426  
Creative Lighting System .............. 433  
Cropping (PictBridge [Setup] menu)  
Delayed remote (Remote control  
mode (ML-L3))..................................193  
Delete.............................................38, 258  
Delete all images...............................260  
Delete current image ...............38, 258  
Delete selected images ..................260  
Depth-of-field ...................................... 92  
Destination...................................72, 319  
Device control (HDMI).....................278  
Digital Print Order Format.. 274,275,  
Diopter adjustment control...29, 443  
Direct sunlight (White balance)...145  
Distortion control .............................412  
D-Lighting ...........................................397  
DPOF...................................274, 275, 488  
DPOF print order...............................275  
DX (24 × 16) 1.5 ×............. 76, 110, 111  
DX format ............................................110  
Dynamic-area AF............123, 126, 329  
E
Easy exposure compensation ......334  
Easy ISO ................................................341  
Edit movie.....................................81, 245  
Electronic rangefinder ....................133  
Ethernet...................................... 269, 442  
EV steps for exposure cntrl............333  
Exif..........................................................488  
Exposure ....................................139144  
Exposure bracketing.............. 202, 353  
Exposure comp. for flash................353  
Exposure compensation ................143  
Exposure delay mode......................339  
Exposure indicator ...................... 63, 94  
Exposure lock .....................................141  
Exposure meters ........................39, 336  
Cross screen (Filter effects)........... 401  
Custom Settings ............................... 323  
Customize command dials ........... 363  
Cyanotype (Monochrome) ........... 400  
D
Date and time............................. 28, 381  
Date format ........................................ 381  
503  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Exposure preview ........................55, 62  
Exposure program........................... 462  
External microphone.........................73  
Eye-Fi upload..................................... 391  
Focus point illumination................329  
Focus point wrap-around..............330  
Focus tracking.......................... 122, 328  
Focus tracking with lock-on..........328  
Focusing screen ................................479  
Focus-mode selector................57, 120  
Format memory card ......................375  
Frame interval (Slide show) ..........308  
Frame size/frame rate ..............71, 319  
Framing guides ............................ 64, 75  
Frequency response .................71, 320  
Front-curtain sync ............................183  
Full-frame playback .........................241  
Full-time servo AF............................... 57  
FV lock...................................................190  
FX (36 × 24) 1.0 × .................... 110, 111  
FX format.............................................110  
F
Face detection................................... 335  
Face-priority AF ...................................58  
File naming......................................... 313  
File number sequence.................... 340  
Filter effects...............................169, 401  
Fine-tune optimal exposure ........ 336  
Fine-tuning white balance ........... 149  
Firmware version.............................. 392  
Fisheye................................................. 413  
Flash 40, 180, 181, 188, 190, 345, 433  
Flash (White balance) ..................... 145  
Flash bracketing ......................202, 353  
Flash cntrl for built-in flash........... 347  
Flash compensation........................ 188  
Flash mode................................181, 183  
Flash only (Auto bracketing set) 202,  
G
GPS............................................... 239, 253  
Green intensifier (Filter effects) ...401  
Group-area AF.......................... 124, 329  
H
Flash range......................................... 187  
Flash ready indicator ......40, 191, 438  
Flash shutter speed................185, 346  
Flash sync speed ............345, 346, 479  
Flash warning.................................... 339  
Flat (Set Picture Control) ............... 165  
Flexible program.................................89  
Flicker reduction............................... 380  
Fluorescent (White balance)........ 145  
Fn button...........................114, 356, 370  
f-number ................................89, 92, 431  
Focal length ..............................237, 432  
Focal plane mark.............................. 133  
Focus indicator .................36, 129, 133  
Focus lock ........................................... 129  
Focus mode................................. 57, 121  
Focus point..... 58, 123, 127, 133, 329,  
H.264 .....................................................484  
HDMI ............................. 65, 78, 277, 488  
HDMI connector.....................................2  
HDMI-CEC.................................. 278, 280  
Headphone volume........................... 72  
Headphones......................................... 73  
Help ......................................................... 21  
Hi (Sensitivity) ....................................135  
Hide image..........................................301  
High definition......................... 277, 488  
High Dynamic Range (HDR)..........177  
High ISO NR ........................................317  
Highlight display................................. 72  
Highlights............................................248  
Histogram..................64, 249, 250, 355  
504  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lo (Sensitivity)....................................135  
Location data ........................... 239, 253  
Lock mirror up for cleaning...........451  
Long exposure NR ............................317  
Lossless compressed (Type)..........117  
I
Image area......... 76, 77, 110, 113, 118  
Image comment ............................... 384  
Image Dust Off ref photo .............. 378  
Image overlay.................................... 403  
Image quality..................................... 115  
Image review .................. 234, 242, 307  
Image size ........................................... 118  
Image type (Slide show) ................ 308  
Incandescent (White balance)..... 145  
Index marking ............70, 80, 370, 372  
Index print .......................................... 274  
In-focus indicator .............36, 129, 133  
Information ................................. 12, 246  
Information display .... 12, 64, 75, 341  
Interval timer shooting .................. 222  
ISO sensitivity ................. 134, 136, 322  
ISO sensitivity settings ..........136, 322  
ISO sensitivity step value............... 333  
i-TTL.................................... 184, 185, 348  
M
M (medium) ..................................77, 118  
Manage Picture Control .................170  
Manual...........................................93, 132  
Manual (Flash cntrl for built-in flash)  
Manual focus..................... 60, 132, 329  
Matrix metering....................... 139, 335  
Max. continuous release ................339  
Maximum aperture .......187, 430, 439  
Maximum sensitivity.............. 137, 322  
MB-D16...........343, 344, 367, 383, 441  
MB-D16 battery type .......................343  
Memory buffer...................................105  
Memory card ....26, 31, 119, 375, 491,  
J
Memory card capacity.....................492  
Metering...............................................139  
Microphone .......................................... 73  
Microphone sensitivity ............71, 320  
Miniature effect...................48, 51, 416  
Minimum aperture...................... 33, 88  
Minimum shutter speed.................137  
Mired .....................................................151  
Mirror..................................109, 193, 451  
Mirror up.................................... 104, 109  
Mode dial..................................................6  
Mode dial lock release .........................6  
Modeling flash...................................353  
Monitor.................. 17, 37, 54, 241, 376  
Monitor brightness ............62, 72, 376  
Monitor color balance.....................377  
Monitor off delay ..............................337  
Monitor pre-flash.................... 185, 191  
Monochrome............................ 165, 400  
JPEG....................................................... 115  
JPEG basic ........................................... 115  
JPEG compression............................ 117  
JPEG fine.............................................. 115  
JPEG normal....................................... 115  
L
L (large).......................................... 77, 118  
LAN........................................................ 442  
Landscape (Set Picture Control) . 165  
Language ............................................ 381  
LCD illumination...........................5, 342  
Lens...................... 27, 33, 235, 389, 426  
Lens focus ring ........................... 60, 132  
Lens mount ....................................3, 133  
Live view...........................5465, 6678  
Live view photography.....................54  
Live view selector.........................54, 66  
505  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Movie ISO sensitivity settings...... 322  
Movie live view .................66, 370373  
Movie quality.............................. 71, 320  
Movie shooting menu.................... 318  
Movie-record button ............... 68, 366  
Movies..................................66, 370373  
Multiple exposure............................ 216  
Multi-selector power aperture.......72  
My Menu ............................................. 421  
Photo shooting menu.....................310  
PictBridge .................................. 271, 488  
Picture Controls....................... 165, 167  
Picture size ..........................................432  
PIN-entry WPS....................................285  
Pitching ................................................388  
Playback........................................37, 241  
Playback display options ...............302  
Playback folder..................................300  
Playback information............ 246, 302  
Playback menu ..................................300  
Playback slot and folder.................245  
Playback zoom...................................255  
Portrait (Set Picture Control) ........165  
Power aperture.......... 72, 73, 370, 372  
Power connector .................... 441, 445  
Predictive focus tracking ...............122  
Preset manual (White balance)...145,  
Press the shutter-release button all  
the way down .................................... 36  
Press the shutter-release button  
halfway ................................................. 36  
Preview button................. 92, 361, 372  
Print (DPOF)........................................274  
Print options (PictBridge [Setup]  
menu)..................................................272  
Print select...........................................274  
Printing.................................................271  
Programmed auto.............................. 89  
Protecting photographs ................257  
Push-button WPS .............................284  
Pv button.............70, 92, 353, 361, 372  
N
NEF (RAW)............... 115, 117, 313, 406  
NEF (RAW) bit depth ....................... 117  
NEF (RAW) processing.................... 406  
NEF (RAW) recording ...................... 117  
Network......................................269, 374  
Network connection....................... 284  
Neutral (Set Picture Control)........ 165  
Nikon Transfer 2 ............................... 267  
No. of copies (PictBridge [Setup]  
menu) ................................................. 272  
Non-CPU lens...................235, 427, 431  
Non-CPU lens data........................... 235  
Normal-area AF....................................58  
Number of focus points................. 330  
Number of shots............................... 494  
O
OK button ........................................... 354  
Optimal quality (JPEG compression)  
Optional flash...........................348, 433  
Output resolution (HDMI)............. 278  
Overflow (Role played by card in  
Slot 2).................................................. 119  
Overview data................................... 254  
Q
Qc (quiet continuous) shutter-  
release.................................................103  
Quick retouch ....................................411  
Quick-response remote (Remote  
control mode (ML-L3))..................193  
Quiet shutter-release ......................103  
P
Page size.............................................. 272  
Perspective control ......................... 415  
Photo information ..................246, 302  
506  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Save user settings............................... 99  
Save/load settings............................386  
Saving camera settings...................386  
Scene mode.......................................... 41  
SD memory card....... 26, 31, 119, 491,  
R
Rank items (My Menu).................... 424  
RAW Slot 1 - JPEG Slot 2 (Role played  
by card in Slot 2) ............................. 119  
Rear-curtain sync.............................. 183  
Recent settings.................................. 425  
Red intensifier (Filter effects) ....... 401  
Red-eye correction .......................... 398  
Red-eye reduction ..................181, 183  
Release button to use dial............. 365  
Release mode ................................7, 103  
Release mode dial........................7, 103  
Release mode dial lock release7, 103  
Remote control ........................193, 444  
Remote control mode (ML-L3) .... 193  
Remote cord................................ 95, 443  
Remote mirror-up (Remote control  
mode (ML-L3)) ................................. 193  
Remote on duration (ML-L3)........ 337  
Remove items (My Menu) ............. 423  
Removing the lens from the camera  
Select date........................261, 274, 301  
Select to send to smart device/  
deselect .................................... 245, 289  
Selective color......................48, 52, 417  
Self-timer ..........................103, 106, 337  
Sensitivity .........................134, 136, 322  
Sepia (Monochrome).......................400  
Set clock from satellite....................239  
Set Picture Control ................. 165, 321  
Setup menu ........................................374  
Shade (White balance)....................145  
Shooting data ....................................251  
Shooting menus...................... 310, 318  
Shutter speed................................ 90, 93  
Shutter-priority auto.......................... 90  
Shutter-release button . 36, 129, 141,  
Repeating flash ................................. 347  
Reset .........................199, 311, 318, 326  
Reset custom settings .................... 326  
Reset movie shooting menu........ 318  
Reset photo shooting menu ........ 311  
Reset user settings........................... 101  
Resize.................................................... 408  
Restoring default settings...199,292,  
Retouch menu..........................245, 393  
Reverse indicators............................ 366  
RGB...............................................249, 314  
Role played by card in Slot 2........ 119  
Rotate tall............................................ 308  
Shutter-release button AE-L .........336  
Side-by-side comparison ...............419  
Single frame........................................103  
Single-point AF........................ 123, 126  
Single-servo AF................. 57, 121, 327  
Size..................................................77, 118  
Size priority (JPEG compression).117  
Skylight (Filter effects) ....................401  
Slide show ...........................................308  
Slot ...............................31, 119, 245, 319  
Slot empty release lock...................365  
Slow sync ................................... 181, 183  
Smart device.......................................281  
Soft (Filter effects).............................402  
Speaker......................................................4  
Special effects ...................................... 46  
Speedlight...........................................433  
Spot........................................................139  
S
S (small) ......................................... 77, 118  
Save selected frame ....................81, 86  
507  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Spot white balance.......................... 159  
sRGB...................................................... 314  
SSID....................................................... 286  
Standard (Set Picture Control) .... 165  
Standard i-TTL flash for digital SLR....  
Standby timer....................39, 239, 336  
Start printing (PictBridge)....273, 275  
Storage folder.................................... 311  
Store points by orientation .......... 331  
Straighten........................................... 411  
Sub-dial frame advance................. 364  
Subject-tracking AF............................58  
Viewfinder................... 10, 29, 443, 478  
Viewfinder eyepiece........................107  
Viewfinder eyepiece cap................107  
Viewfinder focus ........................29, 443  
Viewfinder grid display...................341  
ViewNX 2.................................... 262, 314  
Vignette control................................315  
Virtual horizon ........... 64, 75, 359, 388  
Vivid (Set Picture Control) .............165  
Volume ..........................................80, 309  
W
Warm filter (Filter effects)..............401  
WB.......................................145, 208, 321  
WB bracketing (Auto bracketing set)  
White balance.................145, 208, 321  
Wide-area AF........................................ 58  
Wi-Fi.......................................................281  
Wind noise reduction...............72, 321  
Wireless Mobile Utility .281, 282, 283  
Wireless network ...........269, 281, 442  
Wireless remote controller.. 197, 368  
Wireless transmitter............... 269, 442  
WT-5 ............................................ 269, 442  
T
Television............................................ 277  
Thumbnail playback ..............243, 355  
Tilting monitor.....................................17  
Time ............................................... 28, 381  
Time stamp (PictBridge) ................ 272  
Time zone ........................................... 381  
Time zone and date......................... 381  
Time-lapse photography............... 229  
Timer............................................106, 222  
Toning.........................................168, 170  
Trim....................................................... 399  
Trimming movies................................81  
Tripod........................................................ 3  
Two-button reset ............................. 199  
Type D lens................................426, 429  
Type E lens.................................426, 429  
Type G lens................................426, 429  
U
USB cable ............................................ 266  
User settings .........................................99  
UT-1..............................................269, 442  
UTC...............................................240, 253  
V
View SSID ............................................ 287  
508  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Miele Dishwasher G 658 SCVI User Manual
MPI Technologies Printer IPDS for HP User Manual
Nikon Camera Lens 185mm f 18 User Manual
Nortel Networks IP Phone NN42030 110 User Manual
One for All Universal Remote 8 User Manual
Optoma Technology Projector H31 User Manual
Orange Micro Computer Drive 9210286 User Manual
Ozaki Worldwide Speaker CM688 User Manual
Palm PDAs Smartphones Zire 31 User Manual
Patton electronic Saw SN5200 User Manual